]> git.ipfire.org Git - thirdparty/binutils-gdb.git/blame - ld/ld.texi
Revert "2.41 Release sources"
[thirdparty/binutils-gdb.git] / ld / ld.texi
CommitLineData
252b5132
RH
1\input texinfo
2@setfilename ld.info
d87bef3a 3@c Copyright (C) 1991-2023 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
252b5132 4@syncodeindex ky cp
dff70155 5@c man begin INCLUDE
252b5132
RH
6@include configdoc.texi
7@c (configdoc.texi is generated by the Makefile)
c428fa83 8@include bfdver.texi
dff70155 9@c man end
252b5132
RH
10
11@c @smallbook
12
ff5dcc92
SC
13@macro gcctabopt{body}
14@code{\body\}
15@end macro
16
0285c67d
NC
17@c man begin NAME
18@ifset man
19@c Configure for the generation of man pages
20@set UsesEnvVars
21@set GENERIC
0285c67d 22@set ARM
ac145307 23@set C6X
b8891f8d 24@set CSKY
49fa1e15 25@set H8300
0285c67d 26@set HPPA
0285c67d 27@set M68HC11
7fb9f789 28@set M68K
833794fc 29@set MIPS
3c3bdf30 30@set MMIX
2469cfa2 31@set MSP430
35c08157 32@set NDS32
78058a5e 33@set NIOSII
fa1477dc 34@set PDP11
2a60a7a8
AM
35@set POWERPC
36@set POWERPC64
49fa1e15 37@set Renesas
b4cbbe8f 38@set S/390
49fa1e15
AM
39@set SPU
40@set TICOFF
2ca22b03 41@set WIN32
e0001a05 42@set XTENSA
0285c67d
NC
43@end ifset
44@c man end
45
9160ea82
AM
46@ifnottex
47@dircategory Software development
48@direntry
252b5132 49* Ld: (ld). The GNU linker.
9160ea82
AM
50@end direntry
51@end ifnottex
252b5132 52
0e9517a9 53@copying
e49e529d
JM
54This file documents the @sc{gnu} linker LD
55@ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
56@value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
57@end ifset
58version @value{VERSION}.
252b5132 59
d87bef3a 60Copyright @copyright{} 1991-2023 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
252b5132 61
cf055d54 62Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
793c5807 63under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3
cf055d54
NC
64or any later version published by the Free Software Foundation;
65with no Invariant Sections, with no Front-Cover Texts, and with no
66Back-Cover Texts. A copy of the license is included in the
36f63dca 67section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License''.
0e9517a9 68@end copying
252b5132
RH
69@iftex
70@finalout
71@setchapternewpage odd
71ba23f6 72@settitle The GNU linker
252b5132 73@titlepage
71ba23f6 74@title The GNU linker
252b5132 75@sp 1
e49e529d
JM
76@subtitle @code{ld}
77@ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
78@subtitle @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
79@end ifset
252b5132
RH
80@subtitle Version @value{VERSION}
81@author Steve Chamberlain
82@author Ian Lance Taylor
252b5132
RH
83@page
84
85@tex
86{\parskip=0pt
704c465c 87\hfill Red Hat Inc\par
3ac23310 88\hfill nickc\@redhat.com, doc\@redhat.com\par
71ba23f6 89\hfill {\it The GNU linker}\par
252b5132
RH
90\hfill Edited by Jeffrey Osier (jeffrey\@cygnus.com)\par
91}
92\global\parindent=0pt % Steve likes it this way.
93@end tex
94
95@vskip 0pt plus 1filll
0285c67d 96@c man begin COPYRIGHT
d87bef3a 97Copyright @copyright{} 1991-2023 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
252b5132 98
0285c67d 99Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
793c5807 100under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3
0285c67d
NC
101or any later version published by the Free Software Foundation;
102with no Invariant Sections, with no Front-Cover Texts, and with no
103Back-Cover Texts. A copy of the license is included in the
36f63dca 104section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License''.
0285c67d 105@c man end
252b5132 106
252b5132
RH
107@end titlepage
108@end iftex
4ecceb71 109@contents
252b5132
RH
110@c FIXME: Talk about importance of *order* of args, cmds to linker!
111
84ec0e6d 112@ifnottex
252b5132 113@node Top
71ba23f6 114@top LD
e49e529d
JM
115This file documents the @sc{gnu} linker ld
116@ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
117@value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
118@end ifset
119version @value{VERSION}.
252b5132 120
cf055d54 121This document is distributed under the terms of the GNU Free
793c5807
NC
122Documentation License version 1.3. A copy of the license is included
123in the section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License''.
cf055d54 124
252b5132
RH
125@menu
126* Overview:: Overview
127* Invocation:: Invocation
128* Scripts:: Linker Scripts
bf6d8037 129* Plugins:: Linker Plugins
252b5132
RH
130@ifset GENERIC
131* Machine Dependent:: Machine Dependent Features
132@end ifset
133@ifclear GENERIC
134@ifset H8300
135* H8/300:: ld and the H8/300
136@end ifset
c2dcd04e
NC
137@ifset Renesas
138* Renesas:: ld and other Renesas micros
252b5132 139@end ifset
36f63dca
NC
140@ifset ARM
141* ARM:: ld and the ARM family
142@end ifset
93fd0973
SC
143@ifset M68HC11
144* M68HC11/68HC12:: ld and the Motorola 68HC11 and 68HC12 families
145@end ifset
7ca01ed9
NC
146@ifset HPPA
147* HPPA ELF32:: ld and HPPA 32-bit ELF
148@end ifset
7fb9f789
NC
149@ifset M68K
150* M68K:: ld and Motorola 68K family
151@end ifset
833794fc
MR
152@ifset MIPS
153* MIPS:: ld and MIPS family
154@end ifset
2a60a7a8
AM
155@ifset POWERPC
156* PowerPC ELF32:: ld and PowerPC 32-bit ELF Support
157@end ifset
158@ifset POWERPC64
159* PowerPC64 ELF64:: ld and PowerPC64 64-bit ELF Support
160@end ifset
b4cbbe8f
AK
161@ifset S/390
162* S/390 ELF:: ld and S/390 ELF Support
163@end ifset
49fa1e15
AM
164@ifset SPU
165* SPU ELF:: ld and SPU ELF Support
166@end ifset
74459f0e
TW
167@ifset TICOFF
168* TI COFF:: ld and the TI COFF
169@end ifset
2ca22b03
NC
170@ifset WIN32
171* Win32:: ld and WIN32 (cygwin/mingw)
172@end ifset
e0001a05
NC
173@ifset XTENSA
174* Xtensa:: ld and Xtensa Processors
175@end ifset
252b5132
RH
176@end ifclear
177@ifclear SingleFormat
178* BFD:: BFD
179@end ifclear
180@c Following blank line required for remaining bug in makeinfo conds/menus
181
182* Reporting Bugs:: Reporting Bugs
183* MRI:: MRI Compatible Script Files
704c465c 184* GNU Free Documentation License:: GNU Free Documentation License
370b66a1 185* LD Index:: LD Index
252b5132 186@end menu
84ec0e6d 187@end ifnottex
252b5132
RH
188
189@node Overview
190@chapter Overview
191
192@cindex @sc{gnu} linker
193@cindex what is this?
0285c67d 194
0879a67a 195@ifset man
0285c67d 196@c man begin SYNOPSIS
ff5dcc92 197ld [@b{options}] @var{objfile} @dots{}
0285c67d
NC
198@c man end
199
200@c man begin SEEALSO
201ar(1), nm(1), objcopy(1), objdump(1), readelf(1) and
202the Info entries for @file{binutils} and
203@file{ld}.
204@c man end
205@end ifset
206
207@c man begin DESCRIPTION
208
ff5dcc92 209@command{ld} combines a number of object and archive files, relocates
252b5132 210their data and ties up symbol references. Usually the last step in
ff5dcc92 211compiling a program is to run @command{ld}.
252b5132 212
ff5dcc92 213@command{ld} accepts Linker Command Language files written in
252b5132
RH
214a superset of AT&T's Link Editor Command Language syntax,
215to provide explicit and total control over the linking process.
216
0285c67d
NC
217@ifset man
218@c For the man only
ece2d90e 219This man page does not describe the command language; see the
71ba23f6
NC
220@command{ld} entry in @code{info} for full details on the command
221language and on other aspects of the GNU linker.
0285c67d
NC
222@end ifset
223
252b5132 224@ifclear SingleFormat
ff5dcc92
SC
225This version of @command{ld} uses the general purpose BFD libraries
226to operate on object files. This allows @command{ld} to read, combine, and
252b5132
RH
227write object files in many different formats---for example, COFF or
228@code{a.out}. Different formats may be linked together to produce any
229available kind of object file. @xref{BFD}, for more information.
230@end ifclear
231
232Aside from its flexibility, the @sc{gnu} linker is more helpful than other
233linkers in providing diagnostic information. Many linkers abandon
234execution immediately upon encountering an error; whenever possible,
ff5dcc92 235@command{ld} continues executing, allowing you to identify other errors
252b5132
RH
236(or, in some cases, to get an output file in spite of the error).
237
0285c67d
NC
238@c man end
239
252b5132
RH
240@node Invocation
241@chapter Invocation
242
0285c67d
NC
243@c man begin DESCRIPTION
244
ff5dcc92 245The @sc{gnu} linker @command{ld} is meant to cover a broad range of situations,
252b5132
RH
246and to be as compatible as possible with other linkers. As a result,
247you have many choices to control its behavior.
248
0285c67d
NC
249@c man end
250
252b5132
RH
251@ifset UsesEnvVars
252@menu
a05a5b64 253* Options:: Command-line Options
252b5132
RH
254* Environment:: Environment Variables
255@end menu
256
257@node Options
a05a5b64 258@section Command-line Options
252b5132
RH
259@end ifset
260
261@cindex command line
262@cindex options
0285c67d
NC
263
264@c man begin OPTIONS
265
252b5132
RH
266The linker supports a plethora of command-line options, but in actual
267practice few of them are used in any particular context.
268@cindex standard Unix system
ff5dcc92 269For instance, a frequent use of @command{ld} is to link standard Unix
252b5132
RH
270object files on a standard, supported Unix system. On such a system, to
271link a file @code{hello.o}:
272
273@smallexample
274ld -o @var{output} /lib/crt0.o hello.o -lc
275@end smallexample
276
ff5dcc92 277This tells @command{ld} to produce a file called @var{output} as the
252b5132
RH
278result of linking the file @code{/lib/crt0.o} with @code{hello.o} and
279the library @code{libc.a}, which will come from the standard search
280directories. (See the discussion of the @samp{-l} option below.)
281
ff5dcc92 282Some of the command-line options to @command{ld} may be specified at any
511ab9e9
ILT
283point in the command line. However, options which refer to files, such
284as @samp{-l} or @samp{-T}, cause the file to be read at the point at
285which the option appears in the command line, relative to the object
286files and other file options. Repeating non-file options with a
287different argument will either have no further effect, or override prior
252b5132
RH
288occurrences (those further to the left on the command line) of that
289option. Options which may be meaningfully specified more than once are
290noted in the descriptions below.
291
292@cindex object files
511ab9e9
ILT
293Non-option arguments are object files or archives which are to be linked
294together. They may follow, precede, or be mixed in with command-line
295options, except that an object file argument may not be placed between
296an option and its argument.
252b5132
RH
297
298Usually the linker is invoked with at least one object file, but you can
299specify other forms of binary input files using @samp{-l}, @samp{-R},
300and the script command language. If @emph{no} binary input files at all
301are specified, the linker does not produce any output, and issues the
302message @samp{No input files}.
303
36f63dca 304If the linker cannot recognize the format of an object file, it will
252b5132
RH
305assume that it is a linker script. A script specified in this way
306augments the main linker script used for the link (either the default
307linker script or the one specified by using @samp{-T}). This feature
308permits the linker to link against a file which appears to be an object
309or an archive, but actually merely defines some symbol values, or uses
53d25da6
AM
310@code{INPUT} or @code{GROUP} to load other objects. Specifying a
311script in this way merely augments the main linker script, with the
312extra commands placed after the main script; use the @samp{-T} option
313to replace the default linker script entirely, but note the effect of
314the @code{INSERT} command. @xref{Scripts}.
252b5132
RH
315
316For options whose names are a single letter,
317option arguments must either follow the option letter without intervening
318whitespace, or be given as separate arguments immediately following the
319option that requires them.
320
321For options whose names are multiple letters, either one dash or two can
e4897a32 322precede the option name; for example, @samp{-trace-symbol} and
36f63dca 323@samp{--trace-symbol} are equivalent. Note---there is one exception to
e4897a32 324this rule. Multiple letter options that start with a lower case 'o' can
ba1be17e 325only be preceded by two dashes. This is to reduce confusion with the
e4897a32
NC
326@samp{-o} option. So for example @samp{-omagic} sets the output file
327name to @samp{magic} whereas @samp{--omagic} sets the NMAGIC flag on the
328output.
329
330Arguments to multiple-letter options must either be separated from the
331option name by an equals sign, or be given as separate arguments
332immediately following the option that requires them. For example,
333@samp{--trace-symbol foo} and @samp{--trace-symbol=foo} are equivalent.
334Unique abbreviations of the names of multiple-letter options are
335accepted.
252b5132 336
36f63dca 337Note---if the linker is being invoked indirectly, via a compiler driver
a05a5b64 338(e.g. @samp{gcc}) then all the linker command-line options should be
fa19fce0
NC
339prefixed by @samp{-Wl,} (or whatever is appropriate for the particular
340compiler driver) like this:
4e53152f
NC
341
342@smallexample
2509a395 343 gcc -Wl,--start-group foo.o bar.o -Wl,--end-group
4e53152f
NC
344@end smallexample
345
346This is important, because otherwise the compiler driver program may
2509a395
SL
347silently drop the linker options, resulting in a bad link. Confusion
348may also arise when passing options that require values through a
349driver, as the use of a space between option and argument acts as
350a separator, and causes the driver to pass only the option to the linker
351and the argument to the compiler. In this case, it is simplest to use
352the joined forms of both single- and multiple-letter options, such as:
353
354@smallexample
355 gcc foo.o bar.o -Wl,-eENTRY -Wl,-Map=a.map
356@end smallexample
4e53152f 357
a05a5b64 358Here is a table of the generic command-line switches accepted by the GNU
4e53152f
NC
359linker:
360
ff5dcc92 361@table @gcctabopt
38fc1cb1 362@include at-file.texi
dff70155 363
2509a395
SL
364@kindex -a @var{keyword}
365@item -a @var{keyword}
252b5132
RH
366This option is supported for HP/UX compatibility. The @var{keyword}
367argument must be one of the strings @samp{archive}, @samp{shared}, or
368@samp{default}. @samp{-aarchive} is functionally equivalent to
369@samp{-Bstatic}, and the other two keywords are functionally equivalent
370to @samp{-Bdynamic}. This option may be used any number of times.
371
7ee314fa
AM
372@kindex --audit @var{AUDITLIB}
373@item --audit @var{AUDITLIB}
374Adds @var{AUDITLIB} to the @code{DT_AUDIT} entry of the dynamic section.
375@var{AUDITLIB} is not checked for existence, nor will it use the DT_SONAME
376specified in the library. If specified multiple times @code{DT_AUDIT}
377will contain a colon separated list of audit interfaces to use. If the linker
378finds an object with an audit entry while searching for shared libraries,
9d5777a3 379it will add a corresponding @code{DT_DEPAUDIT} entry in the output file.
7ee314fa 380This option is only meaningful on ELF platforms supporting the rtld-audit
9d5777a3 381interface.
7ee314fa 382
252b5132
RH
383@ifclear SingleFormat
384@cindex binary input format
385@kindex -b @var{format}
386@kindex --format=@var{format}
387@cindex input format
388@cindex input format
389@item -b @var{input-format}
390@itemx --format=@var{input-format}
ff5dcc92
SC
391@command{ld} may be configured to support more than one kind of object
392file. If your @command{ld} is configured this way, you can use the
252b5132 393@samp{-b} option to specify the binary format for input object files
ff5dcc92 394that follow this option on the command line. Even when @command{ld} is
252b5132 395configured to support alternative object formats, you don't usually need
ff5dcc92 396to specify this, as @command{ld} should be configured to expect as a
252b5132
RH
397default input format the most usual format on each machine.
398@var{input-format} is a text string, the name of a particular format
399supported by the BFD libraries. (You can list the available binary
400formats with @samp{objdump -i}.)
401@xref{BFD}.
402
403You may want to use this option if you are linking files with an unusual
404binary format. You can also use @samp{-b} to switch formats explicitly (when
405linking object files of different formats), by including
406@samp{-b @var{input-format}} before each group of object files in a
a1ab1d2a 407particular format.
252b5132
RH
408
409The default format is taken from the environment variable
410@code{GNUTARGET}.
411@ifset UsesEnvVars
412@xref{Environment}.
413@end ifset
414You can also define the input format from a script, using the command
0285c67d
NC
415@code{TARGET};
416@ifclear man
417see @ref{Format Commands}.
418@end ifclear
252b5132
RH
419@end ifclear
420
421@kindex -c @var{MRI-cmdfile}
422@kindex --mri-script=@var{MRI-cmdfile}
423@cindex compatibility, MRI
424@item -c @var{MRI-commandfile}
425@itemx --mri-script=@var{MRI-commandfile}
ff5dcc92 426For compatibility with linkers produced by MRI, @command{ld} accepts script
252b5132 427files written in an alternate, restricted command language, described in
0285c67d
NC
428@ifclear man
429@ref{MRI,,MRI Compatible Script Files}.
430@end ifclear
431@ifset man
432the MRI Compatible Script Files section of GNU ld documentation.
433@end ifset
434Introduce MRI script files with
252b5132 435the option @samp{-c}; use the @samp{-T} option to run linker
ff5dcc92
SC
436scripts written in the general-purpose @command{ld} scripting language.
437If @var{MRI-cmdfile} does not exist, @command{ld} looks for it in the directories
252b5132
RH
438specified by any @samp{-L} options.
439
440@cindex common allocation
441@kindex -d
442@kindex -dc
443@kindex -dp
a1ab1d2a 444@item -d
252b5132
RH
445@itemx -dc
446@itemx -dp
447These three options are equivalent; multiple forms are supported for
448compatibility with other linkers. They assign space to common symbols
449even if a relocatable output file is specified (with @samp{-r}). The
450script command @code{FORCE_COMMON_ALLOCATION} has the same effect.
451@xref{Miscellaneous Commands}.
452
7ee314fa
AM
453@kindex --depaudit @var{AUDITLIB}
454@kindex -P @var{AUDITLIB}
455@item --depaudit @var{AUDITLIB}
456@itemx -P @var{AUDITLIB}
457Adds @var{AUDITLIB} to the @code{DT_DEPAUDIT} entry of the dynamic section.
458@var{AUDITLIB} is not checked for existence, nor will it use the DT_SONAME
459specified in the library. If specified multiple times @code{DT_DEPAUDIT}
460will contain a colon separated list of audit interfaces to use. This
461option is only meaningful on ELF platforms supporting the rtld-audit interface.
9d5777a3 462The -P option is provided for Solaris compatibility.
7ee314fa 463
2d5783fa
NC
464@kindex --enable-linker-version
465@item --enable-linker-version
466Enables the @code{LINKER_VERSION} linker script directive, described
467in @ref{Output Section Data}. If this directive is used in a linker
468script and this option has been enabled then a string containing the
469linker version will be inserted at the current point.
470
471Note - this location of this option on the linker command line is
472significant. It will only affect linker scripts that come after it on
473the command line, or which are built into the linker.
474
475@kindex --disable-linker-version
476@item --disable-linker-version
477Disables the @code{LINKER_VERSION} linker script directive, so that it
478does not insert a version string. This is the default.
479
abf874aa
CL
480@kindex --enable-non-contiguous-regions
481@item --enable-non-contiguous-regions
482This option avoids generating an error if an input section does not
483fit a matching output section. The linker tries to allocate the input
484section to subseque nt matching output sections, and generates an
485error only if no output section is large enough. This is useful when
486several non-contiguous memory regions are available and the input
487section does not require a particular one. The order in which input
488sections are evaluated does not change, for instance:
489
490@smallexample
491 MEMORY @{
93cda40b
NC
492 MEM1 (rwx) : ORIGIN = 0x1000, LENGTH = 0x14
493 MEM2 (rwx) : ORIGIN = 0x1000, LENGTH = 0x40
494 MEM3 (rwx) : ORIGIN = 0x2000, LENGTH = 0x40
abf874aa
CL
495 @}
496 SECTIONS @{
497 mem1 : @{ *(.data.*); @} > MEM1
498 mem2 : @{ *(.data.*); @} > MEM2
94ffdb59 499 mem3 : @{ *(.data.*); @} > MEM3
abf874aa
CL
500 @}
501
502 with input sections:
503 .data.1: size 8
504 .data.2: size 0x10
505 .data.3: size 4
506
507 results in .data.1 affected to mem1, and .data.2 and .data.3
508 affected to mem2, even though .data.3 would fit in mem3.
509@end smallexample
510
511This option is incompatible with INSERT statements because it changes
512the way input sections are mapped to output sections.
513
514@kindex --enable-non-contiguous-regions-warnings
515@item --enable-non-contiguous-regions-warnings
516This option enables warnings when
517@code{--enable-non-contiguous-regions} allows possibly unexpected
518matches in sections mapping, potentially leading to silently
519discarding a section instead of failing because it does not fit any
520output region.
521
252b5132
RH
522@cindex entry point, from command line
523@kindex -e @var{entry}
524@kindex --entry=@var{entry}
a1ab1d2a 525@item -e @var{entry}
252b5132
RH
526@itemx --entry=@var{entry}
527Use @var{entry} as the explicit symbol for beginning execution of your
528program, rather than the default entry point. If there is no symbol
529named @var{entry}, the linker will try to parse @var{entry} as a number,
530and use that as the entry address (the number will be interpreted in
531base 10; you may use a leading @samp{0x} for base 16, or a leading
532@samp{0} for base 8). @xref{Entry Point}, for a discussion of defaults
533and other ways of specifying the entry point.
534
b58f81ae
DJ
535@kindex --exclude-libs
536@item --exclude-libs @var{lib},@var{lib},...
537Specifies a list of archive libraries from which symbols should not be automatically
e1c37eb5 538exported. The library names may be delimited by commas or colons. Specifying
b58f81ae
DJ
539@code{--exclude-libs ALL} excludes symbols in all archive libraries from
540automatic export. This option is available only for the i386 PE targeted
541port of the linker and for ELF targeted ports. For i386 PE, symbols
542explicitly listed in a .def file are still exported, regardless of this
543option. For ELF targeted ports, symbols affected by this option will
544be treated as hidden.
545
e1c37eb5
DK
546@kindex --exclude-modules-for-implib
547@item --exclude-modules-for-implib @var{module},@var{module},...
548Specifies a list of object files or archive members, from which symbols
549should not be automatically exported, but which should be copied wholesale
550into the import library being generated during the link. The module names
551may be delimited by commas or colons, and must match exactly the filenames
552used by @command{ld} to open the files; for archive members, this is simply
553the member name, but for object files the name listed must include and
554match precisely any path used to specify the input file on the linker's
555command-line. This option is available only for the i386 PE targeted port
556of the linker. Symbols explicitly listed in a .def file are still exported,
557regardless of this option.
558
252b5132
RH
559@cindex dynamic symbol table
560@kindex -E
561@kindex --export-dynamic
267e2722 562@kindex --no-export-dynamic
252b5132
RH
563@item -E
564@itemx --export-dynamic
267e2722
CD
565@itemx --no-export-dynamic
566When creating a dynamically linked executable, using the @option{-E}
567option or the @option{--export-dynamic} option causes the linker to add
568all symbols to the dynamic symbol table. The dynamic symbol table is the
569set of symbols which are visible from dynamic objects at run time.
570
571If you do not use either of these options (or use the
572@option{--no-export-dynamic} option to restore the default behavior), the
573dynamic symbol table will normally contain only those symbols which are
574referenced by some dynamic object mentioned in the link.
252b5132
RH
575
576If you use @code{dlopen} to load a dynamic object which needs to refer
577back to the symbols defined by the program, rather than some other
578dynamic object, then you will probably need to use this option when
579linking the program itself.
580
55255dae 581You can also use the dynamic list to control what symbols should
cb840a31 582be added to the dynamic symbol table if the output format supports it.
55255dae 583See the description of @samp{--dynamic-list}.
cb840a31 584
8b747e1a
DK
585Note that this option is specific to ELF targeted ports. PE targets
586support a similar function to export all symbols from a DLL or EXE; see
587the description of @samp{--export-all-symbols} below.
588
37a141bf
FS
589@kindex --export-dynamic-symbol=@var{glob}
590@cindex export dynamic symbol
591@item --export-dynamic-symbol=@var{glob}
592When creating a dynamically linked executable, symbols matching
593@var{glob} will be added to the dynamic symbol table. When creating a
594shared library, references to symbols matching @var{glob} will not be
595bound to the definitions within the shared library. This option is a
596no-op when creating a shared library and @samp{-Bsymbolic} or
597@samp{--dynamic-list} are not specified. This option is only meaningful
598on ELF platforms which support shared libraries.
599
600@kindex --export-dynamic-symbol-list=@var{file}
601@cindex export dynamic symbol list
602@item --export-dynamic-symbol-list=@var{file}
603Specify a @samp{--export-dynamic-symbol} for each pattern in the file.
604The format of the file is the same as the version node without
605scope and node name. See @ref{VERSION} for more information.
606
36f63dca 607@ifclear SingleFormat
252b5132
RH
608@cindex big-endian objects
609@cindex endianness
610@kindex -EB
611@item -EB
612Link big-endian objects. This affects the default output format.
613
614@cindex little-endian objects
615@kindex -EL
616@item -EL
617Link little-endian objects. This affects the default output format.
36f63dca 618@end ifclear
252b5132 619
2509a395
SL
620@kindex -f @var{name}
621@kindex --auxiliary=@var{name}
622@item -f @var{name}
623@itemx --auxiliary=@var{name}
252b5132
RH
624When creating an ELF shared object, set the internal DT_AUXILIARY field
625to the specified name. This tells the dynamic linker that the symbol
626table of the shared object should be used as an auxiliary filter on the
627symbol table of the shared object @var{name}.
628
629If you later link a program against this filter object, then, when you
630run the program, the dynamic linker will see the DT_AUXILIARY field. If
631the dynamic linker resolves any symbols from the filter object, it will
632first check whether there is a definition in the shared object
633@var{name}. If there is one, it will be used instead of the definition
634in the filter object. The shared object @var{name} need not exist.
635Thus the shared object @var{name} may be used to provide an alternative
636implementation of certain functions, perhaps for debugging or for
a094d01f 637machine-specific performance.
252b5132
RH
638
639This option may be specified more than once. The DT_AUXILIARY entries
640will be created in the order in which they appear on the command line.
641
2509a395
SL
642@kindex -F @var{name}
643@kindex --filter=@var{name}
252b5132 644@item -F @var{name}
2509a395 645@itemx --filter=@var{name}
252b5132
RH
646When creating an ELF shared object, set the internal DT_FILTER field to
647the specified name. This tells the dynamic linker that the symbol table
648of the shared object which is being created should be used as a filter
649on the symbol table of the shared object @var{name}.
650
651If you later link a program against this filter object, then, when you
652run the program, the dynamic linker will see the DT_FILTER field. The
653dynamic linker will resolve symbols according to the symbol table of the
654filter object as usual, but it will actually link to the definitions
655found in the shared object @var{name}. Thus the filter object can be
656used to select a subset of the symbols provided by the object
657@var{name}.
658
ff5dcc92 659Some older linkers used the @option{-F} option throughout a compilation
252b5132 660toolchain for specifying object-file format for both input and output
36f63dca
NC
661object files.
662@ifclear SingleFormat
663The @sc{gnu} linker uses other mechanisms for this purpose: the
ece2d90e 664@option{-b}, @option{--format}, @option{--oformat} options, the
252b5132 665@code{TARGET} command in linker scripts, and the @code{GNUTARGET}
36f63dca
NC
666environment variable.
667@end ifclear
668The @sc{gnu} linker will ignore the @option{-F} option when not
669creating an ELF shared object.
252b5132 670
3dbf70a2 671@cindex finalization function
2509a395
SL
672@kindex -fini=@var{name}
673@item -fini=@var{name}
3dbf70a2
MM
674When creating an ELF executable or shared object, call NAME when the
675executable or shared object is unloaded, by setting DT_FINI to the
676address of the function. By default, the linker uses @code{_fini} as
677the function to call.
678
252b5132
RH
679@kindex -g
680@item -g
681Ignored. Provided for compatibility with other tools.
682
2509a395
SL
683@kindex -G @var{value}
684@kindex --gpsize=@var{value}
252b5132 685@cindex object size
2509a395 686@item -G @var{value}
252b5132
RH
687@itemx --gpsize=@var{value}
688Set the maximum size of objects to be optimized using the GP register to
689@var{size}. This is only meaningful for object file formats such as
e8044f35 690MIPS ELF that support putting large and small objects into different
252b5132
RH
691sections. This is ignored for other object file formats.
692
693@cindex runtime library name
2509a395 694@kindex -h @var{name}
252b5132 695@kindex -soname=@var{name}
2509a395 696@item -h @var{name}
252b5132
RH
697@itemx -soname=@var{name}
698When creating an ELF shared object, set the internal DT_SONAME field to
699the specified name. When an executable is linked with a shared object
700which has a DT_SONAME field, then when the executable is run the dynamic
701linker will attempt to load the shared object specified by the DT_SONAME
010e444b 702field rather than using the file name given to the linker.
252b5132
RH
703
704@kindex -i
705@cindex incremental link
706@item -i
707Perform an incremental link (same as option @samp{-r}).
708
3dbf70a2 709@cindex initialization function
2509a395
SL
710@kindex -init=@var{name}
711@item -init=@var{name}
3dbf70a2
MM
712When creating an ELF executable or shared object, call NAME when the
713executable or shared object is loaded, by setting DT_INIT to the address
714of the function. By default, the linker uses @code{_init} as the
715function to call.
716
252b5132 717@cindex archive files, from cmd line
2509a395 718@kindex -l @var{namespec}
bcb674cf 719@kindex --library=@var{namespec}
2509a395 720@item -l @var{namespec}
bcb674cf
RS
721@itemx --library=@var{namespec}
722Add the archive or object file specified by @var{namespec} to the
723list of files to link. This option may be used any number of times.
724If @var{namespec} is of the form @file{:@var{filename}}, @command{ld}
07d8eb55 725will search the library path for a file called @var{filename}, otherwise it
bcb674cf 726will search the library path for a file called @file{lib@var{namespec}.a}.
252b5132 727
ff5dcc92 728On systems which support shared libraries, @command{ld} may also search for
bcb674cf
RS
729files other than @file{lib@var{namespec}.a}. Specifically, on ELF
730and SunOS systems, @command{ld} will search a directory for a library
731called @file{lib@var{namespec}.so} before searching for one called
732@file{lib@var{namespec}.a}. (By convention, a @code{.so} extension
733indicates a shared library.) Note that this behavior does not apply
734to @file{:@var{filename}}, which always specifies a file called
735@var{filename}.
252b5132
RH
736
737The linker will search an archive only once, at the location where it is
738specified on the command line. If the archive defines a symbol which
739was undefined in some object which appeared before the archive on the
740command line, the linker will include the appropriate file(s) from the
741archive. However, an undefined symbol in an object appearing later on
742the command line will not cause the linker to search the archive again.
743
ff5dcc92 744See the @option{-(} option for a way to force the linker to search
252b5132
RH
745archives multiple times.
746
747You may list the same archive multiple times on the command line.
748
749@ifset GENERIC
750This type of archive searching is standard for Unix linkers. However,
ff5dcc92 751if you are using @command{ld} on AIX, note that it is different from the
252b5132
RH
752behaviour of the AIX linker.
753@end ifset
754
755@cindex search directory, from cmd line
2509a395 756@kindex -L @var{dir}
252b5132 757@kindex --library-path=@var{dir}
2509a395 758@item -L @var{searchdir}
252b5132 759@itemx --library-path=@var{searchdir}
ff5dcc92
SC
760Add path @var{searchdir} to the list of paths that @command{ld} will search
761for archive libraries and @command{ld} control scripts. You may use this
252b5132
RH
762option any number of times. The directories are searched in the order
763in which they are specified on the command line. Directories specified
764on the command line are searched before the default directories. All
ff5dcc92 765@option{-L} options apply to all @option{-l} options, regardless of the
7d24f02c
KH
766order in which the options appear. @option{-L} options do not affect
767how @command{ld} searches for a linker script unless @option{-T}
768option is specified.
252b5132 769
3aa2d05a
NC
770If @var{searchdir} begins with @code{=} or @code{$SYSROOT}, then this
771prefix will be replaced by the @dfn{sysroot prefix}, controlled by the
772@samp{--sysroot} option, or specified when the linker is configured.
9c8ebd6a 773
252b5132
RH
774@ifset UsesEnvVars
775The default set of paths searched (without being specified with
ff5dcc92 776@samp{-L}) depends on which emulation mode @command{ld} is using, and in
252b5132
RH
777some cases also on how it was configured. @xref{Environment}.
778@end ifset
779
780The paths can also be specified in a link script with the
781@code{SEARCH_DIR} command. Directories specified this way are searched
782at the point in which the linker script appears in the command line.
783
784@cindex emulation
785@kindex -m @var{emulation}
2509a395 786@item -m @var{emulation}
252b5132
RH
787Emulate the @var{emulation} linker. You can list the available
788emulations with the @samp{--verbose} or @samp{-V} options.
789
790If the @samp{-m} option is not used, the emulation is taken from the
791@code{LDEMULATION} environment variable, if that is defined.
792
793Otherwise, the default emulation depends upon how the linker was
794configured.
795
fb221fba
NC
796@cindex remapping inputs
797@kindex --remap-inputs=@file{pattern}=@file{filename}
798@kindex --remap-inputs-file=@file{file}
799@item --remap-inputs=@file{pattern}=@file{filename}
800@itemx --remap-inputs-file=@file{file}
801These options allow the names of input files to be changed before the
802linker attempts to open them. The option
803@option{--remap-inputs=foo.o=bar.o} will cause any attempt to load a
804file called @file{foo.o} to instead try to load a file called
805@file{bar.o}. Wildcard patterns are permitted in the first filename,
806so @option{--remap-inputs=foo*.o=bar.o} will rename any input file that
807matches @file{foo*.o} to @file{bar.o}.
808
809An alternative form of the option
810@option{--remap-inputs-file=filename} allows the remappings to be read
811from a file. Each line in the file can contain a single remapping.
812Blank lines are ignored. Anything from a hash character (@samp{#}) to
813the end of a line is considered to be a comment and is also ignored.
814The mapping pattern can be separated from the filename by whitespace
815or an equals (@samp{=}) character.
816
817The options can be specified multiple times. Their contents
818accumulate. The remappings will be processed in the order in which
819they occur on the command line, and if they come from a file, in the
820order in which they occur in the file. If a match is made, no further
821checking for that filename will be performed.
822
823If the replacement filename is @file{/dev/null} or just @file{NUL}
824then the remapping will actually cause the input file to be ignored.
825This can be a convenient way to experiment with removing input files
826from a complicated build environment.
827
828Note that this option is position dependent and only affects filenames
829that come after it on the command line. Thus:
830
831@smallexample
832 ld foo.o --remap-inputs=foo.o=bar.o
833@end smallexample
834
835Will have no effect, whereas:
836
837@smallexample
838 ld --remap-inputs=foo.o=bar.o foo.o
839@end smallexample
840
841Will rename the input file @file{foo.o} to @file{bar.o}.
842
843Note - these options also affect files referenced by @emph{INPUT}
844statements in linker scripts. But since linker scripts are processed
845after the entire command line is read, the position of the remap
846options on the command line is not significant.
847
848If the @option{verbose} option is enabled then any mappings that match
849will be reported, although again the @option{verbose} option needs to
850be enabled on the command line @emph{before} the remaped filenames
851appear.
852
853If the @option{-Map} or @option{--print-map} options are enabled then
854the remapping list will be included in the map output.
855
252b5132
RH
856@cindex link map
857@kindex -M
858@kindex --print-map
859@item -M
860@itemx --print-map
861Print a link map to the standard output. A link map provides
862information about the link, including the following:
863
864@itemize @bullet
865@item
3b83e13a 866Where object files are mapped into memory.
252b5132
RH
867@item
868How common symbols are allocated.
869@item
870All archive members included in the link, with a mention of the symbol
871which caused the archive member to be brought in.
3b83e13a
NC
872@item
873The values assigned to symbols.
874
875Note - symbols whose values are computed by an expression which
876involves a reference to a previous value of the same symbol may not
877have correct result displayed in the link map. This is because the
878linker discards intermediate results and only retains the final value
879of an expression. Under such circumstances the linker will display
880the final value enclosed by square brackets. Thus for example a
881linker script containing:
882
883@smallexample
884 foo = 1
885 foo = foo * 4
886 foo = foo + 8
887@end smallexample
888
889will produce the following output in the link map if the @option{-M}
890option is used:
891
892@smallexample
893 0x00000001 foo = 0x1
894 [0x0000000c] foo = (foo * 0x4)
895 [0x0000000c] foo = (foo + 0x8)
896@end smallexample
897
898See @ref{Expressions} for more information about expressions in linker
899scripts.
d2ef37eb 900
06ddcada
AM
901@item
902How GNU properties are merged.
d2ef37eb 903
06ddcada
AM
904When the linker merges input .note.gnu.property sections into one output
905.note.gnu.property section, some properties are removed or updated.
906These actions are reported in the link map. For example:
d2ef37eb
L
907
908@smallexample
909Removed property 0xc0000002 to merge foo.o (0x1) and bar.o (not found)
910@end smallexample
911
06ddcada 912This indicates that property 0xc0000002 is removed from output when
d2ef37eb
L
913merging properties in @file{foo.o}, whose property 0xc0000002 value
914is 0x1, and @file{bar.o}, which doesn't have property 0xc0000002.
915
916@smallexample
06ddcada 917Updated property 0xc0010001 (0x1) to merge foo.o (0x1) and bar.o (0x1)
d2ef37eb
L
918@end smallexample
919
06ddcada 920This indicates that property 0xc0010001 value is updated to 0x1 in output
d2ef37eb
L
921when merging properties in @file{foo.o}, whose 0xc0010001 property value
922is 0x1, and @file{bar.o}, whose 0xc0010001 property value is 0x1.
252b5132
RH
923@end itemize
924
035801ce
FS
925@cindex link map discarded
926@kindex --print-map-discarded
927@kindex --no-print-map-discarded
928@item --print-map-discarded
929@itemx --no-print-map-discarded
930Print (or do not print) the list of discarded and garbage collected sections
931in the link map. Enabled by default.
932
496917ce
NC
933@kindex --print-map-locals
934@kindex --no-print-map-locals
935@item --print-map-locals
936@itemx --no-print-map-locals
937Print (or do not print) local symbols in the link map. Local symbols
938will have the text @samp{(local)} printed before their name, and will
939be listed after all of the global symbols in a given section.
940Temporary local symbols (typically those that start with @samp{.L})
941will not be included in the output. Disabled by default.
942
252b5132
RH
943@kindex -n
944@cindex read-only text
945@cindex NMAGIC
946@kindex --nmagic
947@item -n
948@itemx --nmagic
90f5d9d9
JZ
949Turn off page alignment of sections, and disable linking against shared
950libraries. If the output format supports Unix style magic numbers,
951mark the output as @code{NMAGIC}.
252b5132
RH
952
953@kindex -N
954@kindex --omagic
955@cindex read/write from cmd line
956@cindex OMAGIC
a1ab1d2a 957@item -N
252b5132
RH
958@itemx --omagic
959Set the text and data sections to be readable and writable. Also, do
63fd3b82
NC
960not page-align the data segment, and disable linking against shared
961libraries. If the output format supports Unix style magic numbers,
4d8907ac
DS
962mark the output as @code{OMAGIC}. Note: Although a writable text section
963is allowed for PE-COFF targets, it does not conform to the format
964specification published by Microsoft.
63fd3b82
NC
965
966@kindex --no-omagic
967@cindex OMAGIC
968@item --no-omagic
969This option negates most of the effects of the @option{-N} option. It
970sets the text section to be read-only, and forces the data segment to
971be page-aligned. Note - this option does not enable linking against
972shared libraries. Use @option{-Bdynamic} for this.
252b5132
RH
973
974@kindex -o @var{output}
975@kindex --output=@var{output}
976@cindex naming the output file
977@item -o @var{output}
978@itemx --output=@var{output}
ff5dcc92 979Use @var{output} as the name for the program produced by @command{ld}; if this
252b5132
RH
980option is not specified, the name @file{a.out} is used by default. The
981script command @code{OUTPUT} can also specify the output file name.
982
f37b21b4
RM
983@kindex --dependency-file=@var{depfile}
984@cindex dependency file
985@item --dependency-file=@var{depfile}
986Write a @dfn{dependency file} to @var{depfile}. This file contains a rule
987suitable for @code{make} describing the output file and all the input files
988that were read to produce it. The output is similar to the compiler's
989output with @samp{-M -MP} (@pxref{Preprocessor Options,, Options
990Controlling the Preprocessor, gcc.info, Using the GNU Compiler
991Collection}). Note that there is no option like the compiler's @samp{-MM},
992to exclude ``system files'' (which is not a well-specified concept in the
993linker, unlike ``system headers'' in the compiler). So the output from
994@samp{--dependency-file} is always specific to the exact state of the
995installation where it was produced, and should not be copied into
996distributed makefiles without careful editing.
997
252b5132
RH
998@kindex -O @var{level}
999@cindex generating optimized output
1000@item -O @var{level}
ff5dcc92 1001If @var{level} is a numeric values greater than zero @command{ld} optimizes
252b5132 1002the output. This might take significantly longer and therefore probably
98c503ac
NC
1003should only be enabled for the final binary. At the moment this
1004option only affects ELF shared library generation. Future releases of
1005the linker may make more use of this option. Also currently there is
1006no difference in the linker's behaviour for different non-zero values
1007of this option. Again this may change with future releases.
252b5132 1008
387dd777
DP
1009@kindex -plugin @var{name}
1010@item -plugin @var{name}
1011Involve a plugin in the linking process. The @var{name} parameter is
1012the absolute filename of the plugin. Usually this parameter is
1013automatically added by the complier, when using link time
1014optimization, but users can also add their own plugins if they so
1015wish.
1016
1017Note that the location of the compiler originated plugins is different
1018from the place where the @command{ar}, @command{nm} and
1019@command{ranlib} programs search for their plugins. In order for
1020those commands to make use of a compiler based plugin it must first be
41f37a6f 1021copied into the @file{$@{libdir@}/bfd-plugins} directory. All gcc
387dd777 1022based linker plugins are backward compatible, so it is sufficient to
6c19b93b 1023just copy in the newest one.
387dd777 1024
26278bb8
UD
1025@kindex --push-state
1026@cindex push state governing input file handling
1027@item --push-state
f9a6a8f0 1028The @option{--push-state} allows one to preserve the current state of the
26278bb8
UD
1029flags which govern the input file handling so that they can all be
1030restored with one corresponding @option{--pop-state} option.
1031
1032The option which are covered are: @option{-Bdynamic}, @option{-Bstatic},
1033@option{-dn}, @option{-dy}, @option{-call_shared}, @option{-non_shared},
1034@option{-static}, @option{-N}, @option{-n}, @option{--whole-archive},
1035@option{--no-whole-archive}, @option{-r}, @option{-Ur},
1036@option{--copy-dt-needed-entries}, @option{--no-copy-dt-needed-entries},
1037@option{--as-needed}, @option{--no-as-needed}, and @option{-a}.
1038
1039One target for this option are specifications for @file{pkg-config}. When
1040used with the @option{--libs} option all possibly needed libraries are
1041listed and then possibly linked with all the time. It is better to return
1042something as follows:
1043
1044@smallexample
1045-Wl,--push-state,--as-needed -libone -libtwo -Wl,--pop-state
1046@end smallexample
1047
1048@kindex --pop-state
1049@cindex pop state governing input file handling
67cecaba 1050@item --pop-state
26278bb8
UD
1051Undoes the effect of --push-state, restores the previous values of the
1052flags governing input file handling.
1053
a712da20
NC
1054@kindex -q
1055@kindex --emit-relocs
1056@cindex retain relocations in final executable
1057@item -q
1058@itemx --emit-relocs
ba1be17e 1059Leave relocation sections and contents in fully linked executables.
a712da20
NC
1060Post link analysis and optimization tools may need this information in
1061order to perform correct modifications of executables. This results
1062in larger executables.
1063
dbab7a7b
NC
1064This option is currently only supported on ELF platforms.
1065
4f471f39
RS
1066@kindex --force-dynamic
1067@cindex forcing the creation of dynamic sections
1068@item --force-dynamic
1069Force the output file to have dynamic sections. This option is specific
1070to VxWorks targets.
1071
252b5132
RH
1072@cindex partial link
1073@cindex relocatable output
1074@kindex -r
1049f94e 1075@kindex --relocatable
252b5132 1076@item -r
1049f94e 1077@itemx --relocatable
252b5132 1078Generate relocatable output---i.e., generate an output file that can in
ff5dcc92 1079turn serve as input to @command{ld}. This is often called @dfn{partial
252b5132
RH
1080linking}. As a side effect, in environments that support standard Unix
1081magic numbers, this option also sets the output file's magic number to
1082@code{OMAGIC}.
ff5dcc92 1083@c ; see @option{-N}.
252b5132
RH
1084If this option is not specified, an absolute file is produced. When
1085linking C++ programs, this option @emph{will not} resolve references to
1086constructors; to do that, use @samp{-Ur}.
1087
62bf86b4
HPN
1088When an input file does not have the same format as the output file,
1089partial linking is only supported if that input file does not contain any
1090relocations. Different output formats can have further restrictions; for
1091example some @code{a.out}-based formats do not support partial linking
1092with input files in other formats at all.
1093
252b5132
RH
1094This option does the same thing as @samp{-i}.
1095
1096@kindex -R @var{file}
1097@kindex --just-symbols=@var{file}
1098@cindex symbol-only input
1099@item -R @var{filename}
1100@itemx --just-symbols=@var{filename}
1101Read symbol names and their addresses from @var{filename}, but do not
1102relocate it or include it in the output. This allows your output file
1103to refer symbolically to absolute locations of memory defined in other
1104programs. You may use this option more than once.
1105
ff5dcc92 1106For compatibility with other ELF linkers, if the @option{-R} option is
252b5132 1107followed by a directory name, rather than a file name, it is treated as
ff5dcc92 1108the @option{-rpath} option.
252b5132
RH
1109
1110@kindex -s
1111@kindex --strip-all
1112@cindex strip all symbols
a1ab1d2a 1113@item -s
252b5132
RH
1114@itemx --strip-all
1115Omit all symbol information from the output file.
1116
1117@kindex -S
1118@kindex --strip-debug
1119@cindex strip debugger symbols
a1ab1d2a 1120@item -S
252b5132
RH
1121@itemx --strip-debug
1122Omit debugger symbol information (but not all symbols) from the output file.
1123
a70f34c0
NC
1124@kindex --strip-discarded
1125@kindex --no-strip-discarded
1126@item --strip-discarded
1127@itemx --no-strip-discarded
1128Omit (or do not omit) global symbols defined in discarded sections.
1129Enabled by default.
1130
252b5132
RH
1131@kindex -t
1132@kindex --trace
1133@cindex input files, displaying
a1ab1d2a 1134@item -t
252b5132 1135@itemx --trace
4f4690cd
AM
1136Print the names of the input files as @command{ld} processes them. If
1137@samp{-t} is given twice then members within archives are also printed.
1138@samp{-t} output is useful to generate a list of all the object files
1139and scripts involved in linking, for example, when packaging files for
1140a linker bug report.
252b5132
RH
1141
1142@kindex -T @var{script}
1143@kindex --script=@var{script}
1144@cindex script files
1145@item -T @var{scriptfile}
1146@itemx --script=@var{scriptfile}
1147Use @var{scriptfile} as the linker script. This script replaces
31f14901
AM
1148@command{ld}'s default linker script (rather than adding to it),
1149unless the script contains @code{INSERT}, so
252b5132 1150@var{commandfile} must specify everything necessary to describe the
114283d8
NC
1151output file. @xref{Scripts}. If @var{scriptfile} does not exist in
1152the current directory, @code{ld} looks for it in the directories
1153specified by any preceding @samp{-L} options. Multiple @samp{-T}
1154options accumulate.
252b5132 1155
14be8564
L
1156@kindex -dT @var{script}
1157@kindex --default-script=@var{script}
1158@cindex script files
1159@item -dT @var{scriptfile}
1160@itemx --default-script=@var{scriptfile}
1161Use @var{scriptfile} as the default linker script. @xref{Scripts}.
1162
1163This option is similar to the @option{--script} option except that
1164processing of the script is delayed until after the rest of the
1165command line has been processed. This allows options placed after the
1166@option{--default-script} option on the command line to affect the
1167behaviour of the linker script, which can be important when the linker
1168command line cannot be directly controlled by the user. (eg because
1169the command line is being constructed by another tool, such as
1170@samp{gcc}).
1171
252b5132
RH
1172@kindex -u @var{symbol}
1173@kindex --undefined=@var{symbol}
1174@cindex undefined symbol
1175@item -u @var{symbol}
1176@itemx --undefined=@var{symbol}
1177Force @var{symbol} to be entered in the output file as an undefined
1178symbol. Doing this may, for example, trigger linking of additional
1179modules from standard libraries. @samp{-u} may be repeated with
1180different option arguments to enter additional undefined symbols. This
1181option is equivalent to the @code{EXTERN} linker script command.
1182
0a618243
AB
1183If this option is being used to force additional modules to be pulled
1184into the link, and if it is an error for the symbol to remain
1185undefined, then the option @option{--require-defined} should be used
1186instead.
1187
1188@kindex --require-defined=@var{symbol}
1189@cindex symbols, require defined
1190@cindex defined symbol
1191@item --require-defined=@var{symbol}
1192Require that @var{symbol} is defined in the output file. This option
1193is the same as option @option{--undefined} except that if @var{symbol}
1194is not defined in the output file then the linker will issue an error
1195and exit. The same effect can be achieved in a linker script by using
1196@code{EXTERN}, @code{ASSERT} and @code{DEFINED} together. This option
1197can be used multiple times to require additional symbols.
1198
252b5132
RH
1199@kindex -Ur
1200@cindex constructors
a1ab1d2a 1201@item -Ur
0a7dda4f
NC
1202
1203For programs that do not use constructors or destructors, or for ELF
1204based systems this option is equivalent to @option{-r}: it generates
1205relocatable output---i.e., an output file that can in turn serve as
1206input to @command{ld}. For other binaries however the @option{-Ur}
1207option is similar to @option{-r} but it also resolves references to
1208constructors and destructors.
1209
35f8b059
NC
1210For those systems where @option{-r} and @option{-Ur} behave
1211differently, it does not work to use @option{-Ur} on files that were
1212themselves linked with @option{-Ur}; once the constructor table has
1213been built, it cannot be added to. Use @option{-Ur} only for the last
1214partial link, and @option{-r} for the others.
252b5132 1215
c005eb9e
AB
1216@kindex --orphan-handling=@var{MODE}
1217@cindex orphan sections
1218@cindex sections, orphan
1219@item --orphan-handling=@var{MODE}
1220Control how orphan sections are handled. An orphan section is one not
1221specifically mentioned in a linker script. @xref{Orphan Sections}.
1222
1223@var{MODE} can have any of the following values:
1224
1225@table @code
1226@item place
1227Orphan sections are placed into a suitable output section following
1228the strategy described in @ref{Orphan Sections}. The option
d2732b69 1229@samp{--unique} also affects how sections are placed.
c005eb9e
AB
1230
1231@item discard
1232All orphan sections are discarded, by placing them in the
1233@samp{/DISCARD/} section (@pxref{Output Section Discarding}).
1234
1235@item warn
1236The linker will place the orphan section as for @code{place} and also
1237issue a warning.
1238
1239@item error
1240The linker will exit with an error if any orphan section is found.
1241@end table
1242
1243The default if @samp{--orphan-handling} is not given is @code{place}.
1244
577a0623
AM
1245@kindex --unique[=@var{SECTION}]
1246@item --unique[=@var{SECTION}]
1247Creates a separate output section for every input section matching
1248@var{SECTION}, or if the optional wildcard @var{SECTION} argument is
1249missing, for every orphan input section. An orphan section is one not
1250specifically mentioned in a linker script. You may use this option
1251multiple times on the command line; It prevents the normal merging of
1252input sections with the same name, overriding output section assignments
1253in a linker script.
a854a4a7 1254
252b5132
RH
1255@kindex -v
1256@kindex -V
1257@kindex --version
1258@cindex version
1259@item -v
1260@itemx --version
1261@itemx -V
ff5dcc92 1262Display the version number for @command{ld}. The @option{-V} option also
2d5783fa
NC
1263lists the supported emulations. See also the description of the
1264@option{--enable-linker-version} in @ref{Options,,Command-line Options}
1265which can be used to insert the linker version string into a binary.
252b5132
RH
1266
1267@kindex -x
1268@kindex --discard-all
1269@cindex deleting local symbols
1270@item -x
1271@itemx --discard-all
1272Delete all local symbols.
1273
1274@kindex -X
1275@kindex --discard-locals
1276@cindex local symbols, deleting
a1ab1d2a 1277@item -X
252b5132 1278@itemx --discard-locals
3c68c38f
BW
1279Delete all temporary local symbols. (These symbols start with
1280system-specific local label prefixes, typically @samp{.L} for ELF systems
1281or @samp{L} for traditional a.out systems.)
252b5132
RH
1282
1283@kindex -y @var{symbol}
1284@kindex --trace-symbol=@var{symbol}
1285@cindex symbol tracing
1286@item -y @var{symbol}
1287@itemx --trace-symbol=@var{symbol}
1288Print the name of each linked file in which @var{symbol} appears. This
1289option may be given any number of times. On many systems it is necessary
1290to prepend an underscore.
1291
1292This option is useful when you have an undefined symbol in your link but
1293don't know where the reference is coming from.
1294
1295@kindex -Y @var{path}
1296@item -Y @var{path}
1297Add @var{path} to the default library search path. This option exists
1298for Solaris compatibility.
1299
1300@kindex -z @var{keyword}
1301@item -z @var{keyword}
cd6d6c15
NC
1302The recognized keywords are:
1303@table @samp
1304
e6e2dfbd
AM
1305@item call-nop=prefix-addr
1306@itemx call-nop=suffix-nop
1307@itemx call-nop=prefix-@var{byte}
1308@itemx call-nop=suffix-@var{byte}
1309Specify the 1-byte @code{NOP} padding when transforming indirect call
1310to a locally defined function, foo, via its GOT slot.
1311@option{call-nop=prefix-addr} generates @code{0x67 call foo}.
1312@option{call-nop=suffix-nop} generates @code{call foo 0x90}.
1313@option{call-nop=prefix-@var{byte}} generates @code{@var{byte} call foo}.
1314@option{call-nop=suffix-@var{byte}} generates @code{call foo @var{byte}}.
1315Supported for i386 and x86_64.
1316
233a0083
L
1317@item cet-report=none
1318@itemx cet-report=warning
1319@itemx cet-report=error
1320Specify how to report the missing GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_IBT and
1321GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_SHSTK properties in input .note.gnu.property
1322section. @option{cet-report=none}, which is the default, will make the
1323linker not report missing properties in input files.
1324@option{cet-report=warning} will make the linker issue a warning for
1325missing properties in input files. @option{cet-report=error} will make
1326the linker issue an error for missing properties in input files.
1327Note that @option{ibt} will turn off the missing
1328GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_IBT property report and @option{shstk} will
1329turn off the missing GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_SHSTK property report.
1330Supported for Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1331
cd6d6c15 1332@item combreloc
e6e2dfbd
AM
1333@itemx nocombreloc
1334Combine multiple dynamic relocation sections and sort to improve
1335dynamic symbol lookup caching. Do not do this if @samp{nocombreloc}.
cd6d6c15 1336
b8871f35 1337@item common
e6e2dfbd
AM
1338@itemx nocommon
1339Generate common symbols with STT_COMMON type during a relocatable
1340link. Use STT_OBJECT type if @samp{nocommon}.
1341
1342@item common-page-size=@var{value}
1343Set the page size most commonly used to @var{value}. Memory image
1344layout will be optimized to minimize memory pages if the system is
1345using pages of this size.
b8871f35 1346
cd6d6c15 1347@item defs
97a232d7
NC
1348Report unresolved symbol references from regular object files. This
1349is done even if the linker is creating a non-symbolic shared library.
1350This option is the inverse of @samp{-z undefs}.
cd6d6c15 1351
e6e2dfbd
AM
1352@item dynamic-undefined-weak
1353@itemx nodynamic-undefined-weak
1354Make undefined weak symbols dynamic when building a dynamic object,
1355if they are referenced from a regular object file and not forced local
1356by symbol visibility or versioning. Do not make them dynamic if
1357@samp{nodynamic-undefined-weak}. If neither option is given, a target
1358may default to either option being in force, or make some other
1359selection of undefined weak symbols dynamic. Not all targets support
1360these options.
1361
6aa29e7b
JJ
1362@item execstack
1363Marks the object as requiring executable stack.
1364
b039ef04
L
1365@item global
1366This option is only meaningful when building a shared object. It makes
1367the symbols defined by this shared object available for symbol resolution
1368of subsequently loaded libraries.
1369
93ab9c0d
NC
1370@item globalaudit
1371This option is only meaningful when building a dynamic executable.
1372This option marks the executable as requiring global auditing by
1373setting the @code{DF_1_GLOBAUDIT} bit in the @code{DT_FLAGS_1} dynamic
1374tag. Global auditing requires that any auditing library defined via
a05a5b64 1375the @option{--depaudit} or @option{-P} command-line options be run for
6c19b93b 1376all dynamic objects loaded by the application.
93ab9c0d 1377
e6e2dfbd
AM
1378@item ibtplt
1379Generate Intel Indirect Branch Tracking (IBT) enabled PLT entries.
1380Supported for Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1381
8df93cb5 1382@item ibt
e6e2dfbd
AM
1383Generate GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_IBT in .note.gnu.property section
1384to indicate compatibility with IBT. This also implies @option{ibtplt}.
1385Supported for Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1386
6f365fda
L
1387@item indirect-extern-access
1388@itemx noindirect-extern-access
1389Generate GNU_PROPERTY_1_NEEDED_INDIRECT_EXTERN_ACCESS in
1390.note.gnu.property section to indicate that object file requires
1391canonical function pointers and cannot be used with copy relocation.
1392This option also implies @option{noextern-protected-data} and
1393@option{nocopyreloc}. Supported for i386 and x86-64.
1394
1395@option{noindirect-extern-access} removes
1396GNU_PROPERTY_1_NEEDED_INDIRECT_EXTERN_ACCESS from .note.gnu.property
1397section.
1398
cd6d6c15
NC
1399@item initfirst
1400This option is only meaningful when building a shared object.
1401It marks the object so that its runtime initialization will occur
1402before the runtime initialization of any other objects brought into
1403the process at the same time. Similarly the runtime finalization of
1404the object will occur after the runtime finalization of any other
1405objects.
1406
1407@item interpose
e6e2dfbd
AM
1408Specify that the dynamic loader should modify its symbol search order
1409so that symbols in this shared library interpose all other shared
1410libraries not so marked.
cd6d6c15 1411
c3805e4c
VDM
1412@item unique
1413@itemx nounique
1414When generating a shared library or other dynamically loadable ELF
1415object mark it as one that should (by default) only ever be loaded once,
1416and only in the main namespace (when using @code{dlmopen}). This is
1417primarily used to mark fundamental libraries such as libc, libpthread et
1418al which do not usually function correctly unless they are the sole instances
1419of themselves. This behaviour can be overridden by the @code{dlmopen} caller
1420and does not apply to certain loading mechanisms (such as audit libraries).
1421
279d901e
L
1422@item lam-u48
1423Generate GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U48 in .note.gnu.property section
1424to indicate compatibility with Intel LAM_U48. Supported for Linux/x86_64.
1425
1426@item lam-u57
1427Generate GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U57 in .note.gnu.property section
1428to indicate compatibility with Intel LAM_U57. Supported for Linux/x86_64.
1429
1430@item lam-u48-report=none
1431@itemx lam-u48-report=warning
1432@itemx lam-u48-report=error
1433Specify how to report the missing GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U48
1434property in input .note.gnu.property section.
1435@option{lam-u48-report=none}, which is the default, will make the
1436linker not report missing properties in input files.
1437@option{lam-u48-report=warning} will make the linker issue a warning for
1438missing properties in input files. @option{lam-u48-report=error} will
1439make the linker issue an error for missing properties in input files.
1440Supported for Linux/x86_64.
1441
1442@item lam-u57-report=none
1443@itemx lam-u57-report=warning
1444@itemx lam-u57-report=error
1445Specify how to report the missing GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U57
1446property in input .note.gnu.property section.
1447@option{lam-u57-report=none}, which is the default, will make the
1448linker not report missing properties in input files.
1449@option{lam-u57-report=warning} will make the linker issue a warning for
1450missing properties in input files. @option{lam-u57-report=error} will
1451make the linker issue an error for missing properties in input files.
1452Supported for Linux/x86_64.
1453
1454@item lam-report=none
1455@itemx lam-report=warning
1456@itemx lam-report=error
1457Specify how to report the missing GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U48 and
1458GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U57 properties in input .note.gnu.property
1459section. @option{lam-report=none}, which is the default, will make the
1460linker not report missing properties in input files.
1461@option{lam-report=warning} will make the linker issue a warning for
1462missing properties in input files. @option{lam-report=error} will make
1463the linker issue an error for missing properties in input files.
1464Supported for Linux/x86_64.
1465
5fa222e4
AM
1466@item lazy
1467When generating an executable or shared library, mark it to tell the
1468dynamic linker to defer function call resolution to the point when
1469the function is called (lazy binding), rather than at load time.
1470Lazy binding is the default.
1471
cd6d6c15 1472@item loadfltr
e6e2dfbd 1473Specify that the object's filters be processed immediately at runtime.
cd6d6c15 1474
e6e2dfbd
AM
1475@item max-page-size=@var{value}
1476Set the maximum memory page size supported to @var{value}.
cd6d6c15 1477
e6e2dfbd
AM
1478@item muldefs
1479Allow multiple definitions.
b8871f35 1480
cd6d6c15 1481@item nocopyreloc
daf220f0
AM
1482Disable linker generated .dynbss variables used in place of variables
1483defined in shared libraries. May result in dynamic text relocations.
cd6d6c15
NC
1484
1485@item nodefaultlib
e6e2dfbd
AM
1486Specify that the dynamic loader search for dependencies of this object
1487should ignore any default library search paths.
cd6d6c15
NC
1488
1489@item nodelete
e6e2dfbd 1490Specify that the object shouldn't be unloaded at runtime.
cd6d6c15
NC
1491
1492@item nodlopen
e6e2dfbd 1493Specify that the object is not available to @code{dlopen}.
cd6d6c15
NC
1494
1495@item nodump
e6e2dfbd 1496Specify that the object can not be dumped by @code{dldump}.
cd6d6c15 1497
6aa29e7b
JJ
1498@item noexecstack
1499Marks the object as not requiring executable stack.
1500
e6e2dfbd
AM
1501@item noextern-protected-data
1502Don't treat protected data symbols as external when building a shared
1503library. This option overrides the linker backend default. It can be
1504used to work around incorrect relocations against protected data symbols
1505generated by compiler. Updates on protected data symbols by another
1506module aren't visible to the resulting shared library. Supported for
1507i386 and x86-64.
8dfef1bd 1508
e6e2dfbd
AM
1509@item noreloc-overflow
1510Disable relocation overflow check. This can be used to disable
1511relocation overflow check if there will be no dynamic relocation
1512overflow at run-time. Supported for x86_64.
6aa29e7b 1513
cd6d6c15
NC
1514@item now
1515When generating an executable or shared library, mark it to tell the
1516dynamic linker to resolve all symbols when the program is started, or
e6e2dfbd
AM
1517when the shared library is loaded by dlopen, instead of deferring
1518function call resolution to the point when the function is first
1519called.
cd6d6c15
NC
1520
1521@item origin
e6e2dfbd 1522Specify that the object requires @samp{$ORIGIN} handling in paths.
cd6d6c15 1523
6a91be86
L
1524@item pack-relative-relocs
1525@itemx nopack-relative-relocs
1526Generate compact relative relocation in position-independent executable
1527and shared library. It adds @code{DT_RELR}, @code{DT_RELRSZ} and
1528@code{DT_RELRENT} entries to the dynamic section. It is ignored when
1529building position-dependent executable and relocatable output.
1530@option{nopack-relative-relocs} is the default, which disables compact
72aa8173
L
1531relative relocation. When linked against the GNU C Library, a
1532GLIBC_ABI_DT_RELR symbol version dependency on the shared C Library is
1533added to the output. Supported for i386 and x86-64.
6a91be86 1534
6aa29e7b 1535@item relro
e6e2dfbd 1536@itemx norelro
def5c83c
AM
1537Create an ELF @code{PT_GNU_RELRO} segment header in the object. This
1538specifies a memory segment that should be made read-only after
1539relocation, if supported. Specifying @samp{common-page-size} smaller
1540than the system page size will render this protection ineffective.
e6e2dfbd 1541Don't create an ELF @code{PT_GNU_RELRO} segment if @samp{norelro}.
6aa29e7b 1542
68b00778
L
1543@item report-relative-reloc
1544Report dynamic relative relocations generated by linker. Supported for
1545Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1546
96cc7918
KB
1547@item sectionheader
1548@itemx nosectionheader
1549Generate section header. Don't generate section header if
1550@samp{nosectionheader} is used. @option{sectionheader} is the default.
1551
47acac12
L
1552@item separate-code
1553@itemx noseparate-code
1554Create separate code @code{PT_LOAD} segment header in the object. This
1555specifies a memory segment that should contain only instructions and must
1556be in wholly disjoint pages from any other data. Don't create separate
1557code @code{PT_LOAD} segment if @samp{noseparate-code} is used.
1558
e6e2dfbd
AM
1559@item shstk
1560Generate GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_SHSTK in .note.gnu.property section
1561to indicate compatibility with Intel Shadow Stack. Supported for
1562Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
24718e3b 1563
04c3a755 1564@item stack-size=@var{value}
e6e2dfbd 1565Specify a stack size for an ELF @code{PT_GNU_STACK} segment.
04c3a755
NS
1566Specifying zero will override any default non-zero sized
1567@code{PT_GNU_STACK} segment creation.
1568
8ee10e86
AM
1569@item start-stop-gc
1570@itemx nostart-stop-gc
1571@cindex start-stop-gc
1572When @samp{--gc-sections} is in effect, a reference from a retained
1573section to @code{__start_SECNAME} or @code{__stop_SECNAME} causes all
1574input sections named @code{SECNAME} to also be retained, if
1575@code{SECNAME} is representable as a C identifier and either
1576@code{__start_SECNAME} or @code{__stop_SECNAME} is synthesized by the
1577linker. @samp{-z start-stop-gc} disables this effect, allowing
1578sections to be garbage collected as if the special synthesized symbols
1579were not defined. @samp{-z start-stop-gc} has no effect on a
1580definition of @code{__start_SECNAME} or @code{__stop_SECNAME} in an
1581object file or linker script. Such a definition will prevent the
1582linker providing a synthesized @code{__start_SECNAME} or
1583@code{__stop_SECNAME} respectively, and therefore the special
1584treatment by garbage collection for those references.
1585
cae64165
RM
1586@item start-stop-visibility=@var{value}
1587@cindex visibility
1588@cindex ELF symbol visibility
1589Specify the ELF symbol visibility for synthesized
1590@code{__start_SECNAME} and @code{__stop_SECNAME} symbols (@pxref{Input
1591Section Example}). @var{value} must be exactly @samp{default},
1592@samp{internal}, @samp{hidden}, or @samp{protected}. If no @samp{-z
1593start-stop-visibility} option is given, @samp{protected} is used for
1594compatibility with historical practice. However, it's highly
1595recommended to use @samp{-z start-stop-visibility=hidden} in new
1596programs and shared libraries so that these symbols are not exported
1597between shared objects, which is not usually what's intended.
1598
e6e2dfbd
AM
1599@item text
1600@itemx notext
1601@itemx textoff
a6dbf402
L
1602Report an error if DT_TEXTREL is set, i.e., if the position-independent
1603or shared object has dynamic relocations in read-only sections. Don't
1604report an error if @samp{notext} or @samp{textoff}.
48580982 1605
97a232d7
NC
1606@item undefs
1607Do not report unresolved symbol references from regular object files,
1608either when creating an executable, or when creating a shared library.
1609This option is the inverse of @samp{-z defs}.
1610
2d95647b
L
1611@item unique-symbol
1612@itemx nounique-symbol
1613Avoid duplicated local symbol names in the symbol string table. Append
1614".@code{number}" to duplicated local symbol names if @samp{unique-symbol}
1615is used. @option{nounique-symbol} is the default.
1616
b0ab0693 1617@item x86-64-baseline
32930e4e
L
1618@item x86-64-v2
1619@item x86-64-v3
1620@itemx x86-64-v4
1621Specify the x86-64 ISA level needed in .note.gnu.property section.
b0ab0693 1622@option{x86-64-baseline} generates @code{GNU_PROPERTY_X86_ISA_1_BASELINE}.
32930e4e
L
1623@option{x86-64-v2} generates @code{GNU_PROPERTY_X86_ISA_1_V2}.
1624@option{x86-64-v3} generates @code{GNU_PROPERTY_X86_ISA_1_V3}.
1625@option{x86-64-v4} generates @code{GNU_PROPERTY_X86_ISA_1_V4}.
1626Supported for Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1627
cd6d6c15
NC
1628@end table
1629
ece2d90e 1630Other keywords are ignored for Solaris compatibility.
252b5132
RH
1631
1632@kindex -(
1633@cindex groups of archives
1634@item -( @var{archives} -)
1635@itemx --start-group @var{archives} --end-group
1636The @var{archives} should be a list of archive files. They may be
1637either explicit file names, or @samp{-l} options.
1638
1639The specified archives are searched repeatedly until no new undefined
1640references are created. Normally, an archive is searched only once in
1641the order that it is specified on the command line. If a symbol in that
1642archive is needed to resolve an undefined symbol referred to by an
1643object in an archive that appears later on the command line, the linker
1644would not be able to resolve that reference. By grouping the archives,
5d3db3e2 1645they will all be searched repeatedly until all possible references are
252b5132
RH
1646resolved.
1647
1648Using this option has a significant performance cost. It is best to use
1649it only when there are unavoidable circular references between two or
1650more archives.
1651
69da35b5
NC
1652@kindex --accept-unknown-input-arch
1653@kindex --no-accept-unknown-input-arch
1654@item --accept-unknown-input-arch
1655@itemx --no-accept-unknown-input-arch
1656Tells the linker to accept input files whose architecture cannot be
2ca22b03 1657recognised. The assumption is that the user knows what they are doing
69da35b5
NC
1658and deliberately wants to link in these unknown input files. This was
1659the default behaviour of the linker, before release 2.14. The default
1660behaviour from release 2.14 onwards is to reject such input files, and
1661so the @samp{--accept-unknown-input-arch} option has been added to
1662restore the old behaviour.
2ca22b03 1663
4a43e768
AM
1664@kindex --as-needed
1665@kindex --no-as-needed
1666@item --as-needed
1667@itemx --no-as-needed
1668This option affects ELF DT_NEEDED tags for dynamic libraries mentioned
ddbb8a31 1669on the command line after the @option{--as-needed} option. Normally
4a43e768
AM
1670the linker will add a DT_NEEDED tag for each dynamic library mentioned
1671on the command line, regardless of whether the library is actually
ddbb8a31 1672needed or not. @option{--as-needed} causes a DT_NEEDED tag to only be
ffa9430d
AM
1673emitted for a library that @emph{at that point in the link} satisfies a
1674non-weak undefined symbol reference from a regular object file or, if
1240be6b
AM
1675the library is not found in the DT_NEEDED lists of other needed libraries, a
1676non-weak undefined symbol reference from another needed dynamic library.
ffa9430d
AM
1677Object files or libraries appearing on the command line @emph{after}
1678the library in question do not affect whether the library is seen as
1679needed. This is similar to the rules for extraction of object files
1680from archives. @option{--no-as-needed} restores the default behaviour.
4a43e768 1681
6418520e
NC
1682Note: On Linux based systems the @option{--as-needed} option also has
1683an affect on the behaviour of the @option{--rpath} and
1684@option{--rpath-link} options. See the description of
1685@option{--rpath-link} for more details.
1686
e56f61be
L
1687@kindex --add-needed
1688@kindex --no-add-needed
1689@item --add-needed
1690@itemx --no-add-needed
ddbb8a31
NC
1691These two options have been deprecated because of the similarity of
1692their names to the @option{--as-needed} and @option{--no-as-needed}
1693options. They have been replaced by @option{--copy-dt-needed-entries}
1694and @option{--no-copy-dt-needed-entries}.
e56f61be 1695
252b5132
RH
1696@kindex -assert @var{keyword}
1697@item -assert @var{keyword}
1698This option is ignored for SunOS compatibility.
1699
1700@kindex -Bdynamic
1701@kindex -dy
1702@kindex -call_shared
1703@item -Bdynamic
1704@itemx -dy
1705@itemx -call_shared
1706Link against dynamic libraries. This is only meaningful on platforms
1707for which shared libraries are supported. This option is normally the
1708default on such platforms. The different variants of this option are
1709for compatibility with various systems. You may use this option
1710multiple times on the command line: it affects library searching for
da8bce14 1711@option{-l} options which follow it.
252b5132 1712
a1ab1d2a
UD
1713@kindex -Bgroup
1714@item -Bgroup
1715Set the @code{DF_1_GROUP} flag in the @code{DT_FLAGS_1} entry in the dynamic
1716section. This causes the runtime linker to handle lookups in this
1717object and its dependencies to be performed only inside the group.
560e09e9
NC
1718@option{--unresolved-symbols=report-all} is implied. This option is
1719only meaningful on ELF platforms which support shared libraries.
a1ab1d2a 1720
252b5132
RH
1721@kindex -Bstatic
1722@kindex -dn
1723@kindex -non_shared
1724@kindex -static
a1ab1d2a 1725@item -Bstatic
252b5132
RH
1726@itemx -dn
1727@itemx -non_shared
1728@itemx -static
1729Do not link against shared libraries. This is only meaningful on
1730platforms for which shared libraries are supported. The different
1731variants of this option are for compatibility with various systems. You
1732may use this option multiple times on the command line: it affects
560e09e9 1733library searching for @option{-l} options which follow it. This
e9156f74
NC
1734option also implies @option{--unresolved-symbols=report-all}. This
1735option can be used with @option{-shared}. Doing so means that a
1736shared library is being created but that all of the library's external
1737references must be resolved by pulling in entries from static
ece2d90e 1738libraries.
252b5132
RH
1739
1740@kindex -Bsymbolic
1741@item -Bsymbolic
1742When creating a shared library, bind references to global symbols to the
1743definition within the shared library, if any. Normally, it is possible
1744for a program linked against a shared library to override the definition
1914e264
AM
1745within the shared library. This option is only meaningful on ELF
1746platforms which support shared libraries.
252b5132 1747
40b36307
L
1748@kindex -Bsymbolic-functions
1749@item -Bsymbolic-functions
1750When creating a shared library, bind references to global function
c0065db7 1751symbols to the definition within the shared library, if any.
40b36307 1752This option is only meaningful on ELF platforms which support shared
1914e264 1753libraries.
40b36307 1754
cf893b0e
FS
1755@kindex -Bno-symbolic
1756@item -Bno-symbolic
1757This option can cancel previously specified @samp{-Bsymbolic} and
1758@samp{-Bsymbolic-functions}.
1759
55255dae
L
1760@kindex --dynamic-list=@var{dynamic-list-file}
1761@item --dynamic-list=@var{dynamic-list-file}
1762Specify the name of a dynamic list file to the linker. This is
1763typically used when creating shared libraries to specify a list of
1764global symbols whose references shouldn't be bound to the definition
1765within the shared library, or creating dynamically linked executables
1766to specify a list of symbols which should be added to the symbol table
1767in the executable. This option is only meaningful on ELF platforms
1768which support shared libraries.
1769
1770The format of the dynamic list is the same as the version node without
1771scope and node name. See @ref{VERSION} for more information.
1772
40b36307
L
1773@kindex --dynamic-list-data
1774@item --dynamic-list-data
1775Include all global data symbols to the dynamic list.
1776
1777@kindex --dynamic-list-cpp-new
1778@item --dynamic-list-cpp-new
1779Provide the builtin dynamic list for C++ operator new and delete. It
1780is mainly useful for building shared libstdc++.
1781
0b8a70d9
L
1782@kindex --dynamic-list-cpp-typeinfo
1783@item --dynamic-list-cpp-typeinfo
1784Provide the builtin dynamic list for C++ runtime type identification.
1785
252b5132
RH
1786@kindex --check-sections
1787@kindex --no-check-sections
1788@item --check-sections
308b1ffd 1789@itemx --no-check-sections
252b5132 1790Asks the linker @emph{not} to check section addresses after they have
7d816a17 1791been assigned to see if there are any overlaps. Normally the linker will
252b5132
RH
1792perform this check, and if it finds any overlaps it will produce
1793suitable error messages. The linker does know about, and does make
1794allowances for sections in overlays. The default behaviour can be
a05a5b64 1795restored by using the command-line switch @option{--check-sections}.
02b0b1aa
NS
1796Section overlap is not usually checked for relocatable links. You can
1797force checking in that case by using the @option{--check-sections}
1798option.
252b5132 1799
ddbb8a31
NC
1800@kindex --copy-dt-needed-entries
1801@kindex --no-copy-dt-needed-entries
1802@item --copy-dt-needed-entries
1803@itemx --no-copy-dt-needed-entries
9d5777a3 1804This option affects the treatment of dynamic libraries referred to
ddbb8a31 1805by DT_NEEDED tags @emph{inside} ELF dynamic libraries mentioned on the
08efffb8 1806command line. Normally the linker won't add a DT_NEEDED tag to the
ddbb8a31 1807output binary for each library mentioned in a DT_NEEDED tag in an
08efffb8 1808input dynamic library. With @option{--copy-dt-needed-entries}
ddbb8a31 1809specified on the command line however any dynamic libraries that
08efffb8
MM
1810follow it will have their DT_NEEDED entries added. The default
1811behaviour can be restored with @option{--no-copy-dt-needed-entries}.
ddbb8a31
NC
1812
1813This option also has an effect on the resolution of symbols in dynamic
08efffb8
MM
1814libraries. With @option{--copy-dt-needed-entries} dynamic libraries
1815mentioned on the command line will be recursively searched, following
1816their DT_NEEDED tags to other libraries, in order to resolve symbols
1817required by the output binary. With the default setting however
1818the searching of dynamic libraries that follow it will stop with the
1819dynamic library itself. No DT_NEEDED links will be traversed to resolve
ddbb8a31
NC
1820symbols.
1821
252b5132
RH
1822@cindex cross reference table
1823@kindex --cref
1824@item --cref
1825Output a cross reference table. If a linker map file is being
1826generated, the cross reference table is printed to the map file.
1827Otherwise, it is printed on the standard output.
1828
1829The format of the table is intentionally simple, so that it may be
1830easily processed by a script if necessary. The symbols are printed out,
1831sorted by name. For each symbol, a list of file names is given. If the
1832symbol is defined, the first file listed is the location of the
049c1c8e
NC
1833definition. If the symbol is defined as a common value then any files
1834where this happens appear next. Finally any files that reference the
1835symbol are listed.
252b5132 1836
5dba6f05
NA
1837@cindex ctf variables
1838@kindex --ctf-variables
1839@kindex --no-ctf-variables
1840@item --ctf-variables
1841@item --no-ctf-variables
1842The CTF debuginfo format supports a section which encodes the names and
1843types of variables found in the program which do not appear in any symbol
1844table. These variables clearly cannot be looked up by address by
1845conventional debuggers, so the space used for their types and names is
1846usually wasted: the types are usually small but the names are often not.
1847@option{--ctf-variables} causes the generation of such a section.
1848The default behaviour can be restored with @option{--no-ctf-variables}.
1849
1850@cindex ctf type sharing
1851@kindex --ctf-share-types
1852@item --ctf-share-types=@var{method}
1853Adjust the method used to share types between translation units in CTF.
1854
1855@table @samp
1856@item share-unconflicted
1857Put all types that do not have ambiguous definitions into the shared dictionary,
1858where debuggers can easily access them, even if they only occur in one
1859translation unit. This is the default.
1860
1861@item share-duplicated
1862Put only types that occur in multiple translation units into the shared
1863dictionary: types with only one definition go into per-translation-unit
1864dictionaries. Types with ambiguous definitions in multiple translation units
1865always go into per-translation-unit dictionaries. This tends to make the CTF
1866larger, but may reduce the amount of CTF in the shared dictionary. For very
1867large projects this may speed up opening the CTF and save memory in the CTF
1868consumer at runtime.
1869@end table
1870
4818e05f
AM
1871@cindex common allocation
1872@kindex --no-define-common
1873@item --no-define-common
1874This option inhibits the assignment of addresses to common symbols.
1875The script command @code{INHIBIT_COMMON_ALLOCATION} has the same effect.
1876@xref{Miscellaneous Commands}.
1877
1878The @samp{--no-define-common} option allows decoupling
1879the decision to assign addresses to Common symbols from the choice
1880of the output file type; otherwise a non-Relocatable output type
1881forces assigning addresses to Common symbols.
1882Using @samp{--no-define-common} allows Common symbols that are referenced
1883from a shared library to be assigned addresses only in the main program.
1884This eliminates the unused duplicate space in the shared library,
1885and also prevents any possible confusion over resolving to the wrong
1886duplicate when there are many dynamic modules with specialized search
1887paths for runtime symbol resolution.
1888
7bdf4127
AB
1889@cindex group allocation in linker script
1890@cindex section groups
1891@cindex COMDAT
1892@kindex --force-group-allocation
1893@item --force-group-allocation
1894This option causes the linker to place section group members like
1895normal input sections, and to delete the section groups. This is the
1896default behaviour for a final link but this option can be used to
1897change the behaviour of a relocatable link (@samp{-r}). The script
1898command @code{FORCE_GROUP_ALLOCATION} has the same
1899effect. @xref{Miscellaneous Commands}.
1900
252b5132 1901@cindex symbols, from command line
2509a395
SL
1902@kindex --defsym=@var{symbol}=@var{exp}
1903@item --defsym=@var{symbol}=@var{expression}
252b5132
RH
1904Create a global symbol in the output file, containing the absolute
1905address given by @var{expression}. You may use this option as many
1906times as necessary to define multiple symbols in the command line. A
1907limited form of arithmetic is supported for the @var{expression} in this
1908context: you may give a hexadecimal constant or the name of an existing
1909symbol, or use @code{+} and @code{-} to add or subtract hexadecimal
1910constants or symbols. If you need more elaborate expressions, consider
66bc8739
AM
1911using the linker command language from a script (@pxref{Assignments}).
1912@emph{Note:} there should be no white space between @var{symbol}, the
1913equals sign (``@key{=}''), and @var{expression}.
252b5132 1914
54874444
AB
1915The linker processes @samp{--defsym} arguments and @samp{-T} arguments
1916in order, placing @samp{--defsym} before @samp{-T} will define the
1917symbol before the linker script from @samp{-T} is processed, while
1918placing @samp{--defsym} after @samp{-T} will define the symbol after
1919the linker script has been processed. This difference has
1920consequences for expressions within the linker script that use the
1921@samp{--defsym} symbols, which order is correct will depend on what
1922you are trying to achieve.
1923
252b5132 1924@cindex demangling, from command line
28c309a2 1925@kindex --demangle[=@var{style}]
252b5132 1926@kindex --no-demangle
28c309a2 1927@item --demangle[=@var{style}]
252b5132
RH
1928@itemx --no-demangle
1929These options control whether to demangle symbol names in error messages
1930and other output. When the linker is told to demangle, it tries to
1931present symbol names in a readable fashion: it strips leading
1932underscores if they are used by the object file format, and converts C++
a1ab1d2a
UD
1933mangled symbol names into user readable names. Different compilers have
1934different mangling styles. The optional demangling style argument can be used
1935to choose an appropriate demangling style for your compiler. The linker will
28c309a2
NC
1936demangle by default unless the environment variable @samp{COLLECT_NO_DEMANGLE}
1937is set. These options may be used to override the default.
252b5132
RH
1938
1939@cindex dynamic linker, from command line
506eee22 1940@kindex -I@var{file}
2509a395
SL
1941@kindex --dynamic-linker=@var{file}
1942@item -I@var{file}
1943@itemx --dynamic-linker=@var{file}
252b5132
RH
1944Set the name of the dynamic linker. This is only meaningful when
1945generating dynamically linked ELF executables. The default dynamic
1946linker is normally correct; don't use this unless you know what you are
1947doing.
1948
9b8b325a
RF
1949@kindex --no-dynamic-linker
1950@item --no-dynamic-linker
1951When producing an executable file, omit the request for a dynamic
1952linker to be used at load-time. This is only meaningful for ELF
1953executables that contain dynamic relocations, and usually requires
1954entry point code that is capable of processing these relocations.
1955
a70f34c0
NC
1956@kindex --embedded-relocs
1957@item --embedded-relocs
1958This option is similar to the @option{--emit-relocs} option except
a094d01f 1959that the relocs are stored in a target-specific section. This option
a70f34c0
NC
1960is only supported by the @samp{BFIN}, @samp{CR16} and @emph{M68K}
1961targets.
1962
3f0a5f17
ME
1963@kindex --disable-multiple-abs-defs
1964@item --disable-multiple-abs-defs
1965Do not allow multiple definitions with symbols included
1966in filename invoked by -R or --just-symbols
1967
7ce691ae 1968@kindex --fatal-warnings
0fe58ccd 1969@kindex --no-fatal-warnings
7ce691ae 1970@item --fatal-warnings
0fe58ccd
NC
1971@itemx --no-fatal-warnings
1972Treat all warnings as errors. The default behaviour can be restored
1973with the option @option{--no-fatal-warnings}.
7ce691ae 1974
4b2e7a57
NC
1975@kindex -w
1976@kindex --no-warnings
1977@item -w
1978@itemx --no-warnings
1979Do not display any warning or error messages. This overrides
1980@option{--fatal-warnings} if it has been enabled. This option can be
1981used when it is known that the output binary will not work, but there
1982is still a need to create it.
1983
252b5132
RH
1984@kindex --force-exe-suffix
1985@item --force-exe-suffix
1986Make sure that an output file has a .exe suffix.
1987
1988If a successfully built fully linked output file does not have a
1989@code{.exe} or @code{.dll} suffix, this option forces the linker to copy
1990the output file to one of the same name with a @code{.exe} suffix. This
1991option is useful when using unmodified Unix makefiles on a Microsoft
1992Windows host, since some versions of Windows won't run an image unless
1993it ends in a @code{.exe} suffix.
1994
1995@kindex --gc-sections
1996@kindex --no-gc-sections
1997@cindex garbage collection
c17d87de
NC
1998@item --gc-sections
1999@itemx --no-gc-sections
252b5132 2000Enable garbage collection of unused input sections. It is ignored on
ac69cbc6 2001targets that do not support this option. The default behaviour (of not
b3549761 2002performing this garbage collection) can be restored by specifying
0f088b2a
KT
2003@samp{--no-gc-sections} on the command line. Note that garbage
2004collection for COFF and PE format targets is supported, but the
2005implementation is currently considered to be experimental.
252b5132 2006
d5465ba2
AM
2007@samp{--gc-sections} decides which input sections are used by
2008examining symbols and relocations. The section containing the entry
2009symbol and all sections containing symbols undefined on the
2010command-line will be kept, as will sections containing symbols
2011referenced by dynamic objects. Note that when building shared
2012libraries, the linker must assume that any visible symbol is
2013referenced. Once this initial set of sections has been determined,
2014the linker recursively marks as used any section referenced by their
b69e1ff3
CC
2015relocations. See @samp{--entry}, @samp{--undefined}, and
2016@samp{--gc-keep-exported}.
d5465ba2 2017
ac69cbc6 2018This option can be set when doing a partial link (enabled with option
9d5777a3 2019@samp{-r}). In this case the root of symbols kept must be explicitly
b69e1ff3
CC
2020specified either by one of the options @samp{--entry},
2021@samp{--undefined}, or @samp{--gc-keep-exported} or by a @code{ENTRY}
2022command in the linker script.
ac69cbc6 2023
99fabbc9
JL
2024As a GNU extension, ELF input sections marked with the
2025@code{SHF_GNU_RETAIN} flag will not be garbage collected.
2026
c17d87de
NC
2027@kindex --print-gc-sections
2028@kindex --no-print-gc-sections
2029@cindex garbage collection
2030@item --print-gc-sections
2031@itemx --no-print-gc-sections
2032List all sections removed by garbage collection. The listing is
2033printed on stderr. This option is only effective if garbage
2034collection has been enabled via the @samp{--gc-sections}) option. The
2035default behaviour (of not listing the sections that are removed) can
2036be restored by specifying @samp{--no-print-gc-sections} on the command
2037line.
2038
22185505 2039@kindex --gc-keep-exported
2040@cindex garbage collection
2041@item --gc-keep-exported
2042When @samp{--gc-sections} is enabled, this option prevents garbage
2043collection of unused input sections that contain global symbols having
2044default or protected visibility. This option is intended to be used for
2045executables where unreferenced sections would otherwise be garbage
2046collected regardless of the external visibility of contained symbols.
2047Note that this option has no effect when linking shared objects since
2048it is already the default behaviour. This option is only supported for
2049ELF format targets.
2050
30824704
RM
2051@kindex --print-output-format
2052@cindex output format
2053@item --print-output-format
2054Print the name of the default output format (perhaps influenced by
2055other command-line options). This is the string that would appear
2056in an @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} linker script command (@pxref{File Commands}).
2057
3604cb1f
TG
2058@kindex --print-memory-usage
2059@cindex memory usage
2060@item --print-memory-usage
2061Print used size, total size and used size of memory regions created with
2062the @ref{MEMORY} command. This is useful on embedded targets to have a
2063quick view of amount of free memory. The format of the output has one
2064headline and one line per region. It is both human readable and easily
2065parsable by tools. Here is an example of an output:
2066
2067@smallexample
2068Memory region Used Size Region Size %age Used
2069 ROM: 256 KB 1 MB 25.00%
2070 RAM: 32 B 2 GB 0.00%
2071@end smallexample
2072
252b5132
RH
2073@cindex help
2074@cindex usage
2075@kindex --help
2076@item --help
2077Print a summary of the command-line options on the standard output and exit.
2078
ea20a7da
CC
2079@kindex --target-help
2080@item --target-help
a094d01f 2081Print a summary of all target-specific options on the standard output and exit.
ea20a7da 2082
2509a395
SL
2083@kindex -Map=@var{mapfile}
2084@item -Map=@var{mapfile}
252b5132 2085Print a link map to the file @var{mapfile}. See the description of the
2c72361c
NC
2086@option{-M} option, above. If @var{mapfile} is just the character
2087@code{-} then the map will be written to stdout.
2088
2089Specifying a directory as @var{mapfile} causes the linker map to be
2090written as a file inside the directory. Normally name of the file
2091inside the directory is computed as the basename of the @var{output}
2092file with @code{.map} appended. If however the special character
2093@code{%} is used then this will be replaced by the full path of the
2094output file. Additionally if there are any characters after the
2095@var{%} symbol then @code{.map} will no longer be appended.
2096
2097@smallexample
2098 -o foo.exe -Map=bar [Creates ./bar]
2099 -o ../dir/foo.exe -Map=bar [Creates ./bar]
2100 -o foo.exe -Map=../dir [Creates ../dir/foo.exe.map]
2101 -o ../dir2/foo.exe -Map=../dir [Creates ../dir/foo.exe.map]
2102 -o foo.exe -Map=% [Creates ./foo.exe.map]
2103 -o ../dir/foo.exe -Map=% [Creates ../dir/foo.exe.map]
2104 -o foo.exe -Map=%.bar [Creates ./foo.exe.bar]
2105 -o ../dir/foo.exe -Map=%.bar [Creates ../dir/foo.exe.bar]
2106 -o ../dir2/foo.exe -Map=../dir/% [Creates ../dir/../dir2/foo.exe.map]
2107 -o ../dir2/foo.exe -Map=../dir/%.bar [Creates ../dir/../dir2/foo.exe.bar]
2108@end smallexample
2109
2110It is an error to specify more than one @code{%} character.
2111
2112If the map file already exists then it will be overwritten by this
2113operation.
252b5132
RH
2114
2115@cindex memory usage
2116@kindex --no-keep-memory
2117@item --no-keep-memory
ff5dcc92
SC
2118@command{ld} normally optimizes for speed over memory usage by caching the
2119symbol tables of input files in memory. This option tells @command{ld} to
252b5132 2120instead optimize for memory usage, by rereading the symbol tables as
ff5dcc92 2121necessary. This may be required if @command{ld} runs out of memory space
252b5132
RH
2122while linking a large executable.
2123
2124@kindex --no-undefined
a1ab1d2a 2125@kindex -z defs
97a232d7 2126@kindex -z undefs
252b5132 2127@item --no-undefined
a1ab1d2a 2128@itemx -z defs
560e09e9
NC
2129Report unresolved symbol references from regular object files. This
2130is done even if the linker is creating a non-symbolic shared library.
2131The switch @option{--[no-]allow-shlib-undefined} controls the
2132behaviour for reporting unresolved references found in shared
ece2d90e 2133libraries being linked in.
252b5132 2134
97a232d7
NC
2135The effects of this option can be reverted by using @code{-z undefs}.
2136
aa713662
L
2137@kindex --allow-multiple-definition
2138@kindex -z muldefs
2139@item --allow-multiple-definition
2140@itemx -z muldefs
2141Normally when a symbol is defined multiple times, the linker will
2142report a fatal error. These options allow multiple definitions and the
2143first definition will be used.
2144
b79e8c78 2145@kindex --allow-shlib-undefined
ae9a127f 2146@kindex --no-allow-shlib-undefined
b79e8c78 2147@item --allow-shlib-undefined
ae9a127f 2148@itemx --no-allow-shlib-undefined
903249d7 2149Allows or disallows undefined symbols in shared libraries.
560e09e9
NC
2150This switch is similar to @option{--no-undefined} except that it
2151determines the behaviour when the undefined symbols are in a
2152shared library rather than a regular object file. It does not affect
2153how undefined symbols in regular object files are handled.
2154
903249d7
NC
2155The default behaviour is to report errors for any undefined symbols
2156referenced in shared libraries if the linker is being used to create
2157an executable, but to allow them if the linker is being used to create
2158a shared library.
2159
2160The reasons for allowing undefined symbol references in shared
2161libraries specified at link time are that:
2162
2163@itemize @bullet
2164@item
2165A shared library specified at link time may not be the same as the one
2166that is available at load time, so the symbol might actually be
2167resolvable at load time.
2168@item
2169There are some operating systems, eg BeOS and HPPA, where undefined
2170symbols in shared libraries are normal.
2171
2172The BeOS kernel for example patches shared libraries at load time to
2173select whichever function is most appropriate for the current
2174architecture. This is used, for example, to dynamically select an
2175appropriate memset function.
2176@end itemize
b79e8c78 2177
23ae20f5
NC
2178@kindex --error-handling-script=@var{scriptname}
2179@item --error-handling-script=@var{scriptname}
2180If this option is provided then the linker will invoke
2181@var{scriptname} whenever an error is encountered. Currently however
2182only two kinds of error are supported: missing symbols and missing
2183libraries. Two arguments will be passed to script: the keyword
5c14cc55 2184``undefined-symbol'' or `missing-lib'' and the @var{name} of the
93cf38c0
NC
2185undefined symbol or missing library. The intention is that the script
2186will provide suggestions to the user as to where the symbol or library
23ae20f5
NC
2187might be found. After the script has finished then the normal linker
2188error message will be displayed.
2189
2190The availability of this option is controlled by a configure time
2191switch, so it may not be present in specific implementations.
2192
31941635
L
2193@kindex --no-undefined-version
2194@item --no-undefined-version
2195Normally when a symbol has an undefined version, the linker will ignore
2196it. This option disallows symbols with undefined version and a fatal error
2197will be issued instead.
2198
3e3b46e5
PB
2199@kindex --default-symver
2200@item --default-symver
2201Create and use a default symbol version (the soname) for unversioned
fc0e6df6
PB
2202exported symbols.
2203
2204@kindex --default-imported-symver
2205@item --default-imported-symver
2206Create and use a default symbol version (the soname) for unversioned
2207imported symbols.
3e3b46e5 2208
252b5132
RH
2209@kindex --no-warn-mismatch
2210@item --no-warn-mismatch
ff5dcc92 2211Normally @command{ld} will give an error if you try to link together input
252b5132
RH
2212files that are mismatched for some reason, perhaps because they have
2213been compiled for different processors or for different endiannesses.
ff5dcc92 2214This option tells @command{ld} that it should silently permit such possible
252b5132
RH
2215errors. This option should only be used with care, in cases when you
2216have taken some special action that ensures that the linker errors are
2217inappropriate.
2218
fe7929ce
AM
2219@kindex --no-warn-search-mismatch
2220@item --no-warn-search-mismatch
2221Normally @command{ld} will give a warning if it finds an incompatible
2222library during a library search. This option silences the warning.
2223
252b5132
RH
2224@kindex --no-whole-archive
2225@item --no-whole-archive
ff5dcc92 2226Turn off the effect of the @option{--whole-archive} option for subsequent
252b5132
RH
2227archive files.
2228
2229@cindex output file after errors
2230@kindex --noinhibit-exec
2231@item --noinhibit-exec
2232Retain the executable output file whenever it is still usable.
2233Normally, the linker will not produce an output file if it encounters
2234errors during the link process; it exits without writing an output file
2235when it issues any error whatsoever.
2236
0a9c1c8e
CD
2237@kindex -nostdlib
2238@item -nostdlib
2239Only search library directories explicitly specified on the
2240command line. Library directories specified in linker scripts
2241(including linker scripts specified on the command line) are ignored.
2242
252b5132 2243@ifclear SingleFormat
2509a395
SL
2244@kindex --oformat=@var{output-format}
2245@item --oformat=@var{output-format}
ff5dcc92
SC
2246@command{ld} may be configured to support more than one kind of object
2247file. If your @command{ld} is configured this way, you can use the
252b5132 2248@samp{--oformat} option to specify the binary format for the output
ff5dcc92
SC
2249object file. Even when @command{ld} is configured to support alternative
2250object formats, you don't usually need to specify this, as @command{ld}
252b5132
RH
2251should be configured to produce as a default output format the most
2252usual format on each machine. @var{output-format} is a text string, the
2253name of a particular format supported by the BFD libraries. (You can
2254list the available binary formats with @samp{objdump -i}.) The script
2255command @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} can also specify the output format, but
2256this option overrides it. @xref{BFD}.
2257@end ifclear
2258
76359541
TP
2259@kindex --out-implib
2260@item --out-implib @var{file}
2261Create an import library in @var{file} corresponding to the executable
2262the linker is generating (eg. a DLL or ELF program). This import
2263library (which should be called @code{*.dll.a} or @code{*.a} for DLLs)
2264may be used to link clients against the generated executable; this
2265behaviour makes it possible to skip a separate import library creation
2266step (eg. @code{dlltool} for DLLs). This option is only available for
2267the i386 PE and ELF targetted ports of the linker.
2268
36af4a4e
JJ
2269@kindex -pie
2270@kindex --pic-executable
2271@item -pie
2272@itemx --pic-executable
2273@cindex position independent executables
2274Create a position independent executable. This is currently only supported on
2275ELF platforms. Position independent executables are similar to shared
2276libraries in that they are relocated by the dynamic linker to the virtual
7e7d5768 2277address the OS chooses for them (which can vary between invocations). Like
36af4a4e
JJ
2278normal dynamically linked executables they can be executed and symbols
2279defined in the executable cannot be overridden by shared libraries.
2280
e8f6c2a5
FS
2281@kindex -no-pie
2282@item -no-pie
2283@cindex position dependent executables
2284Create a position dependent executable. This is the default.
2285
252b5132
RH
2286@kindex -qmagic
2287@item -qmagic
2288This option is ignored for Linux compatibility.
2289
2290@kindex -Qy
2291@item -Qy
2292This option is ignored for SVR4 compatibility.
2293
2294@kindex --relax
2295@cindex synthesizing linker
2296@cindex relaxing addressing modes
28d5f677 2297@cindex --no-relax
252b5132 2298@item --relax
28d5f677 2299@itemx --no-relax
a1ab1d2a 2300An option with machine dependent effects.
252b5132
RH
2301@ifset GENERIC
2302This option is only supported on a few targets.
2303@end ifset
2304@ifset H8300
ff5dcc92 2305@xref{H8/300,,@command{ld} and the H8/300}.
252b5132 2306@end ifset
e0001a05
NC
2307@ifset XTENSA
2308@xref{Xtensa,, @command{ld} and Xtensa Processors}.
2309@end ifset
93fd0973
SC
2310@ifset M68HC11
2311@xref{M68HC11/68HC12,,@command{ld} and the 68HC11 and 68HC12}.
2312@end ifset
78058a5e
SL
2313@ifset NIOSII
2314@xref{Nios II,,@command{ld} and the Altera Nios II}.
2315@end ifset
2a60a7a8
AM
2316@ifset POWERPC
2317@xref{PowerPC ELF32,,@command{ld} and PowerPC 32-bit ELF Support}.
2318@end ifset
252b5132 2319
ccd9fae5 2320On some platforms the @option{--relax} option performs target specific,
28d5f677
NC
2321global optimizations that become possible when the linker resolves
2322addressing in the program, such as relaxing address modes,
2323synthesizing new instructions, selecting shorter version of current
11e7fd74 2324instructions, and combining constant values.
252b5132
RH
2325
2326On some platforms these link time global optimizations may make symbolic
2327debugging of the resulting executable impossible.
2328@ifset GENERIC
28d5f677
NC
2329This is known to be the case for the Matsushita MN10200 and MN10300
2330family of processors.
252b5132
RH
2331@end ifset
2332
ccd9fae5
NC
2333On platforms where the feature is supported, the option
2334@option{--no-relax} will disable it.
28d5f677 2335
ccd9fae5
NC
2336On platforms where the feature is not supported, both @option{--relax}
2337and @option{--no-relax} are accepted, but ignored.
5c14cc55 2338
252b5132
RH
2339@cindex retaining specified symbols
2340@cindex stripping all but some symbols
2341@cindex symbols, retaining selectively
2509a395
SL
2342@kindex --retain-symbols-file=@var{filename}
2343@item --retain-symbols-file=@var{filename}
252b5132
RH
2344Retain @emph{only} the symbols listed in the file @var{filename},
2345discarding all others. @var{filename} is simply a flat file, with one
2346symbol name per line. This option is especially useful in environments
2347@ifset GENERIC
2348(such as VxWorks)
2349@end ifset
2350where a large global symbol table is accumulated gradually, to conserve
2351run-time memory.
2352
2353@samp{--retain-symbols-file} does @emph{not} discard undefined symbols,
2354or symbols needed for relocations.
2355
2356You may only specify @samp{--retain-symbols-file} once in the command
2357line. It overrides @samp{-s} and @samp{-S}.
2358
2359@ifset GENERIC
2509a395 2360@item -rpath=@var{dir}
252b5132 2361@cindex runtime library search path
2509a395 2362@kindex -rpath=@var{dir}
252b5132 2363Add a directory to the runtime library search path. This is used when
ff5dcc92 2364linking an ELF executable with shared objects. All @option{-rpath}
252b5132 2365arguments are concatenated and passed to the runtime linker, which uses
c1b00498
MR
2366them to locate shared objects at runtime.
2367
2368The @option{-rpath} option is also used when locating shared objects which
2369are needed by shared objects explicitly included in the link; see the
2370description of the @option{-rpath-link} option. Searching @option{-rpath}
2371in this way is only supported by native linkers and cross linkers which
2372have been configured with the @option{--with-sysroot} option.
2373
2374If @option{-rpath} is not used when linking an ELF executable, the
2375contents of the environment variable @code{LD_RUN_PATH} will be used if it
2376is defined.
252b5132 2377
ff5dcc92 2378The @option{-rpath} option may also be used on SunOS. By default, on
d8506323 2379SunOS, the linker will form a runtime search path out of all the
ff5dcc92
SC
2380@option{-L} options it is given. If a @option{-rpath} option is used, the
2381runtime search path will be formed exclusively using the @option{-rpath}
2382options, ignoring the @option{-L} options. This can be useful when using
2383gcc, which adds many @option{-L} options which may be on NFS mounted
b45619c0 2384file systems.
252b5132 2385
ff5dcc92 2386For compatibility with other ELF linkers, if the @option{-R} option is
252b5132 2387followed by a directory name, rather than a file name, it is treated as
ff5dcc92 2388the @option{-rpath} option.
252b5132
RH
2389@end ifset
2390
2391@ifset GENERIC
2392@cindex link-time runtime library search path
2509a395
SL
2393@kindex -rpath-link=@var{dir}
2394@item -rpath-link=@var{dir}
252b5132
RH
2395When using ELF or SunOS, one shared library may require another. This
2396happens when an @code{ld -shared} link includes a shared library as one
2397of the input files.
2398
2399When the linker encounters such a dependency when doing a non-shared,
2400non-relocatable link, it will automatically try to locate the required
2401shared library and include it in the link, if it is not included
ff5dcc92 2402explicitly. In such a case, the @option{-rpath-link} option
252b5132 2403specifies the first set of directories to search. The
ff5dcc92 2404@option{-rpath-link} option may specify a sequence of directory names
252b5132
RH
2405either by specifying a list of names separated by colons, or by
2406appearing multiple times.
2407
e680a6b6
NC
2408The tokens @var{$ORIGIN} and @var{$LIB} can appear in these search
2409directories. They will be replaced by the full path to the directory
2410containing the program or shared object in the case of @var{$ORIGIN}
2411and either @samp{lib} - for 32-bit binaries - or @samp{lib64} - for
241264-bit binaries - in the case of @var{$LIB}.
2413
2414The alternative form of these tokens - @var{$@{ORIGIN@}} and
2415@var{$@{LIB@}} can also be used. The token @var{$PLATFORM} is not
2416supported.
2417
28c309a2
NC
2418This option should be used with caution as it overrides the search path
2419that may have been hard compiled into a shared library. In such a case it
2420is possible to use unintentionally a different search path than the
2421runtime linker would do.
2422
252b5132 2423The linker uses the following search paths to locate required shared
ece2d90e 2424libraries:
d8e4137b 2425
252b5132
RH
2426@enumerate
2427@item
ff5dcc92 2428Any directories specified by @option{-rpath-link} options.
252b5132 2429@item
ff5dcc92
SC
2430Any directories specified by @option{-rpath} options. The difference
2431between @option{-rpath} and @option{-rpath-link} is that directories
2432specified by @option{-rpath} options are included in the executable and
2433used at runtime, whereas the @option{-rpath-link} option is only effective
ece2d90e
NC
2434at link time. Searching @option{-rpath} in this way is only supported
2435by native linkers and cross linkers which have been configured with
2436the @option{--with-sysroot} option.
252b5132 2437@item
e2a83dd0
NC
2438On an ELF system, for native linkers, if the @option{-rpath} and
2439@option{-rpath-link} options were not used, search the contents of the
2440environment variable @code{LD_RUN_PATH}.
252b5132 2441@item
ff5dcc92
SC
2442On SunOS, if the @option{-rpath} option was not used, search any
2443directories specified using @option{-L} options.
252b5132 2444@item
a1b8d843 2445For a native linker, search the contents of the environment
e2a83dd0 2446variable @code{LD_LIBRARY_PATH}.
252b5132 2447@item
ec4eb78a
L
2448For a native ELF linker, the directories in @code{DT_RUNPATH} or
2449@code{DT_RPATH} of a shared library are searched for shared
2450libraries needed by it. The @code{DT_RPATH} entries are ignored if
2451@code{DT_RUNPATH} entries exist.
2452@item
d8e4137b
NC
2453For a linker for a Linux system, if the file @file{/etc/ld.so.conf}
2454exists, the list of directories found in that file. Note: the path
2455to this file is prefixed with the @code{sysroot} value, if that is
2456defined, and then any @code{prefix} string if the linker was
2457configured with the @command{--prefix=<path>} option.
2458@item
2459For a native linker on a FreeBSD system, any directories specified by
2460the @code{_PATH_ELF_HINTS} macro defined in the @file{elf-hints.h}
2461header file.
2462@item
364d7729
AM
2463Any directories specified by a @code{SEARCH_DIR} command in a
2464linker script given on the command line, including scripts specified
2465by @option{-T} (but not @option{-dT}).
2466@item
2467The default directories, normally @file{/lib} and @file{/usr/lib}.
2468@item
2469Any directories specified by a plugin LDPT_SET_EXTRA_LIBRARY_PATH.
2470@item
2471Any directories specified by a @code{SEARCH_DIR} command in a default
2472linker script.
252b5132
RH
2473@end enumerate
2474
6418520e
NC
2475Note however on Linux based systems there is an additional caveat: If
2476the @option{--as-needed} option is active @emph{and} a shared library
2477is located which would normally satisfy the search @emph{and} this
2478library does not have DT_NEEDED tag for @file{libc.so}
2479@emph{and} there is a shared library later on in the set of search
2480directories which also satisfies the search @emph{and}
2481this second shared library does have a DT_NEEDED tag for
2482@file{libc.so} @emph{then} the second library will be selected instead
2483of the first.
2484
252b5132
RH
2485If the required shared library is not found, the linker will issue a
2486warning and continue with the link.
6418520e 2487
252b5132
RH
2488@end ifset
2489
2490@kindex -shared
2491@kindex -Bshareable
2492@item -shared
2493@itemx -Bshareable
2494@cindex shared libraries
2495Create a shared library. This is currently only supported on ELF, XCOFF
2496and SunOS platforms. On SunOS, the linker will automatically create a
ff5dcc92 2497shared library if the @option{-e} option is not used and there are
252b5132
RH
2498undefined symbols in the link.
2499
252b5132 2500@kindex --sort-common
2509a395
SL
2501@item --sort-common
2502@itemx --sort-common=ascending
2503@itemx --sort-common=descending
de7dd2bd
NC
2504This option tells @command{ld} to sort the common symbols by alignment in
2505ascending or descending order when it places them in the appropriate output
2506sections. The symbol alignments considered are sixteen-byte or larger,
2507eight-byte, four-byte, two-byte, and one-byte. This is to prevent gaps
2508between symbols due to alignment constraints. If no sorting order is
2509specified, then descending order is assumed.
252b5132 2510
2509a395
SL
2511@kindex --sort-section=name
2512@item --sort-section=name
bcaa7b3e
L
2513This option will apply @code{SORT_BY_NAME} to all wildcard section
2514patterns in the linker script.
2515
2509a395
SL
2516@kindex --sort-section=alignment
2517@item --sort-section=alignment
bcaa7b3e
L
2518This option will apply @code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} to all wildcard section
2519patterns in the linker script.
2520
a70f34c0
NC
2521@kindex --spare-dynamic-tags
2522@item --spare-dynamic-tags=@var{count}
2523This option specifies the number of empty slots to leave in the
2524.dynamic section of ELF shared objects. Empty slots may be needed by
2525post processing tools, such as the prelinker. The default is 5.
2526
252b5132 2527@kindex --split-by-file
2509a395 2528@item --split-by-file[=@var{size}]
ff5dcc92 2529Similar to @option{--split-by-reloc} but creates a new output section for
a854a4a7
AM
2530each input file when @var{size} is reached. @var{size} defaults to a
2531size of 1 if not given.
252b5132
RH
2532
2533@kindex --split-by-reloc
2509a395 2534@item --split-by-reloc[=@var{count}]
a854a4a7 2535Tries to creates extra sections in the output file so that no single
252b5132 2536output section in the file contains more than @var{count} relocations.
a854a4a7 2537This is useful when generating huge relocatable files for downloading into
252b5132
RH
2538certain real time kernels with the COFF object file format; since COFF
2539cannot represent more than 65535 relocations in a single section. Note
2540that this will fail to work with object file formats which do not
2541support arbitrary sections. The linker will not split up individual
2542input sections for redistribution, so if a single input section contains
2543more than @var{count} relocations one output section will contain that
a854a4a7 2544many relocations. @var{count} defaults to a value of 32768.
252b5132
RH
2545
2546@kindex --stats
2547@item --stats
2548Compute and display statistics about the operation of the linker, such
2549as execution time and memory usage.
2550
2509a395 2551@kindex --sysroot=@var{directory}
e2243057
RS
2552@item --sysroot=@var{directory}
2553Use @var{directory} as the location of the sysroot, overriding the
2554configure-time default. This option is only supported by linkers
2555that were configured using @option{--with-sysroot}.
2556
a70f34c0
NC
2557@kindex --task-link
2558@item --task-link
2559This is used by COFF/PE based targets to create a task-linked object
2560file where all of the global symbols have been converted to statics.
2561
252b5132
RH
2562@kindex --traditional-format
2563@cindex traditional format
2564@item --traditional-format
ff5dcc92
SC
2565For some targets, the output of @command{ld} is different in some ways from
2566the output of some existing linker. This switch requests @command{ld} to
252b5132
RH
2567use the traditional format instead.
2568
2569@cindex dbx
ff5dcc92 2570For example, on SunOS, @command{ld} combines duplicate entries in the
252b5132
RH
2571symbol string table. This can reduce the size of an output file with
2572full debugging information by over 30 percent. Unfortunately, the SunOS
2573@code{dbx} program can not read the resulting program (@code{gdb} has no
ff5dcc92 2574trouble). The @samp{--traditional-format} switch tells @command{ld} to not
252b5132
RH
2575combine duplicate entries.
2576
2509a395
SL
2577@kindex --section-start=@var{sectionname}=@var{org}
2578@item --section-start=@var{sectionname}=@var{org}
176355da
NC
2579Locate a section in the output file at the absolute
2580address given by @var{org}. You may use this option as many
2581times as necessary to locate multiple sections in the command
2582line.
2583@var{org} must be a single hexadecimal integer;
2584for compatibility with other linkers, you may omit the leading
2585@samp{0x} usually associated with hexadecimal values. @emph{Note:} there
2586should be no white space between @var{sectionname}, the equals
2587sign (``@key{=}''), and @var{org}.
2588
2509a395
SL
2589@kindex -Tbss=@var{org}
2590@kindex -Tdata=@var{org}
2591@kindex -Ttext=@var{org}
252b5132 2592@cindex segment origins, cmd line
2509a395
SL
2593@item -Tbss=@var{org}
2594@itemx -Tdata=@var{org}
2595@itemx -Ttext=@var{org}
2596Same as @option{--section-start}, with @code{.bss}, @code{.data} or
a6e02871 2597@code{.text} as the @var{sectionname}.
252b5132 2598
2509a395
SL
2599@kindex -Ttext-segment=@var{org}
2600@item -Ttext-segment=@var{org}
258795f5 2601@cindex text segment origin, cmd line
2b8c06a3
L
2602When creating an ELF executable, it will set the address of the first
2603byte of the text segment.
258795f5 2604
9d5777a3
RM
2605@kindex -Trodata-segment=@var{org}
2606@item -Trodata-segment=@var{org}
2607@cindex rodata segment origin, cmd line
2608When creating an ELF executable or shared object for a target where
2609the read-only data is in its own segment separate from the executable
2610text, it will set the address of the first byte of the read-only data segment.
2611
0d705e9f
AM
2612@kindex -Tldata-segment=@var{org}
2613@item -Tldata-segment=@var{org}
2614@cindex ldata segment origin, cmd line
2615When creating an ELF executable or shared object for x86-64 medium memory
2616model, it will set the address of the first byte of the ldata segment.
2617
560e09e9
NC
2618@kindex --unresolved-symbols
2619@item --unresolved-symbols=@var{method}
2620Determine how to handle unresolved symbols. There are four possible
2621values for @samp{method}:
2622
2623@table @samp
2624@item ignore-all
da8bce14 2625Do not report any unresolved symbols.
560e09e9
NC
2626
2627@item report-all
da8bce14 2628Report all unresolved symbols. This is the default.
560e09e9
NC
2629
2630@item ignore-in-object-files
2631Report unresolved symbols that are contained in shared libraries, but
2632ignore them if they come from regular object files.
2633
2634@item ignore-in-shared-libs
2635Report unresolved symbols that come from regular object files, but
2636ignore them if they come from shared libraries. This can be useful
2637when creating a dynamic binary and it is known that all the shared
2638libraries that it should be referencing are included on the linker's
2639command line.
2640@end table
2641
2642The behaviour for shared libraries on their own can also be controlled
2643by the @option{--[no-]allow-shlib-undefined} option.
2644
2645Normally the linker will generate an error message for each reported
2646unresolved symbol but the option @option{--warn-unresolved-symbols}
2647can change this to a warning.
2648
1715a13c
L
2649@kindex --verbose[=@var{NUMBER}]
2650@cindex verbose[=@var{NUMBER}]
252b5132 2651@item --dll-verbose
1715a13c 2652@itemx --verbose[=@var{NUMBER}]
ff5dcc92 2653Display the version number for @command{ld} and list the linker emulations
252b5132 2654supported. Display which input files can and cannot be opened. Display
1715a13c
L
2655the linker script being used by the linker. If the optional @var{NUMBER}
2656argument > 1, plugin symbol status will also be displayed.
252b5132
RH
2657
2658@kindex --version-script=@var{version-scriptfile}
2659@cindex version script, symbol versions
2509a395 2660@item --version-script=@var{version-scriptfile}
252b5132
RH
2661Specify the name of a version script to the linker. This is typically
2662used when creating shared libraries to specify additional information
36f63dca 2663about the version hierarchy for the library being created. This option
09e2aba4
DK
2664is only fully supported on ELF platforms which support shared libraries;
2665see @ref{VERSION}. It is partially supported on PE platforms, which can
2666use version scripts to filter symbol visibility in auto-export mode: any
2667symbols marked @samp{local} in the version script will not be exported.
2668@xref{WIN32}.
252b5132 2669
7ce691ae 2670@kindex --warn-common
252b5132
RH
2671@cindex warnings, on combining symbols
2672@cindex combining symbols, warnings on
2673@item --warn-common
2674Warn when a common symbol is combined with another common symbol or with
11e7fd74 2675a symbol definition. Unix linkers allow this somewhat sloppy practice,
252b5132
RH
2676but linkers on some other operating systems do not. This option allows
2677you to find potential problems from combining global symbols.
11e7fd74 2678Unfortunately, some C libraries use this practice, so you may get some
252b5132
RH
2679warnings about symbols in the libraries as well as in your programs.
2680
2681There are three kinds of global symbols, illustrated here by C examples:
2682
2683@table @samp
2684@item int i = 1;
2685A definition, which goes in the initialized data section of the output
2686file.
2687
2688@item extern int i;
2689An undefined reference, which does not allocate space.
2690There must be either a definition or a common symbol for the
2691variable somewhere.
2692
2693@item int i;
2694A common symbol. If there are only (one or more) common symbols for a
2695variable, it goes in the uninitialized data area of the output file.
2696The linker merges multiple common symbols for the same variable into a
2697single symbol. If they are of different sizes, it picks the largest
2698size. The linker turns a common symbol into a declaration, if there is
2699a definition of the same variable.
2700@end table
2701
2702The @samp{--warn-common} option can produce five kinds of warnings.
2703Each warning consists of a pair of lines: the first describes the symbol
2704just encountered, and the second describes the previous symbol
2705encountered with the same name. One or both of the two symbols will be
2706a common symbol.
2707
2708@enumerate
2709@item
2710Turning a common symbol into a reference, because there is already a
2711definition for the symbol.
2712@smallexample
2713@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: common of `@var{symbol}'
2714 overridden by definition
2715@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: defined here
2716@end smallexample
2717
2718@item
2719Turning a common symbol into a reference, because a later definition for
2720the symbol is encountered. This is the same as the previous case,
2721except that the symbols are encountered in a different order.
2722@smallexample
2723@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: definition of `@var{symbol}'
2724 overriding common
2725@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: common is here
2726@end smallexample
2727
2728@item
2729Merging a common symbol with a previous same-sized common symbol.
2730@smallexample
2731@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: multiple common
2732 of `@var{symbol}'
2733@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: previous common is here
2734@end smallexample
2735
2736@item
2737Merging a common symbol with a previous larger common symbol.
2738@smallexample
2739@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: common of `@var{symbol}'
2740 overridden by larger common
2741@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: larger common is here
2742@end smallexample
2743
2744@item
2745Merging a common symbol with a previous smaller common symbol. This is
2746the same as the previous case, except that the symbols are
2747encountered in a different order.
2748@smallexample
2749@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: common of `@var{symbol}'
2750 overriding smaller common
2751@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: smaller common is here
2752@end smallexample
2753@end enumerate
2754
2755@kindex --warn-constructors
2756@item --warn-constructors
2757Warn if any global constructors are used. This is only useful for a few
2758object file formats. For formats like COFF or ELF, the linker can not
2759detect the use of global constructors.
2760
65daf5be 2761@kindex --warn-execstack
bd7d326d 2762@cindex warnings, on executable stack
65daf5be
NC
2763@cindex executable stack, warnings on
2764@item --warn-execstack
2765@itemx --no-warn-execstack
2766On ELF platforms this option controls how the linker generates warning
2767messages when it creates an output file with an executable stack. By
2768default the linker will not warn if the @command{-z execstack} command
2769line option has been used, but this behaviour can be overridden by the
2770@option{--warn-execstack} option.
2771
2772On the other hand the linker will normally warn if the stack is made
2773executable because one or more of the input files need an execuable
2774stack and neither of the @command{-z execstack} or @command{-z
bd7d326d 2775noexecstack} command line options have been specified. This warning
65daf5be
NC
2776can be disabled via the @command{--no-warn-execstack} option.
2777
2778Note: ELF format input files specify that they need an executable
2779stack by having a @var{.note.GNU-stack} section with the executable
2780bit set in its section flags. They can specify that they do not need
2781an executable stack by having that section, but without the executable
2782flag bit set. If an input file does not have a @var{.note.GNU-stack}
2783section present then the default behaviour is target specific. For
2784some targets, then absence of such a section implies that an
2785executable stack @emph{is} required. This is often a problem for hand
2786crafted assembler files.
2787
252b5132
RH
2788@kindex --warn-multiple-gp
2789@item --warn-multiple-gp
2790Warn if multiple global pointer values are required in the output file.
2791This is only meaningful for certain processors, such as the Alpha.
2792Specifically, some processors put large-valued constants in a special
2793section. A special register (the global pointer) points into the middle
2794of this section, so that constants can be loaded efficiently via a
2795base-register relative addressing mode. Since the offset in
2796base-register relative mode is fixed and relatively small (e.g., 16
2797bits), this limits the maximum size of the constant pool. Thus, in
2798large programs, it is often necessary to use multiple global pointer
2799values in order to be able to address all possible constants. This
2800option causes a warning to be issued whenever this case occurs.
2801
2802@kindex --warn-once
2803@cindex warnings, on undefined symbols
2804@cindex undefined symbols, warnings on
2805@item --warn-once
2806Only warn once for each undefined symbol, rather than once per module
2807which refers to it.
2808
ba951afb
NC
2809@kindex --warn-rwx-segments
2810@cindex warnings, on writeable and exectuable segments
2811@cindex executable segments, warnings on
2812@item --warn-rwx-segments
2813@itemx --no-warn-rwx-segments
2814Warn if the linker creates a loadable, non-zero sized segment that has
2815all three of the read, write and execute permission flags set. Such a
2816segment represents a potential security vulnerability. In addition
2817warnings will be generated if a thread local storage segment is
2818created with the execute permission flag set, regardless of whether or
2819not it has the read and/or write flags set.
2820
2821These warnings are enabled by default. They can be disabled via the
2822@option{--no-warn-rwx-segments} option and re-enabled via the
2823@option{--warn-rwx-segments} option.
2824
252b5132
RH
2825@kindex --warn-section-align
2826@cindex warnings, on section alignment
2827@cindex section alignment, warnings on
2828@item --warn-section-align
2829Warn if the address of an output section is changed because of
2830alignment. Typically, the alignment will be set by an input section.
2831The address will only be changed if it not explicitly specified; that
2832is, if the @code{SECTIONS} command does not specify a start address for
2833the section (@pxref{SECTIONS}).
2834
a6dbf402
L
2835@kindex --warn-textrel
2836@item --warn-textrel
2837Warn if the linker adds DT_TEXTREL to a position-independent executable
2838or shared object.
8fdd7217 2839
a0c402a5
L
2840@kindex --warn-alternate-em
2841@item --warn-alternate-em
2842Warn if an object has alternate ELF machine code.
2843
560e09e9
NC
2844@kindex --warn-unresolved-symbols
2845@item --warn-unresolved-symbols
2846If the linker is going to report an unresolved symbol (see the option
2847@option{--unresolved-symbols}) it will normally generate an error.
2848This option makes it generate a warning instead.
2849
2850@kindex --error-unresolved-symbols
2851@item --error-unresolved-symbols
2852This restores the linker's default behaviour of generating errors when
2853it is reporting unresolved symbols.
2854
252b5132
RH
2855@kindex --whole-archive
2856@cindex including an entire archive
2857@item --whole-archive
2858For each archive mentioned on the command line after the
ff5dcc92 2859@option{--whole-archive} option, include every object file in the archive
252b5132
RH
2860in the link, rather than searching the archive for the required object
2861files. This is normally used to turn an archive file into a shared
2862library, forcing every object to be included in the resulting shared
2863library. This option may be used more than once.
2864
7ec229ce 2865Two notes when using this option from gcc: First, gcc doesn't know
ff5dcc92
SC
2866about this option, so you have to use @option{-Wl,-whole-archive}.
2867Second, don't forget to use @option{-Wl,-no-whole-archive} after your
7ec229ce
DD
2868list of archives, because gcc will add its own list of archives to
2869your link and you may not want this flag to affect those as well.
2870
2509a395
SL
2871@kindex --wrap=@var{symbol}
2872@item --wrap=@var{symbol}
252b5132
RH
2873Use a wrapper function for @var{symbol}. Any undefined reference to
2874@var{symbol} will be resolved to @code{__wrap_@var{symbol}}. Any
2875undefined reference to @code{__real_@var{symbol}} will be resolved to
2876@var{symbol}.
2877
2878This can be used to provide a wrapper for a system function. The
2879wrapper function should be called @code{__wrap_@var{symbol}}. If it
2880wishes to call the system function, it should call
2881@code{__real_@var{symbol}}.
2882
2883Here is a trivial example:
2884
2885@smallexample
2886void *
cc2f008e 2887__wrap_malloc (size_t c)
252b5132 2888@{
cc2f008e 2889 printf ("malloc called with %zu\n", c);
252b5132
RH
2890 return __real_malloc (c);
2891@}
2892@end smallexample
2893
ff5dcc92 2894If you link other code with this file using @option{--wrap malloc}, then
252b5132
RH
2895all calls to @code{malloc} will call the function @code{__wrap_malloc}
2896instead. The call to @code{__real_malloc} in @code{__wrap_malloc} will
2897call the real @code{malloc} function.
2898
2899You may wish to provide a @code{__real_malloc} function as well, so that
ff5dcc92 2900links without the @option{--wrap} option will succeed. If you do this,
252b5132
RH
2901you should not put the definition of @code{__real_malloc} in the same
2902file as @code{__wrap_malloc}; if you do, the assembler may resolve the
2903call before the linker has a chance to wrap it to @code{malloc}.
2904
4ea904ed
SH
2905Only undefined references are replaced by the linker. So, translation unit
2906internal references to @var{symbol} are not resolved to
2907@code{__wrap_@var{symbol}}. In the next example, the call to @code{f} in
2908@code{g} is not resolved to @code{__wrap_f}.
2909
2910@smallexample
2911int
2912f (void)
2913@{
2914 return 123;
2915@}
2916
2917int
2918g (void)
2919@{
2920 return f();
2921@}
2922@end smallexample
2923
6aa29e7b 2924@kindex --eh-frame-hdr
29063f8b 2925@kindex --no-eh-frame-hdr
6aa29e7b 2926@item --eh-frame-hdr
29063f8b
NC
2927@itemx --no-eh-frame-hdr
2928Request (@option{--eh-frame-hdr}) or suppress
2929(@option{--no-eh-frame-hdr}) the creation of @code{.eh_frame_hdr}
2930section and ELF @code{PT_GNU_EH_FRAME} segment header.
6aa29e7b 2931
e41b3a13
JJ
2932@kindex --ld-generated-unwind-info
2933@item --no-ld-generated-unwind-info
2934Request creation of @code{.eh_frame} unwind info for linker
2935generated code sections like PLT. This option is on by default
cf0e0a0b 2936if linker generated unwind info is supported. This option also
1bd123bd 2937controls the generation of @code{.sframe} stack trace info for linker
cf0e0a0b 2938generated code sections like PLT.
e41b3a13 2939
6c1439be
L
2940@kindex --enable-new-dtags
2941@kindex --disable-new-dtags
2942@item --enable-new-dtags
2943@itemx --disable-new-dtags
2944This linker can create the new dynamic tags in ELF. But the older ELF
2945systems may not understand them. If you specify
b1b00fcc
MF
2946@option{--enable-new-dtags}, the new dynamic tags will be created as needed
2947and older dynamic tags will be omitted.
ff5dcc92 2948If you specify @option{--disable-new-dtags}, no new dynamic tags will be
6c1439be
L
2949created. By default, the new dynamic tags are not created. Note that
2950those options are only available for ELF systems.
2951
2d643429 2952@kindex --hash-size=@var{number}
e185dd51 2953@item --hash-size=@var{number}
2d643429
NC
2954Set the default size of the linker's hash tables to a prime number
2955close to @var{number}. Increasing this value can reduce the length of
2956time it takes the linker to perform its tasks, at the expense of
2957increasing the linker's memory requirements. Similarly reducing this
2958value can reduce the memory requirements at the expense of speed.
2959
fdc90cb4
JJ
2960@kindex --hash-style=@var{style}
2961@item --hash-style=@var{style}
2962Set the type of linker's hash table(s). @var{style} can be either
2963@code{sysv} for classic ELF @code{.hash} section, @code{gnu} for
2964new style GNU @code{.gnu.hash} section or @code{both} for both
2965the classic ELF @code{.hash} and new style GNU @code{.gnu.hash}
c8455dc9
NC
2966hash tables. The default depends upon how the linker was configured,
2967but for most Linux based systems it will be @code{both}.
fdc90cb4 2968
0ce398f1
L
2969@kindex --compress-debug-sections=none
2970@kindex --compress-debug-sections=zlib
2971@kindex --compress-debug-sections=zlib-gnu
2972@kindex --compress-debug-sections=zlib-gabi
2cac01e3 2973@kindex --compress-debug-sections=zstd
0ce398f1
L
2974@item --compress-debug-sections=none
2975@itemx --compress-debug-sections=zlib
2976@itemx --compress-debug-sections=zlib-gnu
2977@itemx --compress-debug-sections=zlib-gabi
2cac01e3 2978@itemx --compress-debug-sections=zstd
9af89fba
NC
2979On ELF platforms, these options control how DWARF debug sections are
2980compressed using zlib.
2981
2982@option{--compress-debug-sections=none} doesn't compress DWARF debug
2983sections. @option{--compress-debug-sections=zlib-gnu} compresses
2984DWARF debug sections and renames them to begin with @samp{.zdebug}
2985instead of @samp{.debug}. @option{--compress-debug-sections=zlib-gabi}
2986also compresses DWARF debug sections, but rather than renaming them it
2987sets the SHF_COMPRESSED flag in the sections' headers.
2988
2989The @option{--compress-debug-sections=zlib} option is an alias for
2990@option{--compress-debug-sections=zlib-gabi}.
2991
2cac01e3
FS
2992@option{--compress-debug-sections=zstd} compresses DWARF debug sections using
2993zstd.
2994
9af89fba
NC
2995Note that this option overrides any compression in input debug
2996sections, so if a binary is linked with @option{--compress-debug-sections=none}
2997for example, then any compressed debug sections in input files will be
2998uncompressed before they are copied into the output binary.
2999
3000The default compression behaviour varies depending upon the target
3001involved and the configure options used to build the toolchain. The
3002default can be determined by examining the output from the linker's
3003@option{--help} option.
0ce398f1 3004
35835446
JR
3005@kindex --reduce-memory-overheads
3006@item --reduce-memory-overheads
3007This option reduces memory requirements at ld runtime, at the expense of
f2a8f148 3008linking speed. This was introduced to select the old O(n^2) algorithm
35835446 3009for link map file generation, rather than the new O(n) algorithm which uses
2d643429
NC
3010about 40% more memory for symbol storage.
3011
4f9c04f7 3012Another effect of the switch is to set the default hash table size to
2d643429 30131021, which again saves memory at the cost of lengthening the linker's
a85785bc 3014run time. This is not done however if the @option{--hash-size} switch
2d643429
NC
3015has been used.
3016
3017The @option{--reduce-memory-overheads} switch may be also be used to
3018enable other tradeoffs in future versions of the linker.
35835446 3019
a8dde0a2
L
3020@kindex --max-cache-size=@var{size}
3021@item --max-cache-size=@var{size}
3022@command{ld} normally caches the relocation information and symbol tables
3023of input files in memory with the unlimited size. This option sets the
3024maximum cache size to @var{size}.
3025
c0065db7
RM
3026@kindex --build-id
3027@kindex --build-id=@var{style}
3028@item --build-id
3029@itemx --build-id=@var{style}
61e2488c 3030Request the creation of a @code{.note.gnu.build-id} ELF note section
6033bf41 3031or a @code{.buildid} COFF section. The contents of the note are
61e2488c
JT
3032unique bits identifying this linked file. @var{style} can be
3033@code{uuid} to use 128 random bits, @code{sha1} to use a 160-bit
3034@sc{SHA1} hash on the normative parts of the output contents,
3035@code{md5} to use a 128-bit @sc{MD5} hash on the normative parts of
3036the output contents, or @code{0x@var{hexstring}} to use a chosen bit
3037string specified as an even number of hexadecimal digits (@code{-} and
3038@code{:} characters between digit pairs are ignored). If @var{style}
3039is omitted, @code{sha1} is used.
24382dca
RM
3040
3041The @code{md5} and @code{sha1} styles produces an identifier
3042that is always the same in an identical output file, but will be
3043unique among all nonidentical output files. It is not intended
3044to be compared as a checksum for the file's contents. A linked
3045file may be changed later by other tools, but the build ID bit
3046string identifying the original linked file does not change.
c0065db7
RM
3047
3048Passing @code{none} for @var{style} disables the setting from any
3049@code{--build-id} options earlier on the command line.
9e2bb0cb
LB
3050
3051@kindex --package-metadata=@var{JSON}
3052@item --package-metadata=@var{JSON}
3053Request the creation of a @code{.note.package} ELF note section. The
3054contents of the note are in JSON format, as per the package metadata
3055specification. For more information see:
3056https://systemd.io/ELF_PACKAGE_METADATA/
3057If the JSON argument is missing/empty then this will disable the
3058creation of the metadata note, if one had been enabled by an earlier
3059occurrence of the --package-metdata option.
3060If the linker has been built with libjansson, then the JSON string
3061will be validated.
252b5132
RH
3062@end table
3063
0285c67d
NC
3064@c man end
3065
36f63dca 3066@subsection Options Specific to i386 PE Targets
252b5132 3067
0285c67d
NC
3068@c man begin OPTIONS
3069
ff5dcc92 3070The i386 PE linker supports the @option{-shared} option, which causes
252b5132
RH
3071the output to be a dynamically linked library (DLL) instead of a
3072normal executable. You should name the output @code{*.dll} when you
3073use this option. In addition, the linker fully supports the standard
3074@code{*.def} files, which may be specified on the linker command line
3075like an object file (in fact, it should precede archives it exports
3076symbols from, to ensure that they get linked in, just like a normal
3077object file).
3078
3079In addition to the options common to all targets, the i386 PE linker
a05a5b64 3080support additional command-line options that are specific to the i386
252b5132
RH
3081PE target. Options that take values may be separated from their
3082values by either a space or an equals sign.
3083
ff5dcc92 3084@table @gcctabopt
252b5132
RH
3085
3086@kindex --add-stdcall-alias
3087@item --add-stdcall-alias
3088If given, symbols with a stdcall suffix (@@@var{nn}) will be exported
3089as-is and also with the suffix stripped.
bb10df36 3090[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3091
3092@kindex --base-file
3093@item --base-file @var{file}
3094Use @var{file} as the name of a file in which to save the base
3095addresses of all the relocations needed for generating DLLs with
3096@file{dlltool}.
bb10df36 3097[This is an i386 PE specific option]
252b5132
RH
3098
3099@kindex --dll
3100@item --dll
3101Create a DLL instead of a regular executable. You may also use
ff5dcc92 3102@option{-shared} or specify a @code{LIBRARY} in a given @code{.def}
252b5132 3103file.
bb10df36 3104[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132 3105
88183869
DK
3106@kindex --enable-long-section-names
3107@kindex --disable-long-section-names
3108@item --enable-long-section-names
3109@itemx --disable-long-section-names
56e6cf80 3110The PE variants of the COFF object format add an extension that permits
88183869 3111the use of section names longer than eight characters, the normal limit
56e6cf80
NC
3112for COFF. By default, these names are only allowed in object files, as
3113fully-linked executable images do not carry the COFF string table required
88183869
DK
3114to support the longer names. As a GNU extension, it is possible to
3115allow their use in executable images as well, or to (probably pointlessly!)
3116disallow it in object files, by using these two options. Executable images
3117generated with these long section names are slightly non-standard, carrying
3118as they do a string table, and may generate confusing output when examined
9d5777a3
RM
3119with non-GNU PE-aware tools, such as file viewers and dumpers. However,
3120GDB relies on the use of PE long section names to find Dwarf-2 debug
3efd345c
DK
3121information sections in an executable image at runtime, and so if neither
3122option is specified on the command-line, @command{ld} will enable long
3123section names, overriding the default and technically correct behaviour,
3124when it finds the presence of debug information while linking an executable
3125image and not stripping symbols.
88183869
DK
3126[This option is valid for all PE targeted ports of the linker]
3127
252b5132
RH
3128@kindex --enable-stdcall-fixup
3129@kindex --disable-stdcall-fixup
3130@item --enable-stdcall-fixup
3131@itemx --disable-stdcall-fixup
3132If the link finds a symbol that it cannot resolve, it will attempt to
36f63dca 3133do ``fuzzy linking'' by looking for another defined symbol that differs
252b5132
RH
3134only in the format of the symbol name (cdecl vs stdcall) and will
3135resolve that symbol by linking to the match. For example, the
3136undefined symbol @code{_foo} might be linked to the function
3137@code{_foo@@12}, or the undefined symbol @code{_bar@@16} might be linked
3138to the function @code{_bar}. When the linker does this, it prints a
3139warning, since it normally should have failed to link, but sometimes
3140import libraries generated from third-party dlls may need this feature
ff5dcc92 3141to be usable. If you specify @option{--enable-stdcall-fixup}, this
252b5132 3142feature is fully enabled and warnings are not printed. If you specify
ff5dcc92 3143@option{--disable-stdcall-fixup}, this feature is disabled and such
252b5132 3144mismatches are considered to be errors.
bb10df36 3145[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132 3146
522f09cd
KT
3147@kindex --leading-underscore
3148@kindex --no-leading-underscore
3149@item --leading-underscore
3150@itemx --no-leading-underscore
3151For most targets default symbol-prefix is an underscore and is defined
3152in target's description. By this option it is possible to
3153disable/enable the default underscore symbol-prefix.
3154
252b5132
RH
3155@cindex DLLs, creating
3156@kindex --export-all-symbols
3157@item --export-all-symbols
3158If given, all global symbols in the objects used to build a DLL will
3159be exported by the DLL. Note that this is the default if there
3160otherwise wouldn't be any exported symbols. When symbols are
3161explicitly exported via DEF files or implicitly exported via function
3162attributes, the default is to not export anything else unless this
3163option is given. Note that the symbols @code{DllMain@@12},
ece2d90e 3164@code{DllEntryPoint@@0}, @code{DllMainCRTStartup@@12}, and
b044cda1 3165@code{impure_ptr} will not be automatically
ece2d90e
NC
3166exported. Also, symbols imported from other DLLs will not be
3167re-exported, nor will symbols specifying the DLL's internal layout
3168such as those beginning with @code{_head_} or ending with
3169@code{_iname}. In addition, no symbols from @code{libgcc},
b044cda1
CW
3170@code{libstd++}, @code{libmingw32}, or @code{crtX.o} will be exported.
3171Symbols whose names begin with @code{__rtti_} or @code{__builtin_} will
3172not be exported, to help with C++ DLLs. Finally, there is an
ece2d90e 3173extensive list of cygwin-private symbols that are not exported
b044cda1 3174(obviously, this applies on when building DLLs for cygwin targets).
ece2d90e 3175These cygwin-excludes are: @code{_cygwin_dll_entry@@12},
b044cda1 3176@code{_cygwin_crt0_common@@8}, @code{_cygwin_noncygwin_dll_entry@@12},
ece2d90e 3177@code{_fmode}, @code{_impure_ptr}, @code{cygwin_attach_dll},
b044cda1 3178@code{cygwin_premain0}, @code{cygwin_premain1}, @code{cygwin_premain2},
ece2d90e 3179@code{cygwin_premain3}, and @code{environ}.
bb10df36 3180[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3181
3182@kindex --exclude-symbols
1d0a3c9c 3183@item --exclude-symbols @var{symbol},@var{symbol},...
252b5132
RH
3184Specifies a list of symbols which should not be automatically
3185exported. The symbol names may be delimited by commas or colons.
bb10df36 3186[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132 3187
2927aaca
NC
3188@kindex --exclude-all-symbols
3189@item --exclude-all-symbols
3190Specifies no symbols should be automatically exported.
3191[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3192
252b5132
RH
3193@kindex --file-alignment
3194@item --file-alignment
3195Specify the file alignment. Sections in the file will always begin at
3196file offsets which are multiples of this number. This defaults to
3197512.
bb10df36 3198[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3199
3200@cindex heap size
3201@kindex --heap
3202@item --heap @var{reserve}
3203@itemx --heap @var{reserve},@var{commit}
a00b50c5 3204Specify the number of bytes of memory to reserve (and optionally commit)
fe6d7d6a 3205to be used as heap for this program. The default is 1MB reserved, 4K
252b5132 3206committed.
bb10df36 3207[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3208
3209@cindex image base
3210@kindex --image-base
3211@item --image-base @var{value}
3212Use @var{value} as the base address of your program or dll. This is
3213the lowest memory location that will be used when your program or dll
3214is loaded. To reduce the need to relocate and improve performance of
3215your dlls, each should have a unique base address and not overlap any
3216other dlls. The default is 0x400000 for executables, and 0x10000000
3217for dlls.
bb10df36 3218[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3219
3220@kindex --kill-at
3221@item --kill-at
3222If given, the stdcall suffixes (@@@var{nn}) will be stripped from
3223symbols before they are exported.
bb10df36 3224[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132 3225
26d2d8a2
BF
3226@kindex --large-address-aware
3227@item --large-address-aware
b45619c0 3228If given, the appropriate bit in the ``Characteristics'' field of the COFF
26d2d8a2 3229header is set to indicate that this executable supports virtual addresses
b45619c0 3230greater than 2 gigabytes. This should be used in conjunction with the /3GB
26d2d8a2
BF
3231or /USERVA=@var{value} megabytes switch in the ``[operating systems]''
3232section of the BOOT.INI. Otherwise, this bit has no effect.
3233[This option is specific to PE targeted ports of the linker]
3234
f69a2f97
NC
3235@kindex --disable-large-address-aware
3236@item --disable-large-address-aware
3237Reverts the effect of a previous @samp{--large-address-aware} option.
3238This is useful if @samp{--large-address-aware} is always set by the compiler
3239driver (e.g. Cygwin gcc) and the executable does not support virtual
3240addresses greater than 2 gigabytes.
3241[This option is specific to PE targeted ports of the linker]
3242
252b5132
RH
3243@kindex --major-image-version
3244@item --major-image-version @var{value}
36f63dca 3245Sets the major number of the ``image version''. Defaults to 1.
bb10df36 3246[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3247
3248@kindex --major-os-version
3249@item --major-os-version @var{value}
36f63dca 3250Sets the major number of the ``os version''. Defaults to 4.
bb10df36 3251[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3252
3253@kindex --major-subsystem-version
3254@item --major-subsystem-version @var{value}
36f63dca 3255Sets the major number of the ``subsystem version''. Defaults to 4.
bb10df36 3256[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3257
3258@kindex --minor-image-version
3259@item --minor-image-version @var{value}
36f63dca 3260Sets the minor number of the ``image version''. Defaults to 0.
bb10df36 3261[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3262
3263@kindex --minor-os-version
3264@item --minor-os-version @var{value}
36f63dca 3265Sets the minor number of the ``os version''. Defaults to 0.
bb10df36 3266[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3267
3268@kindex --minor-subsystem-version
3269@item --minor-subsystem-version @var{value}
36f63dca 3270Sets the minor number of the ``subsystem version''. Defaults to 0.
bb10df36 3271[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3272
3273@cindex DEF files, creating
3274@cindex DLLs, creating
3275@kindex --output-def
3276@item --output-def @var{file}
3277The linker will create the file @var{file} which will contain a DEF
3278file corresponding to the DLL the linker is generating. This DEF file
3279(which should be called @code{*.def}) may be used to create an import
3280library with @code{dlltool} or may be used as a reference to
3281automatically or implicitly exported symbols.
bb10df36 3282[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132 3283
b044cda1 3284@cindex DLLs, creating
b044cda1
CW
3285@kindex --enable-auto-image-base
3286@item --enable-auto-image-base
d0e6d77b
CF
3287@itemx --enable-auto-image-base=@var{value}
3288Automatically choose the image base for DLLs, optionally starting with base
3289@var{value}, unless one is specified using the @code{--image-base} argument.
3290By using a hash generated from the dllname to create unique image bases
3291for each DLL, in-memory collisions and relocations which can delay program
3292execution are avoided.
bb10df36 3293[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
b044cda1
CW
3294
3295@kindex --disable-auto-image-base
3296@item --disable-auto-image-base
3297Do not automatically generate a unique image base. If there is no
3298user-specified image base (@code{--image-base}) then use the platform
3299default.
bb10df36 3300[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
b044cda1
CW
3301
3302@cindex DLLs, linking to
3303@kindex --dll-search-prefix
3304@item --dll-search-prefix @var{string}
489d0400 3305When linking dynamically to a dll without an import library,
ece2d90e 3306search for @code{<string><basename>.dll} in preference to
560e09e9 3307@code{lib<basename>.dll}. This behaviour allows easy distinction
b044cda1
CW
3308between DLLs built for the various "subplatforms": native, cygwin,
3309uwin, pw, etc. For instance, cygwin DLLs typically use
ece2d90e 3310@code{--dll-search-prefix=cyg}.
bb10df36 3311[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
b044cda1
CW
3312
3313@kindex --enable-auto-import
3314@item --enable-auto-import
ece2d90e 3315Do sophisticated linking of @code{_symbol} to @code{__imp__symbol} for
317ff008
EB
3316DATA imports from DLLs, thus making it possible to bypass the dllimport
3317mechanism on the user side and to reference unmangled symbol names.
3318[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3319
3320The following remarks pertain to the original implementation of the
3321feature and are obsolete nowadays for Cygwin and MinGW targets.
3322
3323Note: Use of the 'auto-import' extension will cause the text section
3324of the image file to be made writable. This does not conform to the
3325PE-COFF format specification published by Microsoft.
4d8907ac 3326
e2a83dd0
NC
3327Note - use of the 'auto-import' extension will also cause read only
3328data which would normally be placed into the .rdata section to be
3329placed into the .data section instead. This is in order to work
3330around a problem with consts that is described here:
3331http://www.cygwin.com/ml/cygwin/2004-09/msg01101.html
3332
4d8907ac
DS
3333Using 'auto-import' generally will 'just work' -- but sometimes you may
3334see this message:
0d888aac 3335
ece2d90e 3336"variable '<var>' can't be auto-imported. Please read the
0d888aac
CW
3337documentation for ld's @code{--enable-auto-import} for details."
3338
ece2d90e
NC
3339This message occurs when some (sub)expression accesses an address
3340ultimately given by the sum of two constants (Win32 import tables only
c0065db7
RM
3341allow one). Instances where this may occur include accesses to member
3342fields of struct variables imported from a DLL, as well as using a
3343constant index into an array variable imported from a DLL. Any
2f8d8971
NC
3344multiword variable (arrays, structs, long long, etc) may trigger
3345this error condition. However, regardless of the exact data type
3346of the offending exported variable, ld will always detect it, issue
3347the warning, and exit.
3348
3349There are several ways to address this difficulty, regardless of the
3350data type of the exported variable:
0d888aac 3351
2fa9fc65
NC
3352One way is to use --enable-runtime-pseudo-reloc switch. This leaves the task
3353of adjusting references in your client code for runtime environment, so
560e09e9 3354this method works only when runtime environment supports this feature.
2fa9fc65 3355
c0065db7
RM
3356A second solution is to force one of the 'constants' to be a variable --
3357that is, unknown and un-optimizable at compile time. For arrays,
3358there are two possibilities: a) make the indexee (the array's address)
0d888aac
CW
3359a variable, or b) make the 'constant' index a variable. Thus:
3360
3361@example
3362extern type extern_array[];
c0065db7 3363extern_array[1] -->
0d888aac
CW
3364 @{ volatile type *t=extern_array; t[1] @}
3365@end example
3366
3367or
3368
3369@example
3370extern type extern_array[];
c0065db7 3371extern_array[1] -->
0d888aac
CW
3372 @{ volatile int t=1; extern_array[t] @}
3373@end example
3374
c0065db7 3375For structs (and most other multiword data types) the only option
2f8d8971 3376is to make the struct itself (or the long long, or the ...) variable:
0d888aac
CW
3377
3378@example
3379extern struct s extern_struct;
c0065db7 3380extern_struct.field -->
0d888aac
CW
3381 @{ volatile struct s *t=&extern_struct; t->field @}
3382@end example
3383
c406afaf
NC
3384or
3385
3386@example
3387extern long long extern_ll;
3388extern_ll -->
3389 @{ volatile long long * local_ll=&extern_ll; *local_ll @}
3390@end example
3391
2fa9fc65 3392A third method of dealing with this difficulty is to abandon
c0065db7 3393'auto-import' for the offending symbol and mark it with
11e7fd74 3394@code{__declspec(dllimport)}. However, in practice that
0d888aac 3395requires using compile-time #defines to indicate whether you are
c0065db7
RM
3396building a DLL, building client code that will link to the DLL, or
3397merely building/linking to a static library. In making the choice
3398between the various methods of resolving the 'direct address with
0d888aac
CW
3399constant offset' problem, you should consider typical real-world usage:
3400
3401Original:
3402@example
3403--foo.h
3404extern int arr[];
3405--foo.c
3406#include "foo.h"
3407void main(int argc, char **argv)@{
3408 printf("%d\n",arr[1]);
3409@}
3410@end example
3411
3412Solution 1:
3413@example
3414--foo.h
3415extern int arr[];
3416--foo.c
3417#include "foo.h"
3418void main(int argc, char **argv)@{
3419 /* This workaround is for win32 and cygwin; do not "optimize" */
3420 volatile int *parr = arr;
3421 printf("%d\n",parr[1]);
3422@}
3423@end example
3424
3425Solution 2:
3426@example
3427--foo.h
3428/* Note: auto-export is assumed (no __declspec(dllexport)) */
3429#if (defined(_WIN32) || defined(__CYGWIN__)) && \
3430 !(defined(FOO_BUILD_DLL) || defined(FOO_STATIC))
3431#define FOO_IMPORT __declspec(dllimport)
3432#else
3433#define FOO_IMPORT
3434#endif
3435extern FOO_IMPORT int arr[];
3436--foo.c
3437#include "foo.h"
3438void main(int argc, char **argv)@{
3439 printf("%d\n",arr[1]);
3440@}
3441@end example
3442
c0065db7 3443A fourth way to avoid this problem is to re-code your
0d888aac
CW
3444library to use a functional interface rather than a data interface
3445for the offending variables (e.g. set_foo() and get_foo() accessor
3446functions).
b044cda1
CW
3447
3448@kindex --disable-auto-import
3449@item --disable-auto-import
c0065db7 3450Do not attempt to do sophisticated linking of @code{_symbol} to
b044cda1 3451@code{__imp__symbol} for DATA imports from DLLs.
bb10df36 3452[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
b044cda1 3453
2fa9fc65
NC
3454@kindex --enable-runtime-pseudo-reloc
3455@item --enable-runtime-pseudo-reloc
3456If your code contains expressions described in --enable-auto-import section,
3457that is, DATA imports from DLL with non-zero offset, this switch will create
3458a vector of 'runtime pseudo relocations' which can be used by runtime
c0065db7 3459environment to adjust references to such data in your client code.
bb10df36 3460[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2fa9fc65
NC
3461
3462@kindex --disable-runtime-pseudo-reloc
3463@item --disable-runtime-pseudo-reloc
317ff008 3464Do not create pseudo relocations for non-zero offset DATA imports from DLLs.
bb10df36 3465[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2fa9fc65 3466
b044cda1
CW
3467@kindex --enable-extra-pe-debug
3468@item --enable-extra-pe-debug
3469Show additional debug info related to auto-import symbol thunking.
bb10df36 3470[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
b044cda1 3471
252b5132
RH
3472@kindex --section-alignment
3473@item --section-alignment
3474Sets the section alignment. Sections in memory will always begin at
3475addresses which are a multiple of this number. Defaults to 0x1000.
bb10df36 3476[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3477
3478@cindex stack size
3479@kindex --stack
3480@item --stack @var{reserve}
3481@itemx --stack @var{reserve},@var{commit}
a00b50c5 3482Specify the number of bytes of memory to reserve (and optionally commit)
fe6d7d6a 3483to be used as stack for this program. The default is 2MB reserved, 4K
252b5132 3484committed.
bb10df36 3485[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3486
3487@kindex --subsystem
3488@item --subsystem @var{which}
3489@itemx --subsystem @var{which}:@var{major}
3490@itemx --subsystem @var{which}:@var{major}.@var{minor}
3491Specifies the subsystem under which your program will execute. The
3492legal values for @var{which} are @code{native}, @code{windows},
33f362e1
NC
3493@code{console}, @code{posix}, and @code{xbox}. You may optionally set
3494the subsystem version also. Numeric values are also accepted for
3495@var{which}.
bb10df36 3496[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132 3497
2f563b51
DK
3498The following options set flags in the @code{DllCharacteristics} field
3499of the PE file header:
3500[These options are specific to PE targeted ports of the linker]
3501
2d5c3743
NC
3502@kindex --high-entropy-va
3503@item --high-entropy-va
514b4e19 3504@itemx --disable-high-entropy-va
2d5c3743 3505Image is compatible with 64-bit address space layout randomization
514b4e19
JD
3506(ASLR). This option is enabled by default for 64-bit PE images.
3507
dc9bd8c9
HD
3508This option also implies @option{--dynamicbase} and
3509@option{--enable-reloc-section}.
2d5c3743 3510
2f563b51
DK
3511@kindex --dynamicbase
3512@item --dynamicbase
514b4e19 3513@itemx --disable-dynamicbase
2f563b51
DK
3514The image base address may be relocated using address space layout
3515randomization (ASLR). This feature was introduced with MS Windows
514b4e19
JD
3516Vista for i386 PE targets. This option is enabled by default but
3517can be disabled via the @option{--disable-dynamicbase} option.
dc9bd8c9 3518This option also implies @option{--enable-reloc-section}.
2f563b51
DK
3519
3520@kindex --forceinteg
3521@item --forceinteg
514b4e19
JD
3522@itemx --disable-forceinteg
3523Code integrity checks are enforced. This option is disabled by
3524default.
2f563b51
DK
3525
3526@kindex --nxcompat
3527@item --nxcompat
514b4e19 3528@item --disable-nxcompat
2f563b51 3529The image is compatible with the Data Execution Prevention.
514b4e19
JD
3530This feature was introduced with MS Windows XP SP2 for i386 PE
3531targets. The option is enabled by default.
2f563b51
DK
3532
3533@kindex --no-isolation
3534@item --no-isolation
514b4e19 3535@itemx --disable-no-isolation
2f563b51 3536Although the image understands isolation, do not isolate the image.
514b4e19 3537This option is disabled by default.
2f563b51
DK
3538
3539@kindex --no-seh
3540@item --no-seh
514b4e19 3541@itemx --disable-no-seh
2f563b51 3542The image does not use SEH. No SE handler may be called from
514b4e19 3543this image. This option is disabled by default.
2f563b51
DK
3544
3545@kindex --no-bind
3546@item --no-bind
514b4e19
JD
3547@itemx --disable-no-bind
3548Do not bind this image. This option is disabled by default.
2f563b51
DK
3549
3550@kindex --wdmdriver
3551@item --wdmdriver
514b4e19
JD
3552@itemx --disable-wdmdriver
3553The driver uses the MS Windows Driver Model. This option is disabled
3554by default.
9d5777a3 3555
2f563b51
DK
3556@kindex --tsaware
3557@item --tsaware
514b4e19
JD
3558@itemx --disable-tsaware
3559The image is Terminal Server aware. This option is disabled by
3560default.
2f563b51 3561
0cb112f7
CF
3562@kindex --insert-timestamp
3563@item --insert-timestamp
eeb14e5a
LZ
3564@itemx --no-insert-timestamp
3565Insert a real timestamp into the image. This is the default behaviour
3566as it matches legacy code and it means that the image will work with
3567other, proprietary tools. The problem with this default is that it
56e6cf80 3568will result in slightly different images being produced each time the
eeb14e5a
LZ
3569same sources are linked. The option @option{--no-insert-timestamp}
3570can be used to insert a zero value for the timestamp, this ensuring
56e6cf80 3571that binaries produced from identical sources will compare
eeb14e5a 3572identically.
dc9bd8c9 3573
b5c37946
SJ
3574If @option{--insert-timestamp} is active then the time inserted is
3575either the time that the linking takes place or, if the
3576@code{SOURCE_DATE_EPOCH} environment variable is defined, the number
3577of seconds since Unix epoch as specified by that variable.
3578
dc9bd8c9
HD
3579@kindex --enable-reloc-section
3580@item --enable-reloc-section
514b4e19 3581@itemx --disable-reloc-section
dc9bd8c9
HD
3582Create the base relocation table, which is necessary if the image
3583is loaded at a different image base than specified in the PE header.
514b4e19 3584This option is enabled by default.
252b5132
RH
3585@end table
3586
0285c67d
NC
3587@c man end
3588
ac145307
BS
3589@ifset C6X
3590@subsection Options specific to C6X uClinux targets
3591
3592@c man begin OPTIONS
3593
3594The C6X uClinux target uses a binary format called DSBT to support shared
3595libraries. Each shared library in the system needs to have a unique index;
3596all executables use an index of 0.
3597
3598@table @gcctabopt
3599
3600@kindex --dsbt-size
3601@item --dsbt-size @var{size}
56e6cf80 3602This option sets the number of entries in the DSBT of the current executable
ac145307
BS
3603or shared library to @var{size}. The default is to create a table with 64
3604entries.
3605
3606@kindex --dsbt-index
3607@item --dsbt-index @var{index}
3608This option sets the DSBT index of the current executable or shared library
3609to @var{index}. The default is 0, which is appropriate for generating
3610executables. If a shared library is generated with a DSBT index of 0, the
3611@code{R_C6000_DSBT_INDEX} relocs are copied into the output file.
3612
fbd9ad90
PB
3613@kindex --no-merge-exidx-entries
3614The @samp{--no-merge-exidx-entries} switch disables the merging of adjacent
3615exidx entries in frame unwind info.
3616
ac145307
BS
3617@end table
3618
3619@c man end
3620@end ifset
3621
b8891f8d
AJ
3622@ifset CSKY
3623@subsection Options specific to C-SKY targets
3624
3625@c man begin OPTIONS
3626
3627@table @gcctabopt
3628
3629@kindex --branch-stub on C-SKY
3630@item --branch-stub
3631This option enables linker branch relaxation by inserting branch stub
3632sections when needed to extend the range of branches. This option is
3633usually not required since C-SKY supports branch and call instructions that
3634can access the full memory range and branch relaxation is normally handled by
3635the compiler or assembler.
3636
3637@kindex --stub-group-size on C-SKY
3638@item --stub-group-size=@var{N}
3639This option allows finer control of linker branch stub creation.
3640It sets the maximum size of a group of input sections that can
3641be handled by one stub section. A negative value of @var{N} locates
3642stub sections after their branches, while a positive value allows stub
3643sections to appear either before or after the branches. Values of
3644@samp{1} or @samp{-1} indicate that the
3645linker should choose suitable defaults.
3646
3647@end table
3648
3649@c man end
3650@end ifset
3651
93fd0973
SC
3652@ifset M68HC11
3653@subsection Options specific to Motorola 68HC11 and 68HC12 targets
3654
3655@c man begin OPTIONS
3656
3657The 68HC11 and 68HC12 linkers support specific options to control the
3658memory bank switching mapping and trampoline code generation.
3659
3660@table @gcctabopt
3661
3662@kindex --no-trampoline
3663@item --no-trampoline
3664This option disables the generation of trampoline. By default a trampoline
3665is generated for each far function which is called using a @code{jsr}
3666instruction (this happens when a pointer to a far function is taken).
3667
3668@kindex --bank-window
3669@item --bank-window @var{name}
3670This option indicates to the linker the name of the memory region in
3671the @samp{MEMORY} specification that describes the memory bank window.
3672The definition of such region is then used by the linker to compute
3673paging and addresses within the memory window.
3674
3675@end table
3676
3677@c man end
3678@end ifset
3679
7fb9f789
NC
3680@ifset M68K
3681@subsection Options specific to Motorola 68K target
3682
3683@c man begin OPTIONS
3684
3685The following options are supported to control handling of GOT generation
3686when linking for 68K targets.
3687
3688@table @gcctabopt
3689
3690@kindex --got
3691@item --got=@var{type}
3692This option tells the linker which GOT generation scheme to use.
3693@var{type} should be one of @samp{single}, @samp{negative},
3694@samp{multigot} or @samp{target}. For more information refer to the
3695Info entry for @file{ld}.
3696
3697@end table
3698
3699@c man end
3700@end ifset
3701
833794fc
MR
3702@ifset MIPS
3703@subsection Options specific to MIPS targets
3704
3705@c man begin OPTIONS
3706
3707The following options are supported to control microMIPS instruction
8b10b0b3
MR
3708generation and branch relocation checks for ISA mode transitions when
3709linking for MIPS targets.
833794fc
MR
3710
3711@table @gcctabopt
3712
3713@kindex --insn32
3714@item --insn32
3715@kindex --no-insn32
3716@itemx --no-insn32
3717These options control the choice of microMIPS instructions used in code
3718generated by the linker, such as that in the PLT or lazy binding stubs,
3719or in relaxation. If @samp{--insn32} is used, then the linker only uses
372032-bit instruction encodings. By default or if @samp{--no-insn32} is
3721used, all instruction encodings are used, including 16-bit ones where
3722possible.
3723
8b10b0b3
MR
3724@kindex --ignore-branch-isa
3725@item --ignore-branch-isa
3726@kindex --no-ignore-branch-isa
3727@itemx --no-ignore-branch-isa
3728These options control branch relocation checks for invalid ISA mode
3729transitions. If @samp{--ignore-branch-isa} is used, then the linker
3730accepts any branch relocations and any ISA mode transition required
3731is lost in relocation calculation, except for some cases of @code{BAL}
3732instructions which meet relaxation conditions and are converted to
3733equivalent @code{JALX} instructions as the associated relocation is
3734calculated. By default or if @samp{--no-ignore-branch-isa} is used
3735a check is made causing the loss of an ISA mode transition to produce
3736an error.
3737
3734320d
MF
3738@kindex --compact-branches
3739@item --compact-branches
3740@kindex --no-compact-branches
fa1477dc 3741@itemx --no-compact-branches
3734320d
MF
3742These options control the generation of compact instructions by the linker
3743in the PLT entries for MIPS R6.
3744
833794fc
MR
3745@end table
3746
3747@c man end
3748@end ifset
3749
fa1477dc
SC
3750
3751@ifset PDP11
3752@subsection Options specific to PDP11 targets
3753
3754@c man begin OPTIONS
3755
3756For the pdp11-aout target, three variants of the output format can be
3757produced as selected by the following options. The default variant
3758for pdp11-aout is the @samp{--omagic} option, whereas for other
3759targets @samp{--nmagic} is the default. The @samp{--imagic} option is
3760defined only for the pdp11-aout target, while the others are described
3761here as they apply to the pdp11-aout target.
3762
3763@table @gcctabopt
3764
3765@kindex -N
3766@item -N
3767@kindex --omagic
3768@itemx --omagic
3769
3770Mark the output as @code{OMAGIC} (0407) in the @file{a.out} header to
3771indicate that the text segment is not to be write-protected and
3772shared. Since the text and data sections are both readable and
3773writable, the data section is allocated immediately contiguous after
3774the text segment. This is the oldest format for PDP11 executable
3775programs and is the default for @command{ld} on PDP11 Unix systems
3776from the beginning through 2.11BSD.
3777
3778@kindex -n
3779@item -n
3780@kindex --nmagic
3781@itemx --nmagic
3782
3783Mark the output as @code{NMAGIC} (0410) in the @file{a.out} header to
3784indicate that when the output file is executed, the text portion will
3785be read-only and shareable among all processes executing the same
3786file. This involves moving the data areas up to the first possible 8K
3787byte page boundary following the end of the text. This option creates
3788a @emph{pure executable} format.
3789
3790@kindex -z
3791@item -z
3792@kindex --imagic
3793@itemx --imagic
3794
3795Mark the output as @code{IMAGIC} (0411) in the @file{a.out} header to
3796indicate that when the output file is executed, the program text and
3797data areas will be loaded into separate address spaces using the split
3798instruction and data space feature of the memory management unit in
3799larger models of the PDP11. This doubles the address space available
3800to the program. The text segment is again pure, write-protected, and
3801shareable. The only difference in the output format between this
3802option and the others, besides the magic number, is that both the text
3803and data sections start at location 0. The @samp{-z} option selected
3804this format in 2.11BSD. This option creates a @emph{separate
3805executable} format.
3806
3807@kindex --no-omagic
3808@item --no-omagic
3809
3810Equivalent to @samp{--nmagic} for pdp11-aout.
3811
3812@end table
3813
3814@c man end
3815@end ifset
3816
252b5132
RH
3817@ifset UsesEnvVars
3818@node Environment
3819@section Environment Variables
3820
0285c67d
NC
3821@c man begin ENVIRONMENT
3822
560e09e9 3823You can change the behaviour of @command{ld} with the environment variables
36f63dca
NC
3824@ifclear SingleFormat
3825@code{GNUTARGET},
3826@end ifclear
3827@code{LDEMULATION} and @code{COLLECT_NO_DEMANGLE}.
252b5132 3828
36f63dca 3829@ifclear SingleFormat
252b5132
RH
3830@kindex GNUTARGET
3831@cindex default input format
3832@code{GNUTARGET} determines the input-file object format if you don't
3833use @samp{-b} (or its synonym @samp{--format}). Its value should be one
3834of the BFD names for an input format (@pxref{BFD}). If there is no
ff5dcc92 3835@code{GNUTARGET} in the environment, @command{ld} uses the natural format
252b5132
RH
3836of the target. If @code{GNUTARGET} is set to @code{default} then BFD
3837attempts to discover the input format by examining binary input files;
3838this method often succeeds, but there are potential ambiguities, since
3839there is no method of ensuring that the magic number used to specify
3840object-file formats is unique. However, the configuration procedure for
3841BFD on each system places the conventional format for that system first
3842in the search-list, so ambiguities are resolved in favor of convention.
36f63dca 3843@end ifclear
252b5132
RH
3844
3845@kindex LDEMULATION
3846@cindex default emulation
3847@cindex emulation, default
3848@code{LDEMULATION} determines the default emulation if you don't use the
3849@samp{-m} option. The emulation can affect various aspects of linker
3850behaviour, particularly the default linker script. You can list the
3851available emulations with the @samp{--verbose} or @samp{-V} options. If
3852the @samp{-m} option is not used, and the @code{LDEMULATION} environment
3853variable is not defined, the default emulation depends upon how the
3854linker was configured.
252b5132
RH
3855
3856@kindex COLLECT_NO_DEMANGLE
3857@cindex demangling, default
3858Normally, the linker will default to demangling symbols. However, if
3859@code{COLLECT_NO_DEMANGLE} is set in the environment, then it will
3860default to not demangling symbols. This environment variable is used in
3861a similar fashion by the @code{gcc} linker wrapper program. The default
3862may be overridden by the @samp{--demangle} and @samp{--no-demangle}
3863options.
3864
0285c67d
NC
3865@c man end
3866@end ifset
3867
252b5132
RH
3868@node Scripts
3869@chapter Linker Scripts
3870
3871@cindex scripts
3872@cindex linker scripts
3873@cindex command files
3874Every link is controlled by a @dfn{linker script}. This script is
3875written in the linker command language.
3876
3877The main purpose of the linker script is to describe how the sections in
3878the input files should be mapped into the output file, and to control
3879the memory layout of the output file. Most linker scripts do nothing
3880more than this. However, when necessary, the linker script can also
3881direct the linker to perform many other operations, using the commands
3882described below.
3883
3884The linker always uses a linker script. If you do not supply one
3885yourself, the linker will use a default script that is compiled into the
a05a5b64
TP
3886linker executable. You can use the @samp{--verbose} command-line option
3887to display the default linker script. Certain command-line options,
252b5132
RH
3888such as @samp{-r} or @samp{-N}, will affect the default linker script.
3889
3890You may supply your own linker script by using the @samp{-T} command
3891line option. When you do this, your linker script will replace the
3892default linker script.
3893
3894You may also use linker scripts implicitly by naming them as input files
3895to the linker, as though they were files to be linked. @xref{Implicit
3896Linker Scripts}.
3897
3898@menu
3899* Basic Script Concepts:: Basic Linker Script Concepts
3900* Script Format:: Linker Script Format
3901* Simple Example:: Simple Linker Script Example
3902* Simple Commands:: Simple Linker Script Commands
3903* Assignments:: Assigning Values to Symbols
3904* SECTIONS:: SECTIONS Command
3905* MEMORY:: MEMORY Command
3906* PHDRS:: PHDRS Command
3907* VERSION:: VERSION Command
3908* Expressions:: Expressions in Linker Scripts
3909* Implicit Linker Scripts:: Implicit Linker Scripts
3910@end menu
3911
3912@node Basic Script Concepts
3913@section Basic Linker Script Concepts
3914@cindex linker script concepts
3915We need to define some basic concepts and vocabulary in order to
3916describe the linker script language.
3917
3918The linker combines input files into a single output file. The output
3919file and each input file are in a special data format known as an
3920@dfn{object file format}. Each file is called an @dfn{object file}.
3921The output file is often called an @dfn{executable}, but for our
3922purposes we will also call it an object file. Each object file has,
3923among other things, a list of @dfn{sections}. We sometimes refer to a
3924section in an input file as an @dfn{input section}; similarly, a section
3925in the output file is an @dfn{output section}.
3926
3927Each section in an object file has a name and a size. Most sections
3928also have an associated block of data, known as the @dfn{section
56dd11f0 3929contents}. A section may be marked as @dfn{loadable}, which means that
252b5132
RH
3930the contents should be loaded into memory when the output file is run.
3931A section with no contents may be @dfn{allocatable}, which means that an
3932area in memory should be set aside, but nothing in particular should be
3933loaded there (in some cases this memory must be zeroed out). A section
3934which is neither loadable nor allocatable typically contains some sort
3935of debugging information.
3936
3937Every loadable or allocatable output section has two addresses. The
3938first is the @dfn{VMA}, or virtual memory address. This is the address
3939the section will have when the output file is run. The second is the
3940@dfn{LMA}, or load memory address. This is the address at which the
3941section will be loaded. In most cases the two addresses will be the
3942same. An example of when they might be different is when a data section
3943is loaded into ROM, and then copied into RAM when the program starts up
3944(this technique is often used to initialize global variables in a ROM
3945based system). In this case the ROM address would be the LMA, and the
3946RAM address would be the VMA.
3947
3948You can see the sections in an object file by using the @code{objdump}
3949program with the @samp{-h} option.
3950
3951Every object file also has a list of @dfn{symbols}, known as the
3952@dfn{symbol table}. A symbol may be defined or undefined. Each symbol
3953has a name, and each defined symbol has an address, among other
3954information. If you compile a C or C++ program into an object file, you
3955will get a defined symbol for every defined function and global or
3956static variable. Every undefined function or global variable which is
3957referenced in the input file will become an undefined symbol.
3958
3959You can see the symbols in an object file by using the @code{nm}
3960program, or by using the @code{objdump} program with the @samp{-t}
3961option.
3962
3963@node Script Format
3964@section Linker Script Format
3965@cindex linker script format
3966Linker scripts are text files.
3967
3968You write a linker script as a series of commands. Each command is
3969either a keyword, possibly followed by arguments, or an assignment to a
3970symbol. You may separate commands using semicolons. Whitespace is
3971generally ignored.
3972
3973Strings such as file or format names can normally be entered directly.
3974If the file name contains a character such as a comma which would
3975otherwise serve to separate file names, you may put the file name in
3976double quotes. There is no way to use a double quote character in a
3977file name.
3978
3979You may include comments in linker scripts just as in C, delimited by
3980@samp{/*} and @samp{*/}. As in C, comments are syntactically equivalent
3981to whitespace.
3982
3983@node Simple Example
3984@section Simple Linker Script Example
3985@cindex linker script example
3986@cindex example of linker script
3987Many linker scripts are fairly simple.
3988
3989The simplest possible linker script has just one command:
3990@samp{SECTIONS}. You use the @samp{SECTIONS} command to describe the
3991memory layout of the output file.
3992
3993The @samp{SECTIONS} command is a powerful command. Here we will
3994describe a simple use of it. Let's assume your program consists only of
3995code, initialized data, and uninitialized data. These will be in the
3996@samp{.text}, @samp{.data}, and @samp{.bss} sections, respectively.
3997Let's assume further that these are the only sections which appear in
3998your input files.
3999
4000For this example, let's say that the code should be loaded at address
40010x10000, and that the data should start at address 0x8000000. Here is a
4002linker script which will do that:
4003@smallexample
4004SECTIONS
4005@{
4006 . = 0x10000;
4007 .text : @{ *(.text) @}
4008 . = 0x8000000;
4009 .data : @{ *(.data) @}
4010 .bss : @{ *(.bss) @}
4011@}
4012@end smallexample
4013
4014You write the @samp{SECTIONS} command as the keyword @samp{SECTIONS},
4015followed by a series of symbol assignments and output section
4016descriptions enclosed in curly braces.
4017
252b5132
RH
4018The first line inside the @samp{SECTIONS} command of the above example
4019sets the value of the special symbol @samp{.}, which is the location
4020counter. If you do not specify the address of an output section in some
4021other way (other ways are described later), the address is set from the
4022current value of the location counter. The location counter is then
4023incremented by the size of the output section. At the start of the
4024@samp{SECTIONS} command, the location counter has the value @samp{0}.
4025
4026The second line defines an output section, @samp{.text}. The colon is
4027required syntax which may be ignored for now. Within the curly braces
4028after the output section name, you list the names of the input sections
4029which should be placed into this output section. The @samp{*} is a
4030wildcard which matches any file name. The expression @samp{*(.text)}
4031means all @samp{.text} input sections in all input files.
4032
4033Since the location counter is @samp{0x10000} when the output section
4034@samp{.text} is defined, the linker will set the address of the
4035@samp{.text} section in the output file to be @samp{0x10000}.
4036
4037The remaining lines define the @samp{.data} and @samp{.bss} sections in
4038the output file. The linker will place the @samp{.data} output section
4039at address @samp{0x8000000}. After the linker places the @samp{.data}
4040output section, the value of the location counter will be
4041@samp{0x8000000} plus the size of the @samp{.data} output section. The
4042effect is that the linker will place the @samp{.bss} output section
58434bc1 4043immediately after the @samp{.data} output section in memory.
252b5132
RH
4044
4045The linker will ensure that each output section has the required
4046alignment, by increasing the location counter if necessary. In this
4047example, the specified addresses for the @samp{.text} and @samp{.data}
4048sections will probably satisfy any alignment constraints, but the linker
4049may have to create a small gap between the @samp{.data} and @samp{.bss}
4050sections.
4051
4052That's it! That's a simple and complete linker script.
4053
4054@node Simple Commands
4055@section Simple Linker Script Commands
4056@cindex linker script simple commands
4057In this section we describe the simple linker script commands.
4058
4059@menu
4060* Entry Point:: Setting the entry point
4061* File Commands:: Commands dealing with files
4062@ifclear SingleFormat
4063* Format Commands:: Commands dealing with object file formats
4064@end ifclear
4065
4a93e180 4066* REGION_ALIAS:: Assign alias names to memory regions
252b5132
RH
4067* Miscellaneous Commands:: Other linker script commands
4068@end menu
4069
4070@node Entry Point
36f63dca 4071@subsection Setting the Entry Point
252b5132
RH
4072@kindex ENTRY(@var{symbol})
4073@cindex start of execution
4074@cindex first instruction
4075@cindex entry point
4076The first instruction to execute in a program is called the @dfn{entry
4077point}. You can use the @code{ENTRY} linker script command to set the
4078entry point. The argument is a symbol name:
4079@smallexample
4080ENTRY(@var{symbol})
4081@end smallexample
4082
4083There are several ways to set the entry point. The linker will set the
4084entry point by trying each of the following methods in order, and
4085stopping when one of them succeeds:
4086@itemize @bullet
a1ab1d2a 4087@item
252b5132 4088the @samp{-e} @var{entry} command-line option;
a1ab1d2a 4089@item
252b5132 4090the @code{ENTRY(@var{symbol})} command in a linker script;
a1ab1d2a 4091@item
a094d01f 4092the value of a target-specific symbol, if it is defined; For many
8a758655 4093targets this is @code{start}, but PE- and BeOS-based systems for example
3ab904c4 4094check a list of possible entry symbols, matching the first one found.
a1ab1d2a 4095@item
5226a6a8
NC
4096the address of the first byte of the code section, if present and an
4097executable is being created - the code section is usually
5c14cc55 4098@samp{.text}, but can be something else;
a1ab1d2a 4099@item
252b5132
RH
4100The address @code{0}.
4101@end itemize
4102
4103@node File Commands
36f63dca 4104@subsection Commands Dealing with Files
252b5132
RH
4105@cindex linker script file commands
4106Several linker script commands deal with files.
4107
4108@table @code
4109@item INCLUDE @var{filename}
4110@kindex INCLUDE @var{filename}
4111@cindex including a linker script
4112Include the linker script @var{filename} at this point. The file will
4113be searched for in the current directory, and in any directory specified
ff5dcc92 4114with the @option{-L} option. You can nest calls to @code{INCLUDE} up to
252b5132
RH
411510 levels deep.
4116
4006703d
NS
4117You can place @code{INCLUDE} directives at the top level, in @code{MEMORY} or
4118@code{SECTIONS} commands, or in output section descriptions.
4119
252b5132
RH
4120@item INPUT(@var{file}, @var{file}, @dots{})
4121@itemx INPUT(@var{file} @var{file} @dots{})
4122@kindex INPUT(@var{files})
4123@cindex input files in linker scripts
4124@cindex input object files in linker scripts
4125@cindex linker script input object files
4126The @code{INPUT} command directs the linker to include the named files
4127in the link, as though they were named on the command line.
4128
4129For example, if you always want to include @file{subr.o} any time you do
4130a link, but you can't be bothered to put it on every link command line,
4131then you can put @samp{INPUT (subr.o)} in your linker script.
4132
4133In fact, if you like, you can list all of your input files in the linker
4134script, and then invoke the linker with nothing but a @samp{-T} option.
4135
e3f2db7f
AO
4136In case a @dfn{sysroot prefix} is configured, and the filename starts
4137with the @samp{/} character, and the script being processed was
4138located inside the @dfn{sysroot prefix}, the filename will be looked
16171946
FS
4139for in the @dfn{sysroot prefix}. The @dfn{sysroot prefix} can also be forced by specifying
4140@code{=} as the first character in the filename path, or prefixing the
4141filename path with @code{$SYSROOT}. See also the description of
4142@samp{-L} in @ref{Options,,Command-line Options}.
4143
4144If a @dfn{sysroot prefix} is not used then the linker will try to open
4145the file in the directory containing the linker script. If it is not
4146found the linker will then search the current directory. If it is still
4147not found the linker will search through the archive library search
4148path.
252b5132 4149
ff5dcc92 4150If you use @samp{INPUT (-l@var{file})}, @command{ld} will transform the
a05a5b64 4151name to @code{lib@var{file}.a}, as with the command-line argument
252b5132
RH
4152@samp{-l}.
4153
4154When you use the @code{INPUT} command in an implicit linker script, the
4155files will be included in the link at the point at which the linker
4156script file is included. This can affect archive searching.
4157
4158@item GROUP(@var{file}, @var{file}, @dots{})
4159@itemx GROUP(@var{file} @var{file} @dots{})
4160@kindex GROUP(@var{files})
4161@cindex grouping input files
4162The @code{GROUP} command is like @code{INPUT}, except that the named
4163files should all be archives, and they are searched repeatedly until no
4164new undefined references are created. See the description of @samp{-(}
a05a5b64 4165in @ref{Options,,Command-line Options}.
252b5132 4166
b717d30e
JJ
4167@item AS_NEEDED(@var{file}, @var{file}, @dots{})
4168@itemx AS_NEEDED(@var{file} @var{file} @dots{})
4169@kindex AS_NEEDED(@var{files})
4170This construct can appear only inside of the @code{INPUT} or @code{GROUP}
4171commands, among other filenames. The files listed will be handled
4172as if they appear directly in the @code{INPUT} or @code{GROUP} commands,
4173with the exception of ELF shared libraries, that will be added only
4174when they are actually needed. This construct essentially enables
4175@option{--as-needed} option for all the files listed inside of it
4176and restores previous @option{--as-needed} resp. @option{--no-as-needed}
4177setting afterwards.
4178
252b5132
RH
4179@item OUTPUT(@var{filename})
4180@kindex OUTPUT(@var{filename})
b45619c0 4181@cindex output file name in linker script
252b5132
RH
4182The @code{OUTPUT} command names the output file. Using
4183@code{OUTPUT(@var{filename})} in the linker script is exactly like using
4184@samp{-o @var{filename}} on the command line (@pxref{Options,,Command
a05a5b64 4185Line Options}). If both are used, the command-line option takes
252b5132
RH
4186precedence.
4187
4188You can use the @code{OUTPUT} command to define a default name for the
4189output file other than the usual default of @file{a.out}.
4190
4191@item SEARCH_DIR(@var{path})
4192@kindex SEARCH_DIR(@var{path})
4193@cindex library search path in linker script
4194@cindex archive search path in linker script
4195@cindex search path in linker script
4196The @code{SEARCH_DIR} command adds @var{path} to the list of paths where
ff5dcc92 4197@command{ld} looks for archive libraries. Using
252b5132 4198@code{SEARCH_DIR(@var{path})} is exactly like using @samp{-L @var{path}}
a05a5b64 4199on the command line (@pxref{Options,,Command-line Options}). If both
252b5132 4200are used, then the linker will search both paths. Paths specified using
a05a5b64 4201the command-line option are searched first.
252b5132
RH
4202
4203@item STARTUP(@var{filename})
4204@kindex STARTUP(@var{filename})
4205@cindex first input file
4206The @code{STARTUP} command is just like the @code{INPUT} command, except
4207that @var{filename} will become the first input file to be linked, as
4208though it were specified first on the command line. This may be useful
4209when using a system in which the entry point is always the start of the
4210first file.
4211@end table
4212
4213@ifclear SingleFormat
4214@node Format Commands
36f63dca 4215@subsection Commands Dealing with Object File Formats
252b5132
RH
4216A couple of linker script commands deal with object file formats.
4217
4218@table @code
4219@item OUTPUT_FORMAT(@var{bfdname})
4220@itemx OUTPUT_FORMAT(@var{default}, @var{big}, @var{little})
4221@kindex OUTPUT_FORMAT(@var{bfdname})
4222@cindex output file format in linker script
4223The @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} command names the BFD format to use for the
4224output file (@pxref{BFD}). Using @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT(@var{bfdname})} is
024531e2 4225exactly like using @samp{--oformat @var{bfdname}} on the command line
a05a5b64 4226(@pxref{Options,,Command-line Options}). If both are used, the command
252b5132
RH
4227line option takes precedence.
4228
4229You can use @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} with three arguments to use different
a05a5b64 4230formats based on the @samp{-EB} and @samp{-EL} command-line options.
252b5132
RH
4231This permits the linker script to set the output format based on the
4232desired endianness.
4233
4234If neither @samp{-EB} nor @samp{-EL} are used, then the output format
4235will be the first argument, @var{default}. If @samp{-EB} is used, the
4236output format will be the second argument, @var{big}. If @samp{-EL} is
4237used, the output format will be the third argument, @var{little}.
4238
4239For example, the default linker script for the MIPS ELF target uses this
4240command:
4241@smallexample
4242OUTPUT_FORMAT(elf32-bigmips, elf32-bigmips, elf32-littlemips)
4243@end smallexample
4244This says that the default format for the output file is
a05a5b64 4245@samp{elf32-bigmips}, but if the user uses the @samp{-EL} command-line
252b5132
RH
4246option, the output file will be created in the @samp{elf32-littlemips}
4247format.
4248
4249@item TARGET(@var{bfdname})
4250@kindex TARGET(@var{bfdname})
4251@cindex input file format in linker script
4252The @code{TARGET} command names the BFD format to use when reading input
4253files. It affects subsequent @code{INPUT} and @code{GROUP} commands.
4254This command is like using @samp{-b @var{bfdname}} on the command line
a05a5b64 4255(@pxref{Options,,Command-line Options}). If the @code{TARGET} command
252b5132
RH
4256is used but @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} is not, then the last @code{TARGET}
4257command is also used to set the format for the output file. @xref{BFD}.
4258@end table
4259@end ifclear
4260
4a93e180
NC
4261@node REGION_ALIAS
4262@subsection Assign alias names to memory regions
4263@kindex REGION_ALIAS(@var{alias}, @var{region})
4264@cindex region alias
4265@cindex region names
4266
4267Alias names can be added to existing memory regions created with the
4268@ref{MEMORY} command. Each name corresponds to at most one memory region.
4269
4270@smallexample
4271REGION_ALIAS(@var{alias}, @var{region})
4272@end smallexample
4273
4274The @code{REGION_ALIAS} function creates an alias name @var{alias} for the
4275memory region @var{region}. This allows a flexible mapping of output sections
4276to memory regions. An example follows.
4277
4278Suppose we have an application for embedded systems which come with various
4279memory storage devices. All have a general purpose, volatile memory @code{RAM}
4280that allows code execution or data storage. Some may have a read-only,
4281non-volatile memory @code{ROM} that allows code execution and read-only data
4282access. The last variant is a read-only, non-volatile memory @code{ROM2} with
4283read-only data access and no code execution capability. We have four output
4284sections:
4285
4286@itemize @bullet
4287@item
4288@code{.text} program code;
4289@item
4290@code{.rodata} read-only data;
4291@item
4292@code{.data} read-write initialized data;
4293@item
4294@code{.bss} read-write zero initialized data.
4295@end itemize
4296
4297The goal is to provide a linker command file that contains a system independent
4298part defining the output sections and a system dependent part mapping the
4299output sections to the memory regions available on the system. Our embedded
4300systems come with three different memory setups @code{A}, @code{B} and
4301@code{C}:
4302@multitable @columnfractions .25 .25 .25 .25
4303@item Section @tab Variant A @tab Variant B @tab Variant C
9d5777a3 4304@item .text @tab RAM @tab ROM @tab ROM
4a93e180
NC
4305@item .rodata @tab RAM @tab ROM @tab ROM2
4306@item .data @tab RAM @tab RAM/ROM @tab RAM/ROM2
4307@item .bss @tab RAM @tab RAM @tab RAM
4308@end multitable
4309The notation @code{RAM/ROM} or @code{RAM/ROM2} means that this section is
4310loaded into region @code{ROM} or @code{ROM2} respectively. Please note that
4311the load address of the @code{.data} section starts in all three variants at
4312the end of the @code{.rodata} section.
4313
4314The base linker script that deals with the output sections follows. It
4315includes the system dependent @code{linkcmds.memory} file that describes the
4316memory layout:
4317@smallexample
4318INCLUDE linkcmds.memory
4319
4320SECTIONS
4321 @{
4322 .text :
4323 @{
4324 *(.text)
4325 @} > REGION_TEXT
4326 .rodata :
4327 @{
4328 *(.rodata)
4329 rodata_end = .;
4330 @} > REGION_RODATA
4331 .data : AT (rodata_end)
4332 @{
4333 data_start = .;
4334 *(.data)
4335 @} > REGION_DATA
4336 data_size = SIZEOF(.data);
4337 data_load_start = LOADADDR(.data);
4338 .bss :
4339 @{
4340 *(.bss)
4341 @} > REGION_BSS
4342 @}
4343@end smallexample
4344
4345Now we need three different @code{linkcmds.memory} files to define memory
4346regions and alias names. The content of @code{linkcmds.memory} for the three
4347variants @code{A}, @code{B} and @code{C}:
4348@table @code
4349@item A
4350Here everything goes into the @code{RAM}.
4351@smallexample
4352MEMORY
4353 @{
4354 RAM : ORIGIN = 0, LENGTH = 4M
4355 @}
4356
4357REGION_ALIAS("REGION_TEXT", RAM);
4358REGION_ALIAS("REGION_RODATA", RAM);
4359REGION_ALIAS("REGION_DATA", RAM);
4360REGION_ALIAS("REGION_BSS", RAM);
4361@end smallexample
4362@item B
4363Program code and read-only data go into the @code{ROM}. Read-write data goes
4364into the @code{RAM}. An image of the initialized data is loaded into the
4365@code{ROM} and will be copied during system start into the @code{RAM}.
4366@smallexample
4367MEMORY
4368 @{
4369 ROM : ORIGIN = 0, LENGTH = 3M
4370 RAM : ORIGIN = 0x10000000, LENGTH = 1M
4371 @}
4372
4373REGION_ALIAS("REGION_TEXT", ROM);
4374REGION_ALIAS("REGION_RODATA", ROM);
4375REGION_ALIAS("REGION_DATA", RAM);
4376REGION_ALIAS("REGION_BSS", RAM);
4377@end smallexample
4378@item C
4379Program code goes into the @code{ROM}. Read-only data goes into the
4380@code{ROM2}. Read-write data goes into the @code{RAM}. An image of the
4381initialized data is loaded into the @code{ROM2} and will be copied during
4382system start into the @code{RAM}.
4383@smallexample
4384MEMORY
4385 @{
4386 ROM : ORIGIN = 0, LENGTH = 2M
4387 ROM2 : ORIGIN = 0x10000000, LENGTH = 1M
4388 RAM : ORIGIN = 0x20000000, LENGTH = 1M
4389 @}
4390
4391REGION_ALIAS("REGION_TEXT", ROM);
4392REGION_ALIAS("REGION_RODATA", ROM2);
4393REGION_ALIAS("REGION_DATA", RAM);
4394REGION_ALIAS("REGION_BSS", RAM);
4395@end smallexample
4396@end table
4397
4398It is possible to write a common system initialization routine to copy the
4399@code{.data} section from @code{ROM} or @code{ROM2} into the @code{RAM} if
4400necessary:
4401@smallexample
4402#include <string.h>
4403
4404extern char data_start [];
4405extern char data_size [];
4406extern char data_load_start [];
4407
4408void copy_data(void)
4409@{
4410 if (data_start != data_load_start)
4411 @{
4412 memcpy(data_start, data_load_start, (size_t) data_size);
4413 @}
4414@}
4415@end smallexample
4416
252b5132 4417@node Miscellaneous Commands
36f63dca 4418@subsection Other Linker Script Commands
252b5132
RH
4419There are a few other linker scripts commands.
4420
4421@table @code
4422@item ASSERT(@var{exp}, @var{message})
4423@kindex ASSERT
4424@cindex assertion in linker script
4425Ensure that @var{exp} is non-zero. If it is zero, then exit the linker
4426with an error code, and print @var{message}.
4427
fd1c4238
NC
4428Note that assertions are checked before the final stages of linking
4429take place. This means that expressions involving symbols PROVIDEd
4430inside section definitions will fail if the user has not set values
4431for those symbols. The only exception to this rule is PROVIDEd
4432symbols that just reference dot. Thus an assertion like this:
4433
4434@smallexample
4435 .stack :
4436 @{
4437 PROVIDE (__stack = .);
4438 PROVIDE (__stack_size = 0x100);
4439 ASSERT ((__stack > (_end + __stack_size)), "Error: No room left for the stack");
4440 @}
4441@end smallexample
4442
4443will fail if @code{__stack_size} is not defined elsewhere. Symbols
4444PROVIDEd outside of section definitions are evaluated earlier, so they
4445can be used inside ASSERTions. Thus:
4446
4447@smallexample
4448 PROVIDE (__stack_size = 0x100);
4449 .stack :
4450 @{
4451 PROVIDE (__stack = .);
4452 ASSERT ((__stack > (_end + __stack_size)), "Error: No room left for the stack");
4453 @}
4454@end smallexample
4455
4456will work.
4457
252b5132
RH
4458@item EXTERN(@var{symbol} @var{symbol} @dots{})
4459@kindex EXTERN
4460@cindex undefined symbol in linker script
4461Force @var{symbol} to be entered in the output file as an undefined
4462symbol. Doing this may, for example, trigger linking of additional
4463modules from standard libraries. You may list several @var{symbol}s for
4464each @code{EXTERN}, and you may use @code{EXTERN} multiple times. This
4465command has the same effect as the @samp{-u} command-line option.
4466
4467@item FORCE_COMMON_ALLOCATION
4468@kindex FORCE_COMMON_ALLOCATION
4469@cindex common allocation in linker script
4470This command has the same effect as the @samp{-d} command-line option:
ff5dcc92 4471to make @command{ld} assign space to common symbols even if a relocatable
252b5132
RH
4472output file is specified (@samp{-r}).
4473
4818e05f
AM
4474@item INHIBIT_COMMON_ALLOCATION
4475@kindex INHIBIT_COMMON_ALLOCATION
4476@cindex common allocation in linker script
4477This command has the same effect as the @samp{--no-define-common}
4478command-line option: to make @code{ld} omit the assignment of addresses
4479to common symbols even for a non-relocatable output file.
4480
7bdf4127
AB
4481@item FORCE_GROUP_ALLOCATION
4482@kindex FORCE_GROUP_ALLOCATION
4483@cindex group allocation in linker script
4484@cindex section groups
4485@cindex COMDAT
4486This command has the same effect as the
4487@samp{--force-group-allocation} command-line option: to make
4488@command{ld} place section group members like normal input sections,
4489and to delete the section groups even if a relocatable output file is
4490specified (@samp{-r}).
4491
53d25da6
AM
4492@item INSERT [ AFTER | BEFORE ] @var{output_section}
4493@kindex INSERT
4494@cindex insert user script into default script
4495This command is typically used in a script specified by @samp{-T} to
4496augment the default @code{SECTIONS} with, for example, overlays. It
4497inserts all prior linker script statements after (or before)
4498@var{output_section}, and also causes @samp{-T} to not override the
4499default linker script. The exact insertion point is as for orphan
4500sections. @xref{Location Counter}. The insertion happens after the
4501linker has mapped input sections to output sections. Prior to the
4502insertion, since @samp{-T} scripts are parsed before the default
4503linker script, statements in the @samp{-T} script occur before the
4504default linker script statements in the internal linker representation
4505of the script. In particular, input section assignments will be made
4506to @samp{-T} output sections before those in the default script. Here
4507is an example of how a @samp{-T} script using @code{INSERT} might look:
4508
4509@smallexample
4510SECTIONS
4511@{
4512 OVERLAY :
4513 @{
4514 .ov1 @{ ov1*(.text) @}
4515 .ov2 @{ ov2*(.text) @}
4516 @}
4517@}
4518INSERT AFTER .text;
4519@end smallexample
4520
31f14901
AM
4521Note that when @samp{-T} is used twice, once to override the default
4522script and once to augment that script using @code{INSERT} the order
4523of parsing and section assignments apply as for the default script.
4524The script with @code{INSERT} should be specified @emph{first} on the
4525command line.
4526
252b5132
RH
4527@item NOCROSSREFS(@var{section} @var{section} @dots{})
4528@kindex NOCROSSREFS(@var{sections})
4529@cindex cross references
ff5dcc92 4530This command may be used to tell @command{ld} to issue an error about any
252b5132
RH
4531references among certain output sections.
4532
4533In certain types of programs, particularly on embedded systems when
4534using overlays, when one section is loaded into memory, another section
4535will not be. Any direct references between the two sections would be
4536errors. For example, it would be an error if code in one section called
4537a function defined in the other section.
4538
4539The @code{NOCROSSREFS} command takes a list of output section names. If
ff5dcc92 4540@command{ld} detects any cross references between the sections, it reports
252b5132
RH
4541an error and returns a non-zero exit status. Note that the
4542@code{NOCROSSREFS} command uses output section names, not input section
4543names.
4544
cdf96953
MF
4545@item NOCROSSREFS_TO(@var{tosection} @var{fromsection} @dots{})
4546@kindex NOCROSSREFS_TO(@var{tosection} @var{fromsections})
4547@cindex cross references
4548This command may be used to tell @command{ld} to issue an error about any
4549references to one section from a list of other sections.
4550
4551The @code{NOCROSSREFS} command is useful when ensuring that two or more
4552output sections are entirely independent but there are situations where
4553a one-way dependency is needed. For example, in a multi-core application
4554there may be shared code that can be called from each core but for safety
4555must never call back.
4556
4557The @code{NOCROSSREFS_TO} command takes a list of output section names.
4558The first section can not be referenced from any of the other sections.
4559If @command{ld} detects any references to the first section from any of
4560the other sections, it reports an error and returns a non-zero exit
4561status. Note that the @code{NOCROSSREFS_TO} command uses output section
4562names, not input section names.
4563
252b5132
RH
4564@ifclear SingleFormat
4565@item OUTPUT_ARCH(@var{bfdarch})
4566@kindex OUTPUT_ARCH(@var{bfdarch})
4567@cindex machine architecture
4568@cindex architecture
4569Specify a particular output machine architecture. The argument is one
4570of the names used by the BFD library (@pxref{BFD}). You can see the
4571architecture of an object file by using the @code{objdump} program with
4572the @samp{-f} option.
4573@end ifclear
01554a74
AM
4574
4575@item LD_FEATURE(@var{string})
4576@kindex LD_FEATURE(@var{string})
4577This command may be used to modify @command{ld} behavior. If
4578@var{string} is @code{"SANE_EXPR"} then absolute symbols and numbers
4579in a script are simply treated as numbers everywhere.
4580@xref{Expression Section}.
252b5132
RH
4581@end table
4582
4583@node Assignments
4584@section Assigning Values to Symbols
4585@cindex assignment in scripts
4586@cindex symbol definition, scripts
4587@cindex variables, defining
4588You may assign a value to a symbol in a linker script. This will define
73ae6183 4589the symbol and place it into the symbol table with a global scope.
252b5132
RH
4590
4591@menu
4592* Simple Assignments:: Simple Assignments
eb8476a6 4593* HIDDEN:: HIDDEN
252b5132 4594* PROVIDE:: PROVIDE
7af8e998 4595* PROVIDE_HIDDEN:: PROVIDE_HIDDEN
73ae6183 4596* Source Code Reference:: How to use a linker script defined symbol in source code
252b5132
RH
4597@end menu
4598
4599@node Simple Assignments
4600@subsection Simple Assignments
4601
4602You may assign to a symbol using any of the C assignment operators:
4603
4604@table @code
4605@item @var{symbol} = @var{expression} ;
4606@itemx @var{symbol} += @var{expression} ;
4607@itemx @var{symbol} -= @var{expression} ;
4608@itemx @var{symbol} *= @var{expression} ;
4609@itemx @var{symbol} /= @var{expression} ;
4610@itemx @var{symbol} <<= @var{expression} ;
4611@itemx @var{symbol} >>= @var{expression} ;
4612@itemx @var{symbol} &= @var{expression} ;
4613@itemx @var{symbol} |= @var{expression} ;
4614@end table
4615
4616The first case will define @var{symbol} to the value of
4617@var{expression}. In the other cases, @var{symbol} must already be
4618defined, and the value will be adjusted accordingly.
4619
4620The special symbol name @samp{.} indicates the location counter. You
b5666f2f 4621may only use this within a @code{SECTIONS} command. @xref{Location Counter}.
252b5132
RH
4622
4623The semicolon after @var{expression} is required.
4624
4625Expressions are defined below; see @ref{Expressions}.
4626
4627You may write symbol assignments as commands in their own right, or as
4628statements within a @code{SECTIONS} command, or as part of an output
4629section description in a @code{SECTIONS} command.
4630
4631The section of the symbol will be set from the section of the
4632expression; for more information, see @ref{Expression Section}.
4633
4634Here is an example showing the three different places that symbol
4635assignments may be used:
4636
4637@smallexample
4638floating_point = 0;
4639SECTIONS
4640@{
4641 .text :
4642 @{
4643 *(.text)
4644 _etext = .;
4645 @}
156e34dd 4646 _bdata = (. + 3) & ~ 3;
252b5132
RH
4647 .data : @{ *(.data) @}
4648@}
4649@end smallexample
4650@noindent
4651In this example, the symbol @samp{floating_point} will be defined as
4652zero. The symbol @samp{_etext} will be defined as the address following
4653the last @samp{.text} input section. The symbol @samp{_bdata} will be
4654defined as the address following the @samp{.text} output section aligned
4655upward to a 4 byte boundary.
4656
eb8476a6
MR
4657@node HIDDEN
4658@subsection HIDDEN
4659@cindex HIDDEN
4660For ELF targeted ports, define a symbol that will be hidden and won't be
4661exported. The syntax is @code{HIDDEN(@var{symbol} = @var{expression})}.
4662
4663Here is the example from @ref{Simple Assignments}, rewritten to use
4664@code{HIDDEN}:
4665
4666@smallexample
4667HIDDEN(floating_point = 0);
4668SECTIONS
4669@{
4670 .text :
4671 @{
4672 *(.text)
4673 HIDDEN(_etext = .);
4674 @}
4675 HIDDEN(_bdata = (. + 3) & ~ 3);
4676 .data : @{ *(.data) @}
4677@}
4678@end smallexample
4679@noindent
4680In this case none of the three symbols will be visible outside this module.
4681
252b5132
RH
4682@node PROVIDE
4683@subsection PROVIDE
4684@cindex PROVIDE
4685In some cases, it is desirable for a linker script to define a symbol
4686only if it is referenced and is not defined by any object included in
4687the link. For example, traditional linkers defined the symbol
4688@samp{etext}. However, ANSI C requires that the user be able to use
4689@samp{etext} as a function name without encountering an error. The
4690@code{PROVIDE} keyword may be used to define a symbol, such as
4691@samp{etext}, only if it is referenced but not defined. The syntax is
4692@code{PROVIDE(@var{symbol} = @var{expression})}.
4693
4694Here is an example of using @code{PROVIDE} to define @samp{etext}:
4695@smallexample
4696SECTIONS
4697@{
4698 .text :
4699 @{
4700 *(.text)
4701 _etext = .;
4702 PROVIDE(etext = .);
4703 @}
4704@}
4705@end smallexample
4706
4707In this example, if the program defines @samp{_etext} (with a leading
3c27360b
JB
4708underscore), the linker will give a multiple definition diagnostic. If,
4709on the other hand, the program defines @samp{etext} (with no leading
252b5132
RH
4710underscore), the linker will silently use the definition in the program.
4711If the program references @samp{etext} but does not define it, the
4712linker will use the definition in the linker script.
4713
b0daac83
NC
4714Note - the @code{PROVIDE} directive considers a common symbol to be
4715defined, even though such a symbol could be combined with the symbol
4716that the @code{PROVIDE} would create. This is particularly important
4717when considering constructor and destructor list symbols such as
4718@samp{__CTOR_LIST__} as these are often defined as common symbols.
4719
7af8e998
L
4720@node PROVIDE_HIDDEN
4721@subsection PROVIDE_HIDDEN
4722@cindex PROVIDE_HIDDEN
4723Similar to @code{PROVIDE}. For ELF targeted ports, the symbol will be
4724hidden and won't be exported.
4725
73ae6183
NC
4726@node Source Code Reference
4727@subsection Source Code Reference
4728
4729Accessing a linker script defined variable from source code is not
4730intuitive. In particular a linker script symbol is not equivalent to
4731a variable declaration in a high level language, it is instead a
4732symbol that does not have a value.
4733
4734Before going further, it is important to note that compilers often
4735transform names in the source code into different names when they are
4736stored in the symbol table. For example, Fortran compilers commonly
4737prepend or append an underscore, and C++ performs extensive @samp{name
4738mangling}. Therefore there might be a discrepancy between the name
4739of a variable as it is used in source code and the name of the same
4740variable as it is defined in a linker script. For example in C a
4741linker script variable might be referred to as:
4742
4743@smallexample
4744 extern int foo;
4745@end smallexample
4746
4747But in the linker script it might be defined as:
4748
4749@smallexample
4750 _foo = 1000;
4751@end smallexample
4752
4753In the remaining examples however it is assumed that no name
4754transformation has taken place.
4755
4756When a symbol is declared in a high level language such as C, two
4757things happen. The first is that the compiler reserves enough space
4758in the program's memory to hold the @emph{value} of the symbol. The
4759second is that the compiler creates an entry in the program's symbol
4760table which holds the symbol's @emph{address}. ie the symbol table
4761contains the address of the block of memory holding the symbol's
4762value. So for example the following C declaration, at file scope:
4763
4764@smallexample
4765 int foo = 1000;
4766@end smallexample
4767
10bf6894 4768creates an entry called @samp{foo} in the symbol table. This entry
73ae6183
NC
4769holds the address of an @samp{int} sized block of memory where the
4770number 1000 is initially stored.
4771
4772When a program references a symbol the compiler generates code that
4773first accesses the symbol table to find the address of the symbol's
4774memory block and then code to read the value from that memory block.
4775So:
4776
4777@smallexample
4778 foo = 1;
4779@end smallexample
4780
4781looks up the symbol @samp{foo} in the symbol table, gets the address
4782associated with this symbol and then writes the value 1 into that
4783address. Whereas:
4784
4785@smallexample
4786 int * a = & foo;
4787@end smallexample
4788
10bf6894 4789looks up the symbol @samp{foo} in the symbol table, gets its address
73ae6183
NC
4790and then copies this address into the block of memory associated with
4791the variable @samp{a}.
4792
4793Linker scripts symbol declarations, by contrast, create an entry in
4794the symbol table but do not assign any memory to them. Thus they are
4795an address without a value. So for example the linker script definition:
4796
4797@smallexample
4798 foo = 1000;
4799@end smallexample
4800
4801creates an entry in the symbol table called @samp{foo} which holds
4802the address of memory location 1000, but nothing special is stored at
4803address 1000. This means that you cannot access the @emph{value} of a
4804linker script defined symbol - it has no value - all you can do is
4805access the @emph{address} of a linker script defined symbol.
4806
4807Hence when you are using a linker script defined symbol in source code
4808you should always take the address of the symbol, and never attempt to
4809use its value. For example suppose you want to copy the contents of a
4810section of memory called .ROM into a section called .FLASH and the
4811linker script contains these declarations:
4812
4813@smallexample
4814@group
4815 start_of_ROM = .ROM;
a5e406b5 4816 end_of_ROM = .ROM + sizeof (.ROM);
73ae6183
NC
4817 start_of_FLASH = .FLASH;
4818@end group
4819@end smallexample
4820
4821Then the C source code to perform the copy would be:
4822
4823@smallexample
4824@group
4825 extern char start_of_ROM, end_of_ROM, start_of_FLASH;
c0065db7 4826
73ae6183
NC
4827 memcpy (& start_of_FLASH, & start_of_ROM, & end_of_ROM - & start_of_ROM);
4828@end group
4829@end smallexample
4830
4831Note the use of the @samp{&} operators. These are correct.
5707d2ad
NC
4832Alternatively the symbols can be treated as the names of vectors or
4833arrays and then the code will again work as expected:
4834
4835@smallexample
4836@group
4837 extern char start_of_ROM[], end_of_ROM[], start_of_FLASH[];
4838
4839 memcpy (start_of_FLASH, start_of_ROM, end_of_ROM - start_of_ROM);
4840@end group
4841@end smallexample
4842
4843Note how using this method does not require the use of @samp{&}
4844operators.
73ae6183 4845
252b5132 4846@node SECTIONS
36f63dca 4847@section SECTIONS Command
252b5132
RH
4848@kindex SECTIONS
4849The @code{SECTIONS} command tells the linker how to map input sections
4850into output sections, and how to place the output sections in memory.
4851
4852The format of the @code{SECTIONS} command is:
4853@smallexample
4854SECTIONS
4855@{
4856 @var{sections-command}
4857 @var{sections-command}
4858 @dots{}
4859@}
4860@end smallexample
4861
4862Each @var{sections-command} may of be one of the following:
4863
4864@itemize @bullet
4865@item
4866an @code{ENTRY} command (@pxref{Entry Point,,Entry command})
4867@item
4868a symbol assignment (@pxref{Assignments})
4869@item
4870an output section description
4871@item
4872an overlay description
4873@end itemize
4874
4875The @code{ENTRY} command and symbol assignments are permitted inside the
4876@code{SECTIONS} command for convenience in using the location counter in
4877those commands. This can also make the linker script easier to
4878understand because you can use those commands at meaningful points in
4879the layout of the output file.
4880
4881Output section descriptions and overlay descriptions are described
4882below.
4883
4884If you do not use a @code{SECTIONS} command in your linker script, the
4885linker will place each input section into an identically named output
4886section in the order that the sections are first encountered in the
4887input files. If all input sections are present in the first file, for
4888example, the order of sections in the output file will match the order
4889in the first input file. The first section will be at address zero.
4890
4891@menu
4892* Output Section Description:: Output section description
4893* Output Section Name:: Output section name
4894* Output Section Address:: Output section address
4895* Input Section:: Input section description
4896* Output Section Data:: Output section data
4897* Output Section Keywords:: Output section keywords
4898* Output Section Discarding:: Output section discarding
4899* Output Section Attributes:: Output section attributes
4900* Overlay Description:: Overlay description
4901@end menu
4902
4903@node Output Section Description
36f63dca 4904@subsection Output Section Description
252b5132
RH
4905The full description of an output section looks like this:
4906@smallexample
a1ab1d2a 4907@group
7e7d5768 4908@var{section} [@var{address}] [(@var{type})] :
0c71d759 4909 [AT(@var{lma})]
1eec346e 4910 [ALIGN(@var{section_align}) | ALIGN_WITH_INPUT]
0c71d759
NC
4911 [SUBALIGN(@var{subsection_align})]
4912 [@var{constraint}]
252b5132
RH
4913 @{
4914 @var{output-section-command}
4915 @var{output-section-command}
4916 @dots{}
abc9061b 4917 @} [>@var{region}] [AT>@var{lma_region}] [:@var{phdr} :@var{phdr} @dots{}] [=@var{fillexp}] [,]
252b5132
RH
4918@end group
4919@end smallexample
4920
4921Most output sections do not use most of the optional section attributes.
4922
4923The whitespace around @var{section} is required, so that the section
4924name is unambiguous. The colon and the curly braces are also required.
abc9061b
CC
4925The comma at the end may be required if a @var{fillexp} is used and
4926the next @var{sections-command} looks like a continuation of the expression.
252b5132
RH
4927The line breaks and other white space are optional.
4928
4929Each @var{output-section-command} may be one of the following:
4930
4931@itemize @bullet
4932@item
4933a symbol assignment (@pxref{Assignments})
4934@item
4935an input section description (@pxref{Input Section})
4936@item
4937data values to include directly (@pxref{Output Section Data})
4938@item
4939a special output section keyword (@pxref{Output Section Keywords})
4940@end itemize
4941
4942@node Output Section Name
36f63dca 4943@subsection Output Section Name
252b5132
RH
4944@cindex name, section
4945@cindex section name
4946The name of the output section is @var{section}. @var{section} must
4947meet the constraints of your output format. In formats which only
4948support a limited number of sections, such as @code{a.out}, the name
4949must be one of the names supported by the format (@code{a.out}, for
4950example, allows only @samp{.text}, @samp{.data} or @samp{.bss}). If the
4951output format supports any number of sections, but with numbers and not
4952names (as is the case for Oasys), the name should be supplied as a
4953quoted numeric string. A section name may consist of any sequence of
4954characters, but a name which contains any unusual characters such as
4955commas must be quoted.
4956
4957The output section name @samp{/DISCARD/} is special; @ref{Output Section
4958Discarding}.
4959
4960@node Output Section Address
2a16d82a 4961@subsection Output Section Address
252b5132
RH
4962@cindex address, section
4963@cindex section address
4964The @var{address} is an expression for the VMA (the virtual memory
ea5cae92
NC
4965address) of the output section. This address is optional, but if it
4966is provided then the output address will be set exactly as specified.
4967
4968If the output address is not specified then one will be chosen for the
4969section, based on the heuristic below. This address will be adjusted
4970to fit the alignment requirement of the output section. The
4971alignment requirement is the strictest alignment of any input section
4972contained within the output section.
4973
4974The output section address heuristic is as follows:
4975
4976@itemize @bullet
4977@item
4978If an output memory @var{region} is set for the section then it
4979is added to this region and its address will be the next free address
4980in that region.
4981
4982@item
4983If the MEMORY command has been used to create a list of memory
4984regions then the first region which has attributes compatible with the
4985section is selected to contain it. The section's output address will
4986be the next free address in that region; @ref{MEMORY}.
4987
4988@item
4989If no memory regions were specified, or none match the section then
4990the output address will be based on the current value of the location
4991counter.
4992@end itemize
4993
4994@noindent
4995For example:
4996
252b5132
RH
4997@smallexample
4998.text . : @{ *(.text) @}
4999@end smallexample
ea5cae92 5000
252b5132
RH
5001@noindent
5002and
ea5cae92 5003
252b5132
RH
5004@smallexample
5005.text : @{ *(.text) @}
5006@end smallexample
ea5cae92 5007
252b5132
RH
5008@noindent
5009are subtly different. The first will set the address of the
5010@samp{.text} output section to the current value of the location
5011counter. The second will set it to the current value of the location
ea5cae92
NC
5012counter aligned to the strictest alignment of any of the @samp{.text}
5013input sections.
252b5132
RH
5014
5015The @var{address} may be an arbitrary expression; @ref{Expressions}.
5016For example, if you want to align the section on a 0x10 byte boundary,
5017so that the lowest four bits of the section address are zero, you could
5018do something like this:
5019@smallexample
5020.text ALIGN(0x10) : @{ *(.text) @}
5021@end smallexample
5022@noindent
5023This works because @code{ALIGN} returns the current location counter
5024aligned upward to the specified value.
5025
5026Specifying @var{address} for a section will change the value of the
6ce340f1
NC
5027location counter, provided that the section is non-empty. (Empty
5028sections are ignored).
252b5132
RH
5029
5030@node Input Section
36f63dca 5031@subsection Input Section Description
252b5132
RH
5032@cindex input sections
5033@cindex mapping input sections to output sections
5034The most common output section command is an input section description.
5035
5036The input section description is the most basic linker script operation.
5037You use output sections to tell the linker how to lay out your program
5038in memory. You use input section descriptions to tell the linker how to
5039map the input files into your memory layout.
5040
5041@menu
5042* Input Section Basics:: Input section basics
5043* Input Section Wildcards:: Input section wildcard patterns
5044* Input Section Common:: Input section for common symbols
5045* Input Section Keep:: Input section and garbage collection
5046* Input Section Example:: Input section example
5047@end menu
5048
5049@node Input Section Basics
36f63dca 5050@subsubsection Input Section Basics
252b5132
RH
5051@cindex input section basics
5052An input section description consists of a file name optionally followed
5053by a list of section names in parentheses.
5054
5055The file name and the section name may be wildcard patterns, which we
5056describe further below (@pxref{Input Section Wildcards}).
5057
5058The most common input section description is to include all input
5059sections with a particular name in the output section. For example, to
5060include all input @samp{.text} sections, you would write:
5061@smallexample
5062*(.text)
5063@end smallexample
5064@noindent
18625d54 5065Here the @samp{*} is a wildcard which matches any file name. To exclude a list
8f1732fc 5066@cindex EXCLUDE_FILE
18625d54
CM
5067of files from matching the file name wildcard, EXCLUDE_FILE may be used to
5068match all files except the ones specified in the EXCLUDE_FILE list. For
5069example:
252b5132 5070@smallexample
8f1732fc
AB
5071EXCLUDE_FILE (*crtend.o *otherfile.o) *(.ctors)
5072@end smallexample
5073@noindent
5074will cause all .ctors sections from all files except @file{crtend.o}
5075and @file{otherfile.o} to be included. The EXCLUDE_FILE can also be
5076placed inside the section list, for example:
5077@smallexample
b4346c09 5078*(EXCLUDE_FILE (*crtend.o *otherfile.o) .ctors)
252b5132 5079@end smallexample
8f1732fc
AB
5080@noindent
5081The result of this is identically to the previous example. Supporting
5082two syntaxes for EXCLUDE_FILE is useful if the section list contains
5083more than one section, as described below.
252b5132
RH
5084
5085There are two ways to include more than one section:
5086@smallexample
5087*(.text .rdata)
5088*(.text) *(.rdata)
5089@end smallexample
5090@noindent
5091The difference between these is the order in which the @samp{.text} and
5092@samp{.rdata} input sections will appear in the output section. In the
b6bf44ba
AM
5093first example, they will be intermingled, appearing in the same order as
5094they are found in the linker input. In the second example, all
252b5132
RH
5095@samp{.text} input sections will appear first, followed by all
5096@samp{.rdata} input sections.
5097
8f1732fc
AB
5098When using EXCLUDE_FILE with more than one section, if the exclusion
5099is within the section list then the exclusion only applies to the
5100immediately following section, for example:
a5bf7d4f
AB
5101@smallexample
5102*(EXCLUDE_FILE (*somefile.o) .text .rdata)
5103@end smallexample
5104@noindent
5105will cause all @samp{.text} sections from all files except
5106@file{somefile.o} to be included, while all @samp{.rdata} sections
5107from all files, including @file{somefile.o}, will be included. To
5108exclude the @samp{.rdata} sections from @file{somefile.o} the example
8f1732fc 5109could be modified to:
a5bf7d4f
AB
5110@smallexample
5111*(EXCLUDE_FILE (*somefile.o) .text EXCLUDE_FILE (*somefile.o) .rdata)
5112@end smallexample
8f1732fc
AB
5113@noindent
5114Alternatively, placing the EXCLUDE_FILE outside of the section list,
5115before the input file selection, will cause the exclusion to apply for
5116all sections. Thus the previous example can be rewritten as:
5117@smallexample
5118EXCLUDE_FILE (*somefile.o) *(.text .rdata)
5119@end smallexample
a5bf7d4f 5120
252b5132
RH
5121You can specify a file name to include sections from a particular file.
5122You would do this if one or more of your files contain special data that
5123needs to be at a particular location in memory. For example:
5124@smallexample
5125data.o(.data)
5126@end smallexample
5127
ae17ab41
CM
5128To refine the sections that are included based on the section flags
5129of an input section, INPUT_SECTION_FLAGS may be used.
5130
5131Here is a simple example for using Section header flags for ELF sections:
5132
5133@smallexample
5134@group
5135SECTIONS @{
5136 .text : @{ INPUT_SECTION_FLAGS (SHF_MERGE & SHF_STRINGS) *(.text) @}
5137 .text2 : @{ INPUT_SECTION_FLAGS (!SHF_WRITE) *(.text) @}
5138@}
5139@end group
5140@end smallexample
5141
5142In this example, the output section @samp{.text} will be comprised of any
5143input section matching the name *(.text) whose section header flags
5144@code{SHF_MERGE} and @code{SHF_STRINGS} are set. The output section
5145@samp{.text2} will be comprised of any input section matching the name *(.text)
5146whose section header flag @code{SHF_WRITE} is clear.
5147
967928e9
AM
5148You can also specify files within archives by writing a pattern
5149matching the archive, a colon, then the pattern matching the file,
5150with no whitespace around the colon.
5151
5152@table @samp
5153@item archive:file
5154matches file within archive
5155@item archive:
5156matches the whole archive
5157@item :file
5158matches file but not one in an archive
5159@end table
5160
5161Either one or both of @samp{archive} and @samp{file} can contain shell
5162wildcards. On DOS based file systems, the linker will assume that a
5163single letter followed by a colon is a drive specifier, so
5164@samp{c:myfile.o} is a simple file specification, not @samp{myfile.o}
5165within an archive called @samp{c}. @samp{archive:file} filespecs may
5166also be used within an @code{EXCLUDE_FILE} list, but may not appear in
5167other linker script contexts. For instance, you cannot extract a file
5168from an archive by using @samp{archive:file} in an @code{INPUT}
5169command.
5170
252b5132
RH
5171If you use a file name without a list of sections, then all sections in
5172the input file will be included in the output section. This is not
5173commonly done, but it may by useful on occasion. For example:
5174@smallexample
5175data.o
5176@end smallexample
5177
967928e9
AM
5178When you use a file name which is not an @samp{archive:file} specifier
5179and does not contain any wild card
252b5132
RH
5180characters, the linker will first see if you also specified the file
5181name on the linker command line or in an @code{INPUT} command. If you
5182did not, the linker will attempt to open the file as an input file, as
5183though it appeared on the command line. Note that this differs from an
5184@code{INPUT} command, because the linker will not search for the file in
5185the archive search path.
5186
5187@node Input Section Wildcards
36f63dca 5188@subsubsection Input Section Wildcard Patterns
252b5132
RH
5189@cindex input section wildcards
5190@cindex wildcard file name patterns
5191@cindex file name wildcard patterns
5192@cindex section name wildcard patterns
5193In an input section description, either the file name or the section
5194name or both may be wildcard patterns.
5195
5196The file name of @samp{*} seen in many examples is a simple wildcard
5197pattern for the file name.
5198
5199The wildcard patterns are like those used by the Unix shell.
5200
5201@table @samp
5202@item *
5203matches any number of characters
5204@item ?
5205matches any single character
5206@item [@var{chars}]
5207matches a single instance of any of the @var{chars}; the @samp{-}
5208character may be used to specify a range of characters, as in
5209@samp{[a-z]} to match any lower case letter
5210@item \
5211quotes the following character
5212@end table
5213
252b5132
RH
5214File name wildcard patterns only match files which are explicitly
5215specified on the command line or in an @code{INPUT} command. The linker
5216does not search directories to expand wildcards.
5217
5218If a file name matches more than one wildcard pattern, or if a file name
5219appears explicitly and is also matched by a wildcard pattern, the linker
5220will use the first match in the linker script. For example, this
5221sequence of input section descriptions is probably in error, because the
5222@file{data.o} rule will not be used:
5223@smallexample
5224.data : @{ *(.data) @}
5225.data1 : @{ data.o(.data) @}
5226@end smallexample
5227
bcaa7b3e 5228@cindex SORT_BY_NAME
252b5132
RH
5229Normally, the linker will place files and sections matched by wildcards
5230in the order in which they are seen during the link. You can change
bcaa7b3e
L
5231this by using the @code{SORT_BY_NAME} keyword, which appears before a wildcard
5232pattern in parentheses (e.g., @code{SORT_BY_NAME(.text*)}). When the
5233@code{SORT_BY_NAME} keyword is used, the linker will sort the files or sections
252b5132
RH
5234into ascending order by name before placing them in the output file.
5235
bcaa7b3e 5236@cindex SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT
9a24a276
AM
5237@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} is similar to @code{SORT_BY_NAME}.
5238@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} will sort sections into descending order of
5239alignment before placing them in the output file. Placing larger
5240alignments before smaller alignments can reduce the amount of padding
5241needed.
bcaa7b3e 5242
02ecc8e9 5243@cindex SORT_BY_INIT_PRIORITY
9a24a276
AM
5244@code{SORT_BY_INIT_PRIORITY} is also similar to @code{SORT_BY_NAME}.
5245@code{SORT_BY_INIT_PRIORITY} will sort sections into ascending
5246numerical order of the GCC init_priority attribute encoded in the
5247section name before placing them in the output file. In
5248@code{.init_array.NNNNN} and @code{.fini_array.NNNNN}, @code{NNNNN} is
5249the init_priority. In @code{.ctors.NNNNN} and @code{.dtors.NNNNN},
5250@code{NNNNN} is 65535 minus the init_priority.
02ecc8e9 5251
bcaa7b3e
L
5252@cindex SORT
5253@code{SORT} is an alias for @code{SORT_BY_NAME}.
5254
5255When there are nested section sorting commands in linker script, there
5256can be at most 1 level of nesting for section sorting commands.
5257
5258@enumerate
5259@item
5260@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern)).
1ae5c3ae 5261It will sort the input sections by name first, then by alignment if two
bcaa7b3e
L
5262sections have the same name.
5263@item
5264@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern)).
1ae5c3ae 5265It will sort the input sections by alignment first, then by name if two
bcaa7b3e
L
5266sections have the same alignment.
5267@item
c0065db7 5268@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern)) is
bcaa7b3e
L
5269treated the same as @code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern).
5270@item
5271@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern))
5272is treated the same as @code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern).
5273@item
5274All other nested section sorting commands are invalid.
5275@end enumerate
5276
a05a5b64 5277When both command-line section sorting option and linker script
bcaa7b3e 5278section sorting command are used, section sorting command always
a05a5b64 5279takes precedence over the command-line option.
bcaa7b3e
L
5280
5281If the section sorting command in linker script isn't nested, the
a05a5b64 5282command-line option will make the section sorting command to be
bcaa7b3e
L
5283treated as nested sorting command.
5284
5285@enumerate
5286@item
5287@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern ) with
5288@option{--sort-sections alignment} is equivalent to
5289@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern)).
5290@item
5291@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern) with
5292@option{--sort-section name} is equivalent to
5293@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern)).
5294@end enumerate
5295
5296If the section sorting command in linker script is nested, the
a05a5b64 5297command-line option will be ignored.
bcaa7b3e 5298
eda680f8 5299@cindex SORT_NONE
a05a5b64 5300@code{SORT_NONE} disables section sorting by ignoring the command-line
eda680f8
L
5301section sorting option.
5302
252b5132
RH
5303If you ever get confused about where input sections are going, use the
5304@samp{-M} linker option to generate a map file. The map file shows
5305precisely how input sections are mapped to output sections.
5306
5307This example shows how wildcard patterns might be used to partition
5308files. This linker script directs the linker to place all @samp{.text}
5309sections in @samp{.text} and all @samp{.bss} sections in @samp{.bss}.
5310The linker will place the @samp{.data} section from all files beginning
5311with an upper case character in @samp{.DATA}; for all other files, the
5312linker will place the @samp{.data} section in @samp{.data}.
5313@smallexample
5314@group
5315SECTIONS @{
5316 .text : @{ *(.text) @}
5317 .DATA : @{ [A-Z]*(.data) @}
5318 .data : @{ *(.data) @}
5319 .bss : @{ *(.bss) @}
5320@}
5321@end group
5322@end smallexample
5323
5324@node Input Section Common
36f63dca 5325@subsubsection Input Section for Common Symbols
252b5132
RH
5326@cindex common symbol placement
5327@cindex uninitialized data placement
5328A special notation is needed for common symbols, because in many object
5329file formats common symbols do not have a particular input section. The
5330linker treats common symbols as though they are in an input section
5331named @samp{COMMON}.
5332
5333You may use file names with the @samp{COMMON} section just as with any
5334other input sections. You can use this to place common symbols from a
5335particular input file in one section while common symbols from other
5336input files are placed in another section.
5337
5338In most cases, common symbols in input files will be placed in the
5339@samp{.bss} section in the output file. For example:
5340@smallexample
5341.bss @{ *(.bss) *(COMMON) @}
5342@end smallexample
5343
5344@cindex scommon section
5345@cindex small common symbols
5346Some object file formats have more than one type of common symbol. For
5347example, the MIPS ELF object file format distinguishes standard common
5348symbols and small common symbols. In this case, the linker will use a
5349different special section name for other types of common symbols. In
5350the case of MIPS ELF, the linker uses @samp{COMMON} for standard common
5351symbols and @samp{.scommon} for small common symbols. This permits you
5352to map the different types of common symbols into memory at different
5353locations.
5354
5355@cindex [COMMON]
5356You will sometimes see @samp{[COMMON]} in old linker scripts. This
5357notation is now considered obsolete. It is equivalent to
5358@samp{*(COMMON)}.
5359
5360@node Input Section Keep
36f63dca 5361@subsubsection Input Section and Garbage Collection
252b5132
RH
5362@cindex KEEP
5363@cindex garbage collection
5364When link-time garbage collection is in use (@samp{--gc-sections}),
a1ab1d2a 5365it is often useful to mark sections that should not be eliminated.
252b5132
RH
5366This is accomplished by surrounding an input section's wildcard entry
5367with @code{KEEP()}, as in @code{KEEP(*(.init))} or
bcaa7b3e 5368@code{KEEP(SORT_BY_NAME(*)(.ctors))}.
252b5132
RH
5369
5370@node Input Section Example
36f63dca 5371@subsubsection Input Section Example
252b5132
RH
5372The following example is a complete linker script. It tells the linker
5373to read all of the sections from file @file{all.o} and place them at the
5374start of output section @samp{outputa} which starts at location
5375@samp{0x10000}. All of section @samp{.input1} from file @file{foo.o}
5376follows immediately, in the same output section. All of section
5377@samp{.input2} from @file{foo.o} goes into output section
5378@samp{outputb}, followed by section @samp{.input1} from @file{foo1.o}.
5379All of the remaining @samp{.input1} and @samp{.input2} sections from any
5380files are written to output section @samp{outputc}.
5381
5382@smallexample
5383@group
5384SECTIONS @{
5385 outputa 0x10000 :
5386 @{
5387 all.o
5388 foo.o (.input1)
5389 @}
36f63dca
NC
5390@end group
5391@group
252b5132
RH
5392 outputb :
5393 @{
5394 foo.o (.input2)
5395 foo1.o (.input1)
5396 @}
36f63dca
NC
5397@end group
5398@group
252b5132
RH
5399 outputc :
5400 @{
5401 *(.input1)
5402 *(.input2)
5403 @}
5404@}
5405@end group
a1ab1d2a 5406@end smallexample
252b5132 5407
cbd0eecf
L
5408If an output section's name is the same as the input section's name
5409and is representable as a C identifier, then the linker will
5410automatically @pxref{PROVIDE} two symbols: __start_SECNAME and
5411__stop_SECNAME, where SECNAME is the name of the section. These
5412indicate the start address and end address of the output section
5413respectively. Note: most section names are not representable as
5414C identifiers because they contain a @samp{.} character.
75bd292b 5415
252b5132 5416@node Output Section Data
36f63dca 5417@subsection Output Section Data
252b5132
RH
5418@cindex data
5419@cindex section data
5420@cindex output section data
a4d5aec7 5421@kindex ASCIZ ``@var{string}''
252b5132
RH
5422@kindex BYTE(@var{expression})
5423@kindex SHORT(@var{expression})
5424@kindex LONG(@var{expression})
5425@kindex QUAD(@var{expression})
5426@kindex SQUAD(@var{expression})
5427You can include explicit bytes of data in an output section by using
5428@code{BYTE}, @code{SHORT}, @code{LONG}, @code{QUAD}, or @code{SQUAD} as
5429an output section command. Each keyword is followed by an expression in
5430parentheses providing the value to store (@pxref{Expressions}). The
5431value of the expression is stored at the current value of the location
5432counter.
5433
5434The @code{BYTE}, @code{SHORT}, @code{LONG}, and @code{QUAD} commands
5435store one, two, four, and eight bytes (respectively). After storing the
5436bytes, the location counter is incremented by the number of bytes
5437stored.
5438
5439For example, this will store the byte 1 followed by the four byte value
5440of the symbol @samp{addr}:
5441@smallexample
5442BYTE(1)
5443LONG(addr)
5444@end smallexample
5445
5446When using a 64 bit host or target, @code{QUAD} and @code{SQUAD} are the
5447same; they both store an 8 byte, or 64 bit, value. When both host and
5448target are 32 bits, an expression is computed as 32 bits. In this case
5449@code{QUAD} stores a 32 bit value zero extended to 64 bits, and
5450@code{SQUAD} stores a 32 bit value sign extended to 64 bits.
5451
5452If the object file format of the output file has an explicit endianness,
5453which is the normal case, the value will be stored in that endianness.
5454When the object file format does not have an explicit endianness, as is
5455true of, for example, S-records, the value will be stored in the
5456endianness of the first input object file.
5457
a4d5aec7
AM
5458You can include a zero-terminated string in an output section by using
5459@code{ASCIZ}. The keyword is followed by a string which is stored at
5460the current value of the location counter adding a zero byte at the
5461end. If the string includes spaces it must be enclosed in double
5462quotes. The string may contain '\n', '\r', '\t' and octal numbers.
5463Hex numbers are not supported.
5464
5465For example, this string of 16 characters will create a 17 byte area
5466@smallexample
5467 ASCIZ "This is 16 bytes"
5468@end smallexample
5469
36f63dca 5470Note---these commands only work inside a section description and not
2b5fc1f5
NC
5471between them, so the following will produce an error from the linker:
5472@smallexample
5473SECTIONS @{@ .text : @{@ *(.text) @}@ LONG(1) .data : @{@ *(.data) @}@ @}@
5474@end smallexample
5475whereas this will work:
5476@smallexample
5477SECTIONS @{@ .text : @{@ *(.text) ; LONG(1) @}@ .data : @{@ *(.data) @}@ @}@
5478@end smallexample
75bd292b 5479
252b5132
RH
5480@kindex FILL(@var{expression})
5481@cindex holes, filling
5482@cindex unspecified memory
5483You may use the @code{FILL} command to set the fill pattern for the
5484current section. It is followed by an expression in parentheses. Any
5485otherwise unspecified regions of memory within the section (for example,
5486gaps left due to the required alignment of input sections) are filled
a139d329 5487with the value of the expression, repeated as
252b5132
RH
5488necessary. A @code{FILL} statement covers memory locations after the
5489point at which it occurs in the section definition; by including more
5490than one @code{FILL} statement, you can have different fill patterns in
5491different parts of an output section.
5492
5493This example shows how to fill unspecified regions of memory with the
563e308f 5494value @samp{0x90}:
252b5132 5495@smallexample
563e308f 5496FILL(0x90909090)
252b5132
RH
5497@end smallexample
5498
5499The @code{FILL} command is similar to the @samp{=@var{fillexp}} output
9673c93c 5500section attribute, but it only affects the
252b5132
RH
5501part of the section following the @code{FILL} command, rather than the
5502entire section. If both are used, the @code{FILL} command takes
9673c93c 5503precedence. @xref{Output Section Fill}, for details on the fill
a139d329 5504expression.
252b5132 5505
2d5783fa
NC
5506@kindex LINKER_VERSION
5507@cindex LINKER_VERSION
5508Inserts a string containing the version of the linker at the current
5509point. Note - by default this directive is disabled and will do
5510nothing. It only becomes active if the
5511@option{--enable-linker-version} command line option is used.
5512
5513Built-in linker scripts for ELF based targets already include this
5514directive in their @samp{.comment} section.
5515
252b5132 5516@node Output Section Keywords
36f63dca 5517@subsection Output Section Keywords
252b5132
RH
5518There are a couple of keywords which can appear as output section
5519commands.
5520
5521@table @code
5522@kindex CREATE_OBJECT_SYMBOLS
5523@cindex input filename symbols
5524@cindex filename symbols
5525@item CREATE_OBJECT_SYMBOLS
5526The command tells the linker to create a symbol for each input file.
5527The name of each symbol will be the name of the corresponding input
5528file. The section of each symbol will be the output section in which
5529the @code{CREATE_OBJECT_SYMBOLS} command appears.
5530
5531This is conventional for the a.out object file format. It is not
5532normally used for any other object file format.
5533
5534@kindex CONSTRUCTORS
5535@cindex C++ constructors, arranging in link
5536@cindex constructors, arranging in link
5537@item CONSTRUCTORS
5538When linking using the a.out object file format, the linker uses an
5539unusual set construct to support C++ global constructors and
5540destructors. When linking object file formats which do not support
5541arbitrary sections, such as ECOFF and XCOFF, the linker will
5542automatically recognize C++ global constructors and destructors by name.
5543For these object file formats, the @code{CONSTRUCTORS} command tells the
5544linker to place constructor information in the output section where the
5545@code{CONSTRUCTORS} command appears. The @code{CONSTRUCTORS} command is
5546ignored for other object file formats.
5547
5548The symbol @w{@code{__CTOR_LIST__}} marks the start of the global
7e69709c
AM
5549constructors, and the symbol @w{@code{__CTOR_END__}} marks the end.
5550Similarly, @w{@code{__DTOR_LIST__}} and @w{@code{__DTOR_END__}} mark
5551the start and end of the global destructors. The
252b5132
RH
5552first word in the list is the number of entries, followed by the address
5553of each constructor or destructor, followed by a zero word. The
5554compiler must arrange to actually run the code. For these object file
5555formats @sc{gnu} C++ normally calls constructors from a subroutine
5556@code{__main}; a call to @code{__main} is automatically inserted into
5557the startup code for @code{main}. @sc{gnu} C++ normally runs
5558destructors either by using @code{atexit}, or directly from the function
5559@code{exit}.
5560
5561For object file formats such as @code{COFF} or @code{ELF} which support
5562arbitrary section names, @sc{gnu} C++ will normally arrange to put the
5563addresses of global constructors and destructors into the @code{.ctors}
5564and @code{.dtors} sections. Placing the following sequence into your
5565linker script will build the sort of table which the @sc{gnu} C++
5566runtime code expects to see.
5567
5568@smallexample
5569 __CTOR_LIST__ = .;
5570 LONG((__CTOR_END__ - __CTOR_LIST__) / 4 - 2)
5571 *(.ctors)
5572 LONG(0)
5573 __CTOR_END__ = .;
5574 __DTOR_LIST__ = .;
5575 LONG((__DTOR_END__ - __DTOR_LIST__) / 4 - 2)
5576 *(.dtors)
5577 LONG(0)
5578 __DTOR_END__ = .;
5579@end smallexample
5580
5581If you are using the @sc{gnu} C++ support for initialization priority,
5582which provides some control over the order in which global constructors
5583are run, you must sort the constructors at link time to ensure that they
5584are executed in the correct order. When using the @code{CONSTRUCTORS}
bcaa7b3e
L
5585command, use @samp{SORT_BY_NAME(CONSTRUCTORS)} instead. When using the
5586@code{.ctors} and @code{.dtors} sections, use @samp{*(SORT_BY_NAME(.ctors))} and
5587@samp{*(SORT_BY_NAME(.dtors))} instead of just @samp{*(.ctors)} and
252b5132
RH
5588@samp{*(.dtors)}.
5589
5590Normally the compiler and linker will handle these issues automatically,
5591and you will not need to concern yourself with them. However, you may
5592need to consider this if you are using C++ and writing your own linker
5593scripts.
5594
5595@end table
5596
5597@node Output Section Discarding
36f63dca 5598@subsection Output Section Discarding
252b5132
RH
5599@cindex discarding sections
5600@cindex sections, discarding
5601@cindex removing sections
2edab91c
AM
5602The linker will not normally create output sections with no contents.
5603This is for convenience when referring to input sections that may or
5604may not be present in any of the input files. For example:
252b5132 5605@smallexample
49c13adb 5606.foo : @{ *(.foo) @}
252b5132
RH
5607@end smallexample
5608@noindent
5609will only create a @samp{.foo} section in the output file if there is a
74541ad4
AM
5610@samp{.foo} section in at least one input file, and if the input
5611sections are not all empty. Other link script directives that allocate
2edab91c
AM
5612space in an output section will also create the output section. So
5613too will assignments to dot even if the assignment does not create
5614space, except for @samp{. = 0}, @samp{. = . + 0}, @samp{. = sym},
5615@samp{. = . + sym} and @samp{. = ALIGN (. != 0, expr, 1)} when
5616@samp{sym} is an absolute symbol of value 0 defined in the script.
5617This allows you to force output of an empty section with @samp{. = .}.
74541ad4 5618
a0976ea4 5619The linker will ignore address assignments (@pxref{Output Section Address})
74541ad4
AM
5620on discarded output sections, except when the linker script defines
5621symbols in the output section. In that case the linker will obey
a0976ea4
AM
5622the address assignments, possibly advancing dot even though the
5623section is discarded.
252b5132
RH
5624
5625@cindex /DISCARD/
5626The special output section name @samp{/DISCARD/} may be used to discard
5627input sections. Any input sections which are assigned to an output
5628section named @samp{/DISCARD/} are not included in the output file.
5629
99fabbc9
JL
5630This can be used to discard input sections marked with the ELF flag
5631@code{SHF_GNU_RETAIN}, which would otherwise have been saved from linker
5632garbage collection.
5633
a2e098c3
NC
5634Note, sections that match the @samp{/DISCARD/} output section will be
5635discarded even if they are in an ELF section group which has other
5636members which are not being discarded. This is deliberate.
5637Discarding takes precedence over grouping.
5638
252b5132 5639@node Output Section Attributes
36f63dca 5640@subsection Output Section Attributes
252b5132
RH
5641@cindex output section attributes
5642We showed above that the full description of an output section looked
5643like this:
0c71d759 5644
252b5132 5645@smallexample
a1ab1d2a 5646@group
7e7d5768 5647@var{section} [@var{address}] [(@var{type})] :
0c71d759 5648 [AT(@var{lma})]
3bbec4bd 5649 [ALIGN(@var{section_align}) | ALIGN_WITH_INPUT]
0c71d759
NC
5650 [SUBALIGN(@var{subsection_align})]
5651 [@var{constraint}]
252b5132
RH
5652 @{
5653 @var{output-section-command}
5654 @var{output-section-command}
5655 @dots{}
562d3460 5656 @} [>@var{region}] [AT>@var{lma_region}] [:@var{phdr} :@var{phdr} @dots{}] [=@var{fillexp}]
252b5132
RH
5657@end group
5658@end smallexample
0c71d759 5659
252b5132
RH
5660We've already described @var{section}, @var{address}, and
5661@var{output-section-command}. In this section we will describe the
5662remaining section attributes.
5663
a1ab1d2a 5664@menu
252b5132
RH
5665* Output Section Type:: Output section type
5666* Output Section LMA:: Output section LMA
bbf115d3 5667* Forced Output Alignment:: Forced Output Alignment
7e7d5768 5668* Forced Input Alignment:: Forced Input Alignment
0c71d759 5669* Output Section Constraint:: Output section constraint
252b5132
RH
5670* Output Section Region:: Output section region
5671* Output Section Phdr:: Output section phdr
5672* Output Section Fill:: Output section fill
5673@end menu
5674
5675@node Output Section Type
36f63dca 5676@subsubsection Output Section Type
252b5132
RH
5677Each output section may have a type. The type is a keyword in
5678parentheses. The following types are defined:
5679
5680@table @code
dcb53d93 5681
252b5132
RH
5682@item NOLOAD
5683The section should be marked as not loadable, so that it will not be
5684loaded into memory when the program is run.
dcb53d93 5685
6b86da53
LB
5686@item READONLY
5687The section should be marked as read-only.
dcb53d93 5688
252b5132 5689@item DSECT
c212f39d
FS
5690@item COPY
5691@item INFO
5692@item OVERLAY
252b5132
RH
5693These type names are supported for backward compatibility, and are
5694rarely used. They all have the same effect: the section should be
5695marked as not allocatable, so that no memory is allocated for the
5696section when the program is run.
dcb53d93 5697
c212f39d
FS
5698@item TYPE = @var{type}
5699Set the section type to the integer @var{type}. When generating an ELF
5700output file, type names @code{SHT_PROGBITS}, @code{SHT_STRTAB},
5c14cc55 5701@code{SHT_NOTE}, @code{SHT_NOBITS}, @code{SHT_INIT_ARRAY},
c212f39d
FS
5702@code{SHT_FINI_ARRAY}, and @code{SHT_PREINIT_ARRAY} are also allowed
5703for @var{type}. It is the user's responsibility to ensure that any
5704special requirements of the section type are met.
dcb53d93
NC
5705
5706Note - the TYPE only is used if some or all of the contents of the
5707section do not have an implicit type of their own. So for example:
5708@smallexample
5709 .foo . TYPE = SHT_PROGBITS @{ *(.bar) @}
5710@end smallexample
5711will set the type of section @samp{.foo} to the type of the section
5712@samp{.bar} in the input files, which may not be the SHT_PROGBITS
5713type. Whereas:
5714@smallexample
5715 .foo . TYPE = SHT_PROGBITS @{ BYTE(1) @}
5716@end smallexample
5717will set the type of @samp{.foo} to SHT_PROGBBITS. If it is necessary
5718to override the type of incoming sections and force the output section
5719type then an extra piece of untyped data will be needed:
5720@smallexample
5721 .foo . TYPE = SHT_PROGBITS @{ BYTE(1); *(.bar) @}
5722@end smallexample
5723
c212f39d
FS
5724@item READONLY ( TYPE = @var{type} )
5725This form of the syntax combines the @var{READONLY} type with the
5726type specified by @var{type}.
dcb53d93 5727
252b5132
RH
5728@end table
5729
5730@kindex NOLOAD
5731@cindex prevent unnecessary loading
5732@cindex loading, preventing
5733The linker normally sets the attributes of an output section based on
5734the input sections which map into it. You can override this by using
5735the section type. For example, in the script sample below, the
5736@samp{ROM} section is addressed at memory location @samp{0} and does not
2e76e85a 5737need to be loaded when the program is run.
252b5132
RH
5738@smallexample
5739@group
5740SECTIONS @{
5741 ROM 0 (NOLOAD) : @{ @dots{} @}
5742 @dots{}
5743@}
5744@end group
5745@end smallexample
5746
5747@node Output Section LMA
36f63dca 5748@subsubsection Output Section LMA
562d3460 5749@kindex AT>@var{lma_region}
252b5132
RH
5750@kindex AT(@var{lma})
5751@cindex load address
5752@cindex section load address
5753Every section has a virtual address (VMA) and a load address (LMA); see
ea5cae92
NC
5754@ref{Basic Script Concepts}. The virtual address is specified by the
5755@pxref{Output Section Address} described earlier. The load address is
5756specified by the @code{AT} or @code{AT>} keywords. Specifying a load
5757address is optional.
6bdafbeb 5758
ea5cae92
NC
5759The @code{AT} keyword takes an expression as an argument. This
5760specifies the exact load address of the section. The @code{AT>} keyword
5761takes the name of a memory region as an argument. @xref{MEMORY}. The
5762load address of the section is set to the next free address in the
5763region, aligned to the section's alignment requirements.
dc0b6aa0
AM
5764
5765If neither @code{AT} nor @code{AT>} is specified for an allocatable
ea5cae92
NC
5766section, the linker will use the following heuristic to determine the
5767load address:
5768
5769@itemize @bullet
5770@item
5771If the section has a specific VMA address, then this is used as
5772the LMA address as well.
5773
5774@item
5775If the section is not allocatable then its LMA is set to its VMA.
5776
5777@item
5778Otherwise if a memory region can be found that is compatible
5779with the current section, and this region contains at least one
5780section, then the LMA is set so the difference between the
5781VMA and LMA is the same as the difference between the VMA and LMA of
5782the last section in the located region.
5783
5784@item
5785If no memory regions have been declared then a default region
5786that covers the entire address space is used in the previous step.
5787
5788@item
5789If no suitable region could be found, or there was no previous
5790section then the LMA is set equal to the VMA.
5791@end itemize
252b5132
RH
5792
5793@cindex ROM initialized data
5794@cindex initialized data in ROM
5795This feature is designed to make it easy to build a ROM image. For
5796example, the following linker script creates three output sections: one
5797called @samp{.text}, which starts at @code{0x1000}, one called
5798@samp{.mdata}, which is loaded at the end of the @samp{.text} section
5799even though its VMA is @code{0x2000}, and one called @samp{.bss} to hold
5800uninitialized data at address @code{0x3000}. The symbol @code{_data} is
5801defined with the value @code{0x2000}, which shows that the location
5802counter holds the VMA value, not the LMA value.
5803
5804@smallexample
5805@group
5806SECTIONS
5807 @{
5808 .text 0x1000 : @{ *(.text) _etext = . ; @}
a1ab1d2a 5809 .mdata 0x2000 :
252b5132
RH
5810 AT ( ADDR (.text) + SIZEOF (.text) )
5811 @{ _data = . ; *(.data); _edata = . ; @}
5812 .bss 0x3000 :
5813 @{ _bstart = . ; *(.bss) *(COMMON) ; _bend = . ;@}
5814@}
5815@end group
5816@end smallexample
5817
5818The run-time initialization code for use with a program generated with
5819this linker script would include something like the following, to copy
5820the initialized data from the ROM image to its runtime address. Notice
5821how this code takes advantage of the symbols defined by the linker
5822script.
5823
5824@smallexample
5825@group
5826extern char _etext, _data, _edata, _bstart, _bend;
5827char *src = &_etext;
5828char *dst = &_data;
5829
ea5cae92
NC
5830/* ROM has data at end of text; copy it. */
5831while (dst < &_edata)
252b5132 5832 *dst++ = *src++;
252b5132 5833
ea5cae92 5834/* Zero bss. */
252b5132
RH
5835for (dst = &_bstart; dst< &_bend; dst++)
5836 *dst = 0;
5837@end group
5838@end smallexample
5839
bbf115d3
L
5840@node Forced Output Alignment
5841@subsubsection Forced Output Alignment
5842@kindex ALIGN(@var{section_align})
5843@cindex forcing output section alignment
5844@cindex output section alignment
1eec346e 5845You can increase an output section's alignment by using ALIGN. As an
13075d04
SH
5846alternative you can enforce that the difference between the VMA and LMA remains
5847intact throughout this output section with the ALIGN_WITH_INPUT attribute.
bbf115d3 5848
7e7d5768
AM
5849@node Forced Input Alignment
5850@subsubsection Forced Input Alignment
5851@kindex SUBALIGN(@var{subsection_align})
5852@cindex forcing input section alignment
5853@cindex input section alignment
5854You can force input section alignment within an output section by using
5855SUBALIGN. The value specified overrides any alignment given by input
5856sections, whether larger or smaller.
5857
0c71d759
NC
5858@node Output Section Constraint
5859@subsubsection Output Section Constraint
5860@kindex ONLY_IF_RO
5861@kindex ONLY_IF_RW
5862@cindex constraints on output sections
5863You can specify that an output section should only be created if all
5864of its input sections are read-only or all of its input sections are
5865read-write by using the keyword @code{ONLY_IF_RO} and
5866@code{ONLY_IF_RW} respectively.
5867
252b5132 5868@node Output Section Region
36f63dca 5869@subsubsection Output Section Region
252b5132
RH
5870@kindex >@var{region}
5871@cindex section, assigning to memory region
5872@cindex memory regions and sections
5873You can assign a section to a previously defined region of memory by
5874using @samp{>@var{region}}. @xref{MEMORY}.
5875
5876Here is a simple example:
5877@smallexample
5878@group
5879MEMORY @{ rom : ORIGIN = 0x1000, LENGTH = 0x1000 @}
5880SECTIONS @{ ROM : @{ *(.text) @} >rom @}
5881@end group
5882@end smallexample
5883
5884@node Output Section Phdr
36f63dca 5885@subsubsection Output Section Phdr
252b5132
RH
5886@kindex :@var{phdr}
5887@cindex section, assigning to program header
5888@cindex program headers and sections
5889You can assign a section to a previously defined program segment by
5890using @samp{:@var{phdr}}. @xref{PHDRS}. If a section is assigned to
5891one or more segments, then all subsequent allocated sections will be
5892assigned to those segments as well, unless they use an explicitly
5893@code{:@var{phdr}} modifier. You can use @code{:NONE} to tell the
5894linker to not put the section in any segment at all.
5895
5896Here is a simple example:
5897@smallexample
5898@group
5899PHDRS @{ text PT_LOAD ; @}
5900SECTIONS @{ .text : @{ *(.text) @} :text @}
5901@end group
5902@end smallexample
5903
5904@node Output Section Fill
36f63dca 5905@subsubsection Output Section Fill
252b5132
RH
5906@kindex =@var{fillexp}
5907@cindex section fill pattern
5908@cindex fill pattern, entire section
5909You can set the fill pattern for an entire section by using
5910@samp{=@var{fillexp}}. @var{fillexp} is an expression
5911(@pxref{Expressions}). Any otherwise unspecified regions of memory
5912within the output section (for example, gaps left due to the required
a139d329
AM
5913alignment of input sections) will be filled with the value, repeated as
5914necessary. If the fill expression is a simple hex number, ie. a string
9673c93c 5915of hex digit starting with @samp{0x} and without a trailing @samp{k} or @samp{M}, then
a139d329
AM
5916an arbitrarily long sequence of hex digits can be used to specify the
5917fill pattern; Leading zeros become part of the pattern too. For all
9673c93c 5918other cases, including extra parentheses or a unary @code{+}, the fill
a139d329
AM
5919pattern is the four least significant bytes of the value of the
5920expression. In all cases, the number is big-endian.
252b5132
RH
5921
5922You can also change the fill value with a @code{FILL} command in the
9673c93c 5923output section commands; (@pxref{Output Section Data}).
252b5132
RH
5924
5925Here is a simple example:
5926@smallexample
5927@group
563e308f 5928SECTIONS @{ .text : @{ *(.text) @} =0x90909090 @}
252b5132
RH
5929@end group
5930@end smallexample
5931
5932@node Overlay Description
36f63dca 5933@subsection Overlay Description
252b5132
RH
5934@kindex OVERLAY
5935@cindex overlays
5936An overlay description provides an easy way to describe sections which
5937are to be loaded as part of a single memory image but are to be run at
5938the same memory address. At run time, some sort of overlay manager will
5939copy the overlaid sections in and out of the runtime memory address as
5940required, perhaps by simply manipulating addressing bits. This approach
5941can be useful, for example, when a certain region of memory is faster
5942than another.
5943
5944Overlays are described using the @code{OVERLAY} command. The
5945@code{OVERLAY} command is used within a @code{SECTIONS} command, like an
5946output section description. The full syntax of the @code{OVERLAY}
5947command is as follows:
5948@smallexample
5949@group
5950OVERLAY [@var{start}] : [NOCROSSREFS] [AT ( @var{ldaddr} )]
5951 @{
5952 @var{secname1}
5953 @{
5954 @var{output-section-command}
5955 @var{output-section-command}
5956 @dots{}
5957 @} [:@var{phdr}@dots{}] [=@var{fill}]
5958 @var{secname2}
5959 @{
5960 @var{output-section-command}
5961 @var{output-section-command}
5962 @dots{}
5963 @} [:@var{phdr}@dots{}] [=@var{fill}]
5964 @dots{}
abc9061b 5965 @} [>@var{region}] [:@var{phdr}@dots{}] [=@var{fill}] [,]
252b5132
RH
5966@end group
5967@end smallexample
5968
5969Everything is optional except @code{OVERLAY} (a keyword), and each
5970section must have a name (@var{secname1} and @var{secname2} above). The
5971section definitions within the @code{OVERLAY} construct are identical to
11e7fd74 5972those within the general @code{SECTIONS} construct (@pxref{SECTIONS}),
252b5132
RH
5973except that no addresses and no memory regions may be defined for
5974sections within an @code{OVERLAY}.
5975
abc9061b
CC
5976The comma at the end may be required if a @var{fill} is used and
5977the next @var{sections-command} looks like a continuation of the expression.
5978
252b5132
RH
5979The sections are all defined with the same starting address. The load
5980addresses of the sections are arranged such that they are consecutive in
5981memory starting at the load address used for the @code{OVERLAY} as a
5982whole (as with normal section definitions, the load address is optional,
5983and defaults to the start address; the start address is also optional,
5984and defaults to the current value of the location counter).
5985
56dd11f0
NC
5986If the @code{NOCROSSREFS} keyword is used, and there are any
5987references among the sections, the linker will report an error. Since
5988the sections all run at the same address, it normally does not make
5989sense for one section to refer directly to another.
5990@xref{Miscellaneous Commands, NOCROSSREFS}.
252b5132
RH
5991
5992For each section within the @code{OVERLAY}, the linker automatically
34711ca3 5993provides two symbols. The symbol @code{__load_start_@var{secname}} is
252b5132
RH
5994defined as the starting load address of the section. The symbol
5995@code{__load_stop_@var{secname}} is defined as the final load address of
5996the section. Any characters within @var{secname} which are not legal
5997within C identifiers are removed. C (or assembler) code may use these
5998symbols to move the overlaid sections around as necessary.
5999
6000At the end of the overlay, the value of the location counter is set to
6001the start address of the overlay plus the size of the largest section.
6002
6003Here is an example. Remember that this would appear inside a
6004@code{SECTIONS} construct.
6005@smallexample
6006@group
6007 OVERLAY 0x1000 : AT (0x4000)
6008 @{
6009 .text0 @{ o1/*.o(.text) @}
6010 .text1 @{ o2/*.o(.text) @}
6011 @}
6012@end group
6013@end smallexample
6014@noindent
6015This will define both @samp{.text0} and @samp{.text1} to start at
6016address 0x1000. @samp{.text0} will be loaded at address 0x4000, and
6017@samp{.text1} will be loaded immediately after @samp{.text0}. The
34711ca3 6018following symbols will be defined if referenced: @code{__load_start_text0},
252b5132
RH
6019@code{__load_stop_text0}, @code{__load_start_text1},
6020@code{__load_stop_text1}.
6021
6022C code to copy overlay @code{.text1} into the overlay area might look
6023like the following.
6024
6025@smallexample
6026@group
6027 extern char __load_start_text1, __load_stop_text1;
6028 memcpy ((char *) 0x1000, &__load_start_text1,
6029 &__load_stop_text1 - &__load_start_text1);
6030@end group
6031@end smallexample
6032
6033Note that the @code{OVERLAY} command is just syntactic sugar, since
6034everything it does can be done using the more basic commands. The above
6035example could have been written identically as follows.
6036
6037@smallexample
6038@group
6039 .text0 0x1000 : AT (0x4000) @{ o1/*.o(.text) @}
34711ca3
AM
6040 PROVIDE (__load_start_text0 = LOADADDR (.text0));
6041 PROVIDE (__load_stop_text0 = LOADADDR (.text0) + SIZEOF (.text0));
252b5132 6042 .text1 0x1000 : AT (0x4000 + SIZEOF (.text0)) @{ o2/*.o(.text) @}
34711ca3
AM
6043 PROVIDE (__load_start_text1 = LOADADDR (.text1));
6044 PROVIDE (__load_stop_text1 = LOADADDR (.text1) + SIZEOF (.text1));
252b5132
RH
6045 . = 0x1000 + MAX (SIZEOF (.text0), SIZEOF (.text1));
6046@end group
6047@end smallexample
6048
6049@node MEMORY
36f63dca 6050@section MEMORY Command
252b5132
RH
6051@kindex MEMORY
6052@cindex memory regions
6053@cindex regions of memory
6054@cindex allocating memory
6055@cindex discontinuous memory
6056The linker's default configuration permits allocation of all available
6057memory. You can override this by using the @code{MEMORY} command.
6058
6059The @code{MEMORY} command describes the location and size of blocks of
6060memory in the target. You can use it to describe which memory regions
6061may be used by the linker, and which memory regions it must avoid. You
6062can then assign sections to particular memory regions. The linker will
6063set section addresses based on the memory regions, and will warn about
6064regions that become too full. The linker will not shuffle sections
6065around to fit into the available regions.
6066
127fcdff
AB
6067A linker script may contain many uses of the @code{MEMORY} command,
6068however, all memory blocks defined are treated as if they were
6069specified inside a single @code{MEMORY} command. The syntax for
6070@code{MEMORY} is:
252b5132
RH
6071@smallexample
6072@group
a1ab1d2a 6073MEMORY
252b5132
RH
6074 @{
6075 @var{name} [(@var{attr})] : ORIGIN = @var{origin}, LENGTH = @var{len}
6076 @dots{}
6077 @}
6078@end group
6079@end smallexample
6080
6081The @var{name} is a name used in the linker script to refer to the
6082region. The region name has no meaning outside of the linker script.
6083Region names are stored in a separate name space, and will not conflict
6084with symbol names, file names, or section names. Each memory region
4a93e180
NC
6085must have a distinct name within the @code{MEMORY} command. However you can
6086add later alias names to existing memory regions with the @ref{REGION_ALIAS}
9d5777a3 6087command.
252b5132
RH
6088
6089@cindex memory region attributes
6090The @var{attr} string is an optional list of attributes that specify
6091whether to use a particular memory region for an input section which is
6092not explicitly mapped in the linker script. As described in
6093@ref{SECTIONS}, if you do not specify an output section for some input
6094section, the linker will create an output section with the same name as
6095the input section. If you define region attributes, the linker will use
6096them to select the memory region for the output section that it creates.
6097
6098The @var{attr} string must consist only of the following characters:
6099@table @samp
6100@item R
6101Read-only section
6102@item W
6103Read/write section
6104@item X
6105Executable section
6106@item A
6107Allocatable section
6108@item I
6109Initialized section
6110@item L
6111Same as @samp{I}
6112@item !
c09e9a8c 6113Invert the sense of any of the attributes that follow
252b5132
RH
6114@end table
6115
81c688d5 6116If an unmapped section matches any of the listed attributes other than
252b5132 6117@samp{!}, it will be placed in the memory region. The @samp{!}
81c688d5
NC
6118attribute reverses the test for the characters that follow, so that an
6119unmapped section will be placed in the memory region only if it does
6120not match any of the attributes listed afterwards. Thus an attribute
6121string of @samp{RW!X} will match any unmapped section that has either
6122or both of the @samp{R} and @samp{W} attributes, but only as long as
6123the section does not also have the @samp{X} attribute.
252b5132
RH
6124
6125@kindex ORIGIN =
6126@kindex o =
6127@kindex org =
9cd6d51a
NC
6128The @var{origin} is an numerical expression for the start address of
6129the memory region. The expression must evaluate to a constant and it
6130cannot involve any symbols. The keyword @code{ORIGIN} may be
6131abbreviated to @code{org} or @code{o} (but not, for example,
6132@code{ORG}).
252b5132
RH
6133
6134@kindex LENGTH =
6135@kindex len =
6136@kindex l =
6137The @var{len} is an expression for the size in bytes of the memory
6138region. As with the @var{origin} expression, the expression must
9cd6d51a
NC
6139be numerical only and must evaluate to a constant. The keyword
6140@code{LENGTH} may be abbreviated to @code{len} or @code{l}.
252b5132
RH
6141
6142In the following example, we specify that there are two memory regions
6143available for allocation: one starting at @samp{0} for 256 kilobytes,
6144and the other starting at @samp{0x40000000} for four megabytes. The
6145linker will place into the @samp{rom} memory region every section which
6146is not explicitly mapped into a memory region, and is either read-only
6147or executable. The linker will place other sections which are not
6148explicitly mapped into a memory region into the @samp{ram} memory
6149region.
6150
6151@smallexample
6152@group
a1ab1d2a 6153MEMORY
252b5132
RH
6154 @{
6155 rom (rx) : ORIGIN = 0, LENGTH = 256K
6156 ram (!rx) : org = 0x40000000, l = 4M
6157 @}
6158@end group
6159@end smallexample
6160
6161Once you define a memory region, you can direct the linker to place
6162specific output sections into that memory region by using the
6163@samp{>@var{region}} output section attribute. For example, if you have
6164a memory region named @samp{mem}, you would use @samp{>mem} in the
6165output section definition. @xref{Output Section Region}. If no address
6166was specified for the output section, the linker will set the address to
6167the next available address within the memory region. If the combined
6168output sections directed to a memory region are too large for the
6169region, the linker will issue an error message.
6170
3ec57632 6171It is possible to access the origin and length of a memory in an
c0065db7 6172expression via the @code{ORIGIN(@var{memory})} and
3ec57632
NC
6173@code{LENGTH(@var{memory})} functions:
6174
6175@smallexample
6176@group
c0065db7 6177 _fstack = ORIGIN(ram) + LENGTH(ram) - 4;
3ec57632
NC
6178@end group
6179@end smallexample
6180
252b5132
RH
6181@node PHDRS
6182@section PHDRS Command
6183@kindex PHDRS
6184@cindex program headers
6185@cindex ELF program headers
6186@cindex program segments
6187@cindex segments, ELF
6188The ELF object file format uses @dfn{program headers}, also knows as
6189@dfn{segments}. The program headers describe how the program should be
6190loaded into memory. You can print them out by using the @code{objdump}
6191program with the @samp{-p} option.
6192
6193When you run an ELF program on a native ELF system, the system loader
6194reads the program headers in order to figure out how to load the
6195program. This will only work if the program headers are set correctly.
6196This manual does not describe the details of how the system loader
6197interprets program headers; for more information, see the ELF ABI.
6198
6199The linker will create reasonable program headers by default. However,
6200in some cases, you may need to specify the program headers more
6201precisely. You may use the @code{PHDRS} command for this purpose. When
6202the linker sees the @code{PHDRS} command in the linker script, it will
6203not create any program headers other than the ones specified.
6204
6205The linker only pays attention to the @code{PHDRS} command when
6206generating an ELF output file. In other cases, the linker will simply
6207ignore @code{PHDRS}.
6208
6209This is the syntax of the @code{PHDRS} command. The words @code{PHDRS},
6210@code{FILEHDR}, @code{AT}, and @code{FLAGS} are keywords.
6211
6212@smallexample
6213@group
6214PHDRS
6215@{
6216 @var{name} @var{type} [ FILEHDR ] [ PHDRS ] [ AT ( @var{address} ) ]
6217 [ FLAGS ( @var{flags} ) ] ;
6218@}
6219@end group
6220@end smallexample
6221
6222The @var{name} is used only for reference in the @code{SECTIONS} command
6223of the linker script. It is not put into the output file. Program
6224header names are stored in a separate name space, and will not conflict
6225with symbol names, file names, or section names. Each program header
5c1a3f0f
NS
6226must have a distinct name. The headers are processed in order and it
6227is usual for them to map to sections in ascending load address order.
252b5132
RH
6228
6229Certain program header types describe segments of memory which the
6230system loader will load from the file. In the linker script, you
6231specify the contents of these segments by placing allocatable output
6232sections in the segments. You use the @samp{:@var{phdr}} output section
6233attribute to place a section in a particular segment. @xref{Output
6234Section Phdr}.
6235
6236It is normal to put certain sections in more than one segment. This
6237merely implies that one segment of memory contains another. You may
6238repeat @samp{:@var{phdr}}, using it once for each segment which should
6239contain the section.
6240
6241If you place a section in one or more segments using @samp{:@var{phdr}},
6242then the linker will place all subsequent allocatable sections which do
6243not specify @samp{:@var{phdr}} in the same segments. This is for
6244convenience, since generally a whole set of contiguous sections will be
6245placed in a single segment. You can use @code{:NONE} to override the
6246default segment and tell the linker to not put the section in any
6247segment at all.
6248
6249@kindex FILEHDR
6250@kindex PHDRS
5c1a3f0f 6251You may use the @code{FILEHDR} and @code{PHDRS} keywords after
252b5132
RH
6252the program header type to further describe the contents of the segment.
6253The @code{FILEHDR} keyword means that the segment should include the ELF
6254file header. The @code{PHDRS} keyword means that the segment should
5c1a3f0f 6255include the ELF program headers themselves. If applied to a loadable
4100cea3
AM
6256segment (@code{PT_LOAD}), all prior loadable segments must have one of
6257these keywords.
252b5132
RH
6258
6259The @var{type} may be one of the following. The numbers indicate the
6260value of the keyword.
6261
6262@table @asis
6263@item @code{PT_NULL} (0)
6264Indicates an unused program header.
6265
6266@item @code{PT_LOAD} (1)
6267Indicates that this program header describes a segment to be loaded from
6268the file.
6269
6270@item @code{PT_DYNAMIC} (2)
6271Indicates a segment where dynamic linking information can be found.
6272
6273@item @code{PT_INTERP} (3)
6274Indicates a segment where the name of the program interpreter may be
6275found.
6276
6277@item @code{PT_NOTE} (4)
6278Indicates a segment holding note information.
6279
6280@item @code{PT_SHLIB} (5)
6281A reserved program header type, defined but not specified by the ELF
6282ABI.
6283
6284@item @code{PT_PHDR} (6)
6285Indicates a segment where the program headers may be found.
6286
1a9ccd70
NC
6287@item @code{PT_TLS} (7)
6288Indicates a segment containing thread local storage.
6289
252b5132
RH
6290@item @var{expression}
6291An expression giving the numeric type of the program header. This may
6292be used for types not defined above.
6293@end table
6294
6295You can specify that a segment should be loaded at a particular address
6296in memory by using an @code{AT} expression. This is identical to the
6297@code{AT} command used as an output section attribute (@pxref{Output
6298Section LMA}). The @code{AT} command for a program header overrides the
6299output section attribute.
6300
6301The linker will normally set the segment flags based on the sections
6302which comprise the segment. You may use the @code{FLAGS} keyword to
6303explicitly specify the segment flags. The value of @var{flags} must be
6304an integer. It is used to set the @code{p_flags} field of the program
6305header.
6306
6307Here is an example of @code{PHDRS}. This shows a typical set of program
6308headers used on a native ELF system.
6309
6310@example
6311@group
6312PHDRS
6313@{
6314 headers PT_PHDR PHDRS ;
6315 interp PT_INTERP ;
6316 text PT_LOAD FILEHDR PHDRS ;
6317 data PT_LOAD ;
6318 dynamic PT_DYNAMIC ;
6319@}
6320
6321SECTIONS
6322@{
6323 . = SIZEOF_HEADERS;
6324 .interp : @{ *(.interp) @} :text :interp
6325 .text : @{ *(.text) @} :text
6326 .rodata : @{ *(.rodata) @} /* defaults to :text */
6327 @dots{}
6328 . = . + 0x1000; /* move to a new page in memory */
6329 .data : @{ *(.data) @} :data
6330 .dynamic : @{ *(.dynamic) @} :data :dynamic
6331 @dots{}
6332@}
6333@end group
6334@end example
6335
6336@node VERSION
6337@section VERSION Command
6338@kindex VERSION @{script text@}
6339@cindex symbol versions
6340@cindex version script
6341@cindex versions of symbols
6342The linker supports symbol versions when using ELF. Symbol versions are
6343only useful when using shared libraries. The dynamic linker can use
6344symbol versions to select a specific version of a function when it runs
6345a program that may have been linked against an earlier version of the
6346shared library.
6347
6348You can include a version script directly in the main linker script, or
6349you can supply the version script as an implicit linker script. You can
6350also use the @samp{--version-script} linker option.
6351
6352The syntax of the @code{VERSION} command is simply
6353@smallexample
6354VERSION @{ version-script-commands @}
6355@end smallexample
6356
6357The format of the version script commands is identical to that used by
6358Sun's linker in Solaris 2.5. The version script defines a tree of
6359version nodes. You specify the node names and interdependencies in the
6360version script. You can specify which symbols are bound to which
6361version nodes, and you can reduce a specified set of symbols to local
6362scope so that they are not globally visible outside of the shared
6363library.
6364
6365The easiest way to demonstrate the version script language is with a few
6366examples.
6367
6368@smallexample
6369VERS_1.1 @{
6370 global:
6371 foo1;
6372 local:
a1ab1d2a
UD
6373 old*;
6374 original*;
6375 new*;
252b5132
RH
6376@};
6377
6378VERS_1.2 @{
6379 foo2;
6380@} VERS_1.1;
6381
6382VERS_2.0 @{
6383 bar1; bar2;
c0065db7 6384 extern "C++" @{
86043bbb 6385 ns::*;
bb1515f2
MF
6386 "f(int, double)";
6387 @};
252b5132
RH
6388@} VERS_1.2;
6389@end smallexample
6390
6391This example version script defines three version nodes. The first
6392version node defined is @samp{VERS_1.1}; it has no other dependencies.
6393The script binds the symbol @samp{foo1} to @samp{VERS_1.1}. It reduces
6394a number of symbols to local scope so that they are not visible outside
313e35ee
AM
6395of the shared library; this is done using wildcard patterns, so that any
6396symbol whose name begins with @samp{old}, @samp{original}, or @samp{new}
6397is matched. The wildcard patterns available are the same as those used
6398in the shell when matching filenames (also known as ``globbing'').
86043bbb
MM
6399However, if you specify the symbol name inside double quotes, then the
6400name is treated as literal, rather than as a glob pattern.
252b5132
RH
6401
6402Next, the version script defines node @samp{VERS_1.2}. This node
6403depends upon @samp{VERS_1.1}. The script binds the symbol @samp{foo2}
6404to the version node @samp{VERS_1.2}.
6405
6406Finally, the version script defines node @samp{VERS_2.0}. This node
6407depends upon @samp{VERS_1.2}. The scripts binds the symbols @samp{bar1}
6408and @samp{bar2} are bound to the version node @samp{VERS_2.0}.
6409
6410When the linker finds a symbol defined in a library which is not
6411specifically bound to a version node, it will effectively bind it to an
6412unspecified base version of the library. You can bind all otherwise
a981ed6f 6413unspecified symbols to a given version node by using @samp{global: *;}
ae5a3597
AM
6414somewhere in the version script. Note that it's slightly crazy to use
6415wildcards in a global spec except on the last version node. Global
6416wildcards elsewhere run the risk of accidentally adding symbols to the
6417set exported for an old version. That's wrong since older versions
6418ought to have a fixed set of symbols.
252b5132
RH
6419
6420The names of the version nodes have no specific meaning other than what
6421they might suggest to the person reading them. The @samp{2.0} version
6422could just as well have appeared in between @samp{1.1} and @samp{1.2}.
6423However, this would be a confusing way to write a version script.
6424
0f6bf451 6425Node name can be omitted, provided it is the only version node
6b9b879a
JJ
6426in the version script. Such version script doesn't assign any versions to
6427symbols, only selects which symbols will be globally visible out and which
6428won't.
6429
6430@smallexample
7c9c73be 6431@{ global: foo; bar; local: *; @};
9d201f2f 6432@end smallexample
6b9b879a 6433
252b5132
RH
6434When you link an application against a shared library that has versioned
6435symbols, the application itself knows which version of each symbol it
6436requires, and it also knows which version nodes it needs from each
6437shared library it is linked against. Thus at runtime, the dynamic
6438loader can make a quick check to make sure that the libraries you have
6439linked against do in fact supply all of the version nodes that the
6440application will need to resolve all of the dynamic symbols. In this
6441way it is possible for the dynamic linker to know with certainty that
6442all external symbols that it needs will be resolvable without having to
6443search for each symbol reference.
6444
6445The symbol versioning is in effect a much more sophisticated way of
6446doing minor version checking that SunOS does. The fundamental problem
6447that is being addressed here is that typically references to external
6448functions are bound on an as-needed basis, and are not all bound when
6449the application starts up. If a shared library is out of date, a
6450required interface may be missing; when the application tries to use
6451that interface, it may suddenly and unexpectedly fail. With symbol
6452versioning, the user will get a warning when they start their program if
6453the libraries being used with the application are too old.
6454
6455There are several GNU extensions to Sun's versioning approach. The
6456first of these is the ability to bind a symbol to a version node in the
6457source file where the symbol is defined instead of in the versioning
6458script. This was done mainly to reduce the burden on the library
6459maintainer. You can do this by putting something like:
6460@smallexample
6461__asm__(".symver original_foo,foo@@VERS_1.1");
6462@end smallexample
6463@noindent
6464in the C source file. This renames the function @samp{original_foo} to
6465be an alias for @samp{foo} bound to the version node @samp{VERS_1.1}.
6466The @samp{local:} directive can be used to prevent the symbol
96a94295
L
6467@samp{original_foo} from being exported. A @samp{.symver} directive
6468takes precedence over a version script.
252b5132
RH
6469
6470The second GNU extension is to allow multiple versions of the same
6471function to appear in a given shared library. In this way you can make
6472an incompatible change to an interface without increasing the major
6473version number of the shared library, while still allowing applications
6474linked against the old interface to continue to function.
6475
6476To do this, you must use multiple @samp{.symver} directives in the
6477source file. Here is an example:
6478
6479@smallexample
6480__asm__(".symver original_foo,foo@@");
6481__asm__(".symver old_foo,foo@@VERS_1.1");
6482__asm__(".symver old_foo1,foo@@VERS_1.2");
6483__asm__(".symver new_foo,foo@@@@VERS_2.0");
6484@end smallexample
6485
6486In this example, @samp{foo@@} represents the symbol @samp{foo} bound to the
6487unspecified base version of the symbol. The source file that contains this
6488example would define 4 C functions: @samp{original_foo}, @samp{old_foo},
6489@samp{old_foo1}, and @samp{new_foo}.
6490
6491When you have multiple definitions of a given symbol, there needs to be
6492some way to specify a default version to which external references to
6493this symbol will be bound. You can do this with the
6494@samp{foo@@@@VERS_2.0} type of @samp{.symver} directive. You can only
6495declare one version of a symbol as the default in this manner; otherwise
6496you would effectively have multiple definitions of the same symbol.
6497
6498If you wish to bind a reference to a specific version of the symbol
6499within the shared library, you can use the aliases of convenience
36f63dca 6500(i.e., @samp{old_foo}), or you can use the @samp{.symver} directive to
252b5132
RH
6501specifically bind to an external version of the function in question.
6502
cb840a31
L
6503You can also specify the language in the version script:
6504
6505@smallexample
6506VERSION extern "lang" @{ version-script-commands @}
6507@end smallexample
6508
c0065db7 6509The supported @samp{lang}s are @samp{C}, @samp{C++}, and @samp{Java}.
cb840a31
L
6510The linker will iterate over the list of symbols at the link time and
6511demangle them according to @samp{lang} before matching them to the
bb1515f2
MF
6512patterns specified in @samp{version-script-commands}. The default
6513@samp{lang} is @samp{C}.
cb840a31 6514
86043bbb
MM
6515Demangled names may contains spaces and other special characters. As
6516described above, you can use a glob pattern to match demangled names,
6517or you can use a double-quoted string to match the string exactly. In
6518the latter case, be aware that minor differences (such as differing
6519whitespace) between the version script and the demangler output will
6520cause a mismatch. As the exact string generated by the demangler
6521might change in the future, even if the mangled name does not, you
6522should check that all of your version directives are behaving as you
6523expect when you upgrade.
6524
252b5132
RH
6525@node Expressions
6526@section Expressions in Linker Scripts
6527@cindex expressions
6528@cindex arithmetic
6529The syntax for expressions in the linker script language is identical to
fb0afe4c
AM
6530that of C expressions, except that whitespace is required in some
6531places to resolve syntactic ambiguities. All expressions are
6532evaluated as integers. All expressions are evaluated in the same
6533size, which is 32 bits if both the host and target are 32 bits, and is
6534otherwise 64 bits.
252b5132
RH
6535
6536You can use and set symbol values in expressions.
6537
6538The linker defines several special purpose builtin functions for use in
6539expressions.
6540
6541@menu
6542* Constants:: Constants
0c71d759 6543* Symbolic Constants:: Symbolic constants
252b5132 6544* Symbols:: Symbol Names
ecca9871 6545* Orphan Sections:: Orphan Sections
252b5132
RH
6546* Location Counter:: The Location Counter
6547* Operators:: Operators
6548* Evaluation:: Evaluation
6549* Expression Section:: The Section of an Expression
6550* Builtin Functions:: Builtin Functions
6551@end menu
6552
6553@node Constants
6554@subsection Constants
6555@cindex integer notation
6556@cindex constants in linker scripts
6557All constants are integers.
6558
6559As in C, the linker considers an integer beginning with @samp{0} to be
6560octal, and an integer beginning with @samp{0x} or @samp{0X} to be
8a308ae8 6561hexadecimal. Alternatively the linker accepts suffixes of @samp{h} or
11e7fd74 6562@samp{H} for hexadecimal, @samp{o} or @samp{O} for octal, @samp{b} or
8a308ae8
NC
6563@samp{B} for binary and @samp{d} or @samp{D} for decimal. Any integer
6564value without a prefix or a suffix is considered to be decimal.
252b5132
RH
6565
6566@cindex scaled integers
6567@cindex K and M integer suffixes
6568@cindex M and K integer suffixes
6569@cindex suffixes for integers
6570@cindex integer suffixes
6571In addition, you can use the suffixes @code{K} and @code{M} to scale a
6572constant by
6573@c TEXI2ROFF-KILL
36f63dca 6574@ifnottex
252b5132
RH
6575@c END TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6576@code{1024} or @code{1024*1024}
6577@c TEXI2ROFF-KILL
36f63dca 6578@end ifnottex
252b5132
RH
6579@tex
6580${\rm 1024}$ or ${\rm 1024}^2$
6581@end tex
6582@c END TEXI2ROFF-KILL
8a308ae8
NC
6583respectively. For example, the following
6584all refer to the same quantity:
6585
252b5132 6586@smallexample
36f63dca
NC
6587_fourk_1 = 4K;
6588_fourk_2 = 4096;
6589_fourk_3 = 0x1000;
8a308ae8 6590_fourk_4 = 10000o;
252b5132
RH
6591@end smallexample
6592
8a308ae8
NC
6593Note - the @code{K} and @code{M} suffixes cannot be used in
6594conjunction with the base suffixes mentioned above.
6595
0c71d759
NC
6596@node Symbolic Constants
6597@subsection Symbolic Constants
6598@cindex symbolic constants
6599@kindex CONSTANT
a094d01f 6600It is possible to refer to target-specific constants via the use of
0c71d759
NC
6601the @code{CONSTANT(@var{name})} operator, where @var{name} is one of:
6602
6603@table @code
6604@item MAXPAGESIZE
6605@kindex MAXPAGESIZE
6606The target's maximum page size.
6607
6608@item COMMONPAGESIZE
6609@kindex COMMONPAGESIZE
6610The target's default page size.
6611@end table
6612
6613So for example:
6614
6615@smallexample
9d5777a3 6616 .text ALIGN (CONSTANT (MAXPAGESIZE)) : @{ *(.text) @}
0c71d759
NC
6617@end smallexample
6618
6619will create a text section aligned to the largest page boundary
6620supported by the target.
6621
252b5132
RH
6622@node Symbols
6623@subsection Symbol Names
6624@cindex symbol names
6625@cindex names
6626@cindex quoted symbol names
6627@kindex "
6628Unless quoted, symbol names start with a letter, underscore, or period
6629and may include letters, digits, underscores, periods, and hyphens.
6630Unquoted symbol names must not conflict with any keywords. You can
6631specify a symbol which contains odd characters or has the same name as a
6632keyword by surrounding the symbol name in double quotes:
6633@smallexample
36f63dca
NC
6634"SECTION" = 9;
6635"with a space" = "also with a space" + 10;
252b5132
RH
6636@end smallexample
6637
6638Since symbols can contain many non-alphabetic characters, it is safest
6639to delimit symbols with spaces. For example, @samp{A-B} is one symbol,
6640whereas @samp{A - B} is an expression involving subtraction.
6641
ecca9871
L
6642@node Orphan Sections
6643@subsection Orphan Sections
6644@cindex orphan
6645Orphan sections are sections present in the input files which
6646are not explicitly placed into the output file by the linker
6647script. The linker will still copy these sections into the
a87ded7b
AB
6648output file by either finding, or creating a suitable output section
6649in which to place the orphaned input section.
6650
6651If the name of an orphaned input section exactly matches the name of
6652an existing output section, then the orphaned input section will be
6653placed at the end of that output section.
6654
6655If there is no output section with a matching name then new output
6656sections will be created. Each new output section will have the same
6657name as the orphan section placed within it. If there are multiple
6658orphan sections with the same name, these will all be combined into
6659one new output section.
6660
6661If new output sections are created to hold orphaned input sections,
6662then the linker must decide where to place these new output sections
e299b355
AM
6663in relation to existing output sections. On most modern targets, the
6664linker attempts to place orphan sections after sections of the same
6665attribute, such as code vs data, loadable vs non-loadable, etc. If no
6666sections with matching attributes are found, or your target lacks this
6667support, the orphan section is placed at the end of the file.
ecca9871 6668
a05a5b64
TP
6669The command-line options @samp{--orphan-handling} and @samp{--unique}
6670(@pxref{Options,,Command-line Options}) can be used to control which
c005eb9e
AB
6671output sections an orphan is placed in.
6672
252b5132
RH
6673@node Location Counter
6674@subsection The Location Counter
6675@kindex .
6676@cindex dot
6677@cindex location counter
6678@cindex current output location
6679The special linker variable @dfn{dot} @samp{.} always contains the
6680current output location counter. Since the @code{.} always refers to a
6681location in an output section, it may only appear in an expression
6682within a @code{SECTIONS} command. The @code{.} symbol may appear
6683anywhere that an ordinary symbol is allowed in an expression.
6684
6685@cindex holes
6686Assigning a value to @code{.} will cause the location counter to be
6687moved. This may be used to create holes in the output section. The
dc0b6aa0
AM
6688location counter may not be moved backwards inside an output section,
6689and may not be moved backwards outside of an output section if so
6690doing creates areas with overlapping LMAs.
252b5132
RH
6691
6692@smallexample
6693SECTIONS
6694@{
6695 output :
6696 @{
6697 file1(.text)
6698 . = . + 1000;
6699 file2(.text)
6700 . += 1000;
6701 file3(.text)
563e308f 6702 @} = 0x12345678;
252b5132
RH
6703@}
6704@end smallexample
6705@noindent
6706In the previous example, the @samp{.text} section from @file{file1} is
6707located at the beginning of the output section @samp{output}. It is
6708followed by a 1000 byte gap. Then the @samp{.text} section from
6709@file{file2} appears, also with a 1000 byte gap following before the
563e308f 6710@samp{.text} section from @file{file3}. The notation @samp{= 0x12345678}
252b5132
RH
6711specifies what data to write in the gaps (@pxref{Output Section Fill}).
6712
5c6bbab8
NC
6713@cindex dot inside sections
6714Note: @code{.} actually refers to the byte offset from the start of the
6715current containing object. Normally this is the @code{SECTIONS}
69da35b5 6716statement, whose start address is 0, hence @code{.} can be used as an
5c6bbab8
NC
6717absolute address. If @code{.} is used inside a section description
6718however, it refers to the byte offset from the start of that section,
6719not an absolute address. Thus in a script like this:
6720
6721@smallexample
6722SECTIONS
6723@{
6724 . = 0x100
6725 .text: @{
6726 *(.text)
6727 . = 0x200
6728 @}
6729 . = 0x500
6730 .data: @{
6731 *(.data)
6732 . += 0x600
6733 @}
6734@}
6735@end smallexample
6736
6737The @samp{.text} section will be assigned a starting address of 0x100
6738and a size of exactly 0x200 bytes, even if there is not enough data in
6739the @samp{.text} input sections to fill this area. (If there is too
6740much data, an error will be produced because this would be an attempt to
6741move @code{.} backwards). The @samp{.data} section will start at 0x500
6742and it will have an extra 0x600 bytes worth of space after the end of
6743the values from the @samp{.data} input sections and before the end of
6744the @samp{.data} output section itself.
6745
b5666f2f
AM
6746@cindex dot outside sections
6747Setting symbols to the value of the location counter outside of an
6748output section statement can result in unexpected values if the linker
6749needs to place orphan sections. For example, given the following:
6750
6751@smallexample
6752SECTIONS
6753@{
6754 start_of_text = . ;
6755 .text: @{ *(.text) @}
6756 end_of_text = . ;
6757
6758 start_of_data = . ;
6759 .data: @{ *(.data) @}
6760 end_of_data = . ;
6761@}
6762@end smallexample
6763
6764If the linker needs to place some input section, e.g. @code{.rodata},
6765not mentioned in the script, it might choose to place that section
6766between @code{.text} and @code{.data}. You might think the linker
6767should place @code{.rodata} on the blank line in the above script, but
6768blank lines are of no particular significance to the linker. As well,
6769the linker doesn't associate the above symbol names with their
6770sections. Instead, it assumes that all assignments or other
6771statements belong to the previous output section, except for the
6772special case of an assignment to @code{.}. I.e., the linker will
6773place the orphan @code{.rodata} section as if the script was written
6774as follows:
6775
6776@smallexample
6777SECTIONS
6778@{
6779 start_of_text = . ;
6780 .text: @{ *(.text) @}
6781 end_of_text = . ;
6782
6783 start_of_data = . ;
6784 .rodata: @{ *(.rodata) @}
6785 .data: @{ *(.data) @}
6786 end_of_data = . ;
6787@}
6788@end smallexample
6789
6790This may or may not be the script author's intention for the value of
6791@code{start_of_data}. One way to influence the orphan section
6792placement is to assign the location counter to itself, as the linker
6793assumes that an assignment to @code{.} is setting the start address of
6794a following output section and thus should be grouped with that
6795section. So you could write:
6796
6797@smallexample
6798SECTIONS
6799@{
6800 start_of_text = . ;
6801 .text: @{ *(.text) @}
6802 end_of_text = . ;
6803
6804 . = . ;
6805 start_of_data = . ;
6806 .data: @{ *(.data) @}
6807 end_of_data = . ;
6808@}
6809@end smallexample
6810
6811Now, the orphan @code{.rodata} section will be placed between
6812@code{end_of_text} and @code{start_of_data}.
6813
252b5132
RH
6814@need 2000
6815@node Operators
6816@subsection Operators
6817@cindex operators for arithmetic
6818@cindex arithmetic operators
6819@cindex precedence in expressions
6820The linker recognizes the standard C set of arithmetic operators, with
6821the standard bindings and precedence levels:
6822@c TEXI2ROFF-KILL
36f63dca 6823@ifnottex
252b5132
RH
6824@c END TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6825@smallexample
b5c37946 6826precedence associativity Operators Notes
252b5132 6827(highest)
b5c37946 68281 left ! - ~ (1)
252b5132
RH
68292 left * / %
68303 left + -
68314 left >> <<
b5c37946
SJ
68325 left > < <= >=
68336 left == !=
68347 left &
68358 left ^
68369 left |
683710 left &&
683811 left ||
683912 right ? :
684013 right += -= *= /= <<= >>= &= |= ^= (2)
252b5132
RH
6841(lowest)
6842@end smallexample
6843Notes:
a1ab1d2a 6844(1) Prefix operators
252b5132
RH
6845(2) @xref{Assignments}.
6846@c TEXI2ROFF-KILL
36f63dca 6847@end ifnottex
252b5132
RH
6848@tex
6849\vskip \baselineskip
6850%"lispnarrowing" is the extra indent used generally for smallexample
6851\hskip\lispnarrowing\vbox{\offinterlineskip
6852\hrule
6853\halign
6854{\vrule#&\strut\hfil\ #\ \hfil&\vrule#&\strut\hfil\ #\ \hfil&\vrule#&\strut\hfil\ {\tt #}\ \hfil&\vrule#\cr
6855height2pt&\omit&&\omit&&\omit&\cr
6856&Precedence&& Associativity &&{\rm Operators}&\cr
6857height2pt&\omit&&\omit&&\omit&\cr
6858\noalign{\hrule}
6859height2pt&\omit&&\omit&&\omit&\cr
6860&highest&&&&&\cr
6861% '176 is tilde, '~' in tt font
a1ab1d2a 6862&1&&left&&\qquad- \char'176\ !\qquad\dag&\cr
252b5132
RH
6863&2&&left&&* / \%&\cr
6864&3&&left&&+ -&\cr
6865&4&&left&&>> <<&\cr
b5c37946
SJ
6866&5&&left&& > < <= >=&\cr
6867&6&&left&&== !=&\cr
6868&7&&left&&\&&\cr
6869&8&&left&&\^{}&\cr
6870&9&&left&&|&\cr
6871&10&&left&&{\&\&}&\cr
6872&11&&left&&||&\cr
6873&12&&right&&? :&\cr
6874&13&&right&&\qquad += -= *= /= <<= >>= \&= |= \^{}=\qquad\ddag&\cr
252b5132
RH
6875&lowest&&&&&\cr
6876height2pt&\omit&&\omit&&\omit&\cr}
6877\hrule}
6878@end tex
6879@iftex
6880{
6881@obeylines@parskip=0pt@parindent=0pt
6882@dag@quad Prefix operators.
6883@ddag@quad @xref{Assignments}.
6884}
6885@end iftex
6886@c END TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6887
6888@node Evaluation
6889@subsection Evaluation
6890@cindex lazy evaluation
6891@cindex expression evaluation order
6892The linker evaluates expressions lazily. It only computes the value of
6893an expression when absolutely necessary.
6894
6895The linker needs some information, such as the value of the start
6896address of the first section, and the origins and lengths of memory
6897regions, in order to do any linking at all. These values are computed
6898as soon as possible when the linker reads in the linker script.
6899
6900However, other values (such as symbol values) are not known or needed
6901until after storage allocation. Such values are evaluated later, when
6902other information (such as the sizes of output sections) is available
6903for use in the symbol assignment expression.
6904
6905The sizes of sections cannot be known until after allocation, so
6906assignments dependent upon these are not performed until after
6907allocation.
6908
6909Some expressions, such as those depending upon the location counter
6910@samp{.}, must be evaluated during section allocation.
6911
6912If the result of an expression is required, but the value is not
6913available, then an error results. For example, a script like the
6914following
6915@smallexample
6916@group
6917SECTIONS
6918 @{
a1ab1d2a 6919 .text 9+this_isnt_constant :
252b5132
RH
6920 @{ *(.text) @}
6921 @}
6922@end group
6923@end smallexample
6924@noindent
6925will cause the error message @samp{non constant expression for initial
6926address}.
6927
6928@node Expression Section
6929@subsection The Section of an Expression
6930@cindex expression sections
6931@cindex absolute expressions
6932@cindex relative expressions
6933@cindex absolute and relocatable symbols
6934@cindex relocatable and absolute symbols
6935@cindex symbols, relocatable and absolute
7542af2a
AM
6936Addresses and symbols may be section relative, or absolute. A section
6937relative symbol is relocatable. If you request relocatable output
6938using the @samp{-r} option, a further link operation may change the
6939value of a section relative symbol. On the other hand, an absolute
6940symbol will retain the same value throughout any further link
6941operations.
6942
abf4be64
AM
6943Some terms in linker expressions are addresses. This is true of
6944section relative symbols and for builtin functions that return an
6945address, such as @code{ADDR}, @code{LOADADDR}, @code{ORIGIN} and
6946@code{SEGMENT_START}. Other terms are simply numbers, or are builtin
6947functions that return a non-address value, such as @code{LENGTH}.
01554a74
AM
6948One complication is that unless you set @code{LD_FEATURE ("SANE_EXPR")}
6949(@pxref{Miscellaneous Commands}), numbers and absolute symbols are treated
5c3049d2
AM
6950differently depending on their location, for compatibility with older
6951versions of @code{ld}. Expressions appearing outside an output
6952section definition treat all numbers as absolute addresses.
6953Expressions appearing inside an output section definition treat
01554a74
AM
6954absolute symbols as numbers. If @code{LD_FEATURE ("SANE_EXPR")} is
6955given, then absolute symbols and numbers are simply treated as numbers
6956everywhere.
5c3049d2
AM
6957
6958In the following simple example,
252b5132 6959
7542af2a
AM
6960@smallexample
6961@group
6962SECTIONS
6963 @{
6964 . = 0x100;
6965 __executable_start = 0x100;
6966 .data :
6967 @{
6968 . = 0x10;
6969 __data_start = 0x10;
6970 *(.data)
6971 @}
6972 @dots{}
6973 @}
6974@end group
6975@end smallexample
252b5132 6976
7542af2a
AM
6977both @code{.} and @code{__executable_start} are set to the absolute
6978address 0x100 in the first two assignments, then both @code{.} and
6979@code{__data_start} are set to 0x10 relative to the @code{.data}
6980section in the second two assignments.
252b5132 6981
5c3049d2
AM
6982For expressions involving numbers, relative addresses and absolute
6983addresses, ld follows these rules to evaluate terms:
7542af2a
AM
6984
6985@itemize @bullet
6986@item
c05f749e
AM
6987Unary operations on an absolute address or number, and binary
6988operations on two absolute addresses or two numbers, or between one
6989absolute address and a number, apply the operator to the value(s).
6990@item
7542af2a
AM
6991Unary operations on a relative address, and binary operations on two
6992relative addresses in the same section or between one relative address
6993and a number, apply the operator to the offset part of the address(es).
6994@item
c05f749e
AM
6995Other binary operations, that is, between two relative addresses not
6996in the same section, or between a relative address and an absolute
6997address, first convert any non-absolute term to an absolute address
6998before applying the operator.
7542af2a
AM
6999@end itemize
7000
7001The result section of each sub-expression is as follows:
7002
7003@itemize @bullet
7004@item
7005An operation involving only numbers results in a number.
7006@item
7007The result of comparisons, @samp{&&} and @samp{||} is also a number.
7008@item
9bc8bb33 7009The result of other binary arithmetic and logical operations on two
11e7fd74 7010relative addresses in the same section or two absolute addresses
94b41882
AM
7011(after above conversions) is also a number when
7012@code{LD_FEATURE ("SANE_EXPR")} or inside an output section definition
7013but an absolute address otherwise.
9bc8bb33
AM
7014@item
7015The result of other operations on relative addresses or one
7016relative address and a number, is a relative address in the same
7017section as the relative operand(s).
7542af2a
AM
7018@item
7019The result of other operations on absolute addresses (after above
7020conversions) is an absolute address.
7021@end itemize
252b5132
RH
7022
7023You can use the builtin function @code{ABSOLUTE} to force an expression
7024to be absolute when it would otherwise be relative. For example, to
7025create an absolute symbol set to the address of the end of the output
7026section @samp{.data}:
7027@smallexample
7028SECTIONS
7029 @{
7030 .data : @{ *(.data) _edata = ABSOLUTE(.); @}
7031 @}
7032@end smallexample
7033@noindent
7034If @samp{ABSOLUTE} were not used, @samp{_edata} would be relative to the
7035@samp{.data} section.
7036
7542af2a
AM
7037Using @code{LOADADDR} also forces an expression absolute, since this
7038particular builtin function returns an absolute address.
7039
252b5132
RH
7040@node Builtin Functions
7041@subsection Builtin Functions
7042@cindex functions in expressions
7043The linker script language includes a number of builtin functions for
7044use in linker script expressions.
7045
7046@table @code
7047@item ABSOLUTE(@var{exp})
7048@kindex ABSOLUTE(@var{exp})
7049@cindex expression, absolute
7050Return the absolute (non-relocatable, as opposed to non-negative) value
7051of the expression @var{exp}. Primarily useful to assign an absolute
7052value to a symbol within a section definition, where symbol values are
7053normally section relative. @xref{Expression Section}.
7054
7055@item ADDR(@var{section})
7056@kindex ADDR(@var{section})
7057@cindex section address in expression
7542af2a 7058Return the address (VMA) of the named @var{section}. Your
252b5132 7059script must previously have defined the location of that section. In
7542af2a
AM
7060the following example, @code{start_of_output_1}, @code{symbol_1} and
7061@code{symbol_2} are assigned equivalent values, except that
7062@code{symbol_1} will be relative to the @code{.output1} section while
7063the other two will be absolute:
252b5132
RH
7064@smallexample
7065@group
7066SECTIONS @{ @dots{}
7067 .output1 :
a1ab1d2a 7068 @{
252b5132
RH
7069 start_of_output_1 = ABSOLUTE(.);
7070 @dots{}
7071 @}
7072 .output :
7073 @{
7074 symbol_1 = ADDR(.output1);
7075 symbol_2 = start_of_output_1;
7076 @}
7077@dots{} @}
7078@end group
7079@end smallexample
7080
876f4090
NS
7081@item ALIGN(@var{align})
7082@itemx ALIGN(@var{exp},@var{align})
7083@kindex ALIGN(@var{align})
7084@kindex ALIGN(@var{exp},@var{align})
252b5132
RH
7085@cindex round up location counter
7086@cindex align location counter
876f4090
NS
7087@cindex round up expression
7088@cindex align expression
7089Return the location counter (@code{.}) or arbitrary expression aligned
7090to the next @var{align} boundary. The single operand @code{ALIGN}
7091doesn't change the value of the location counter---it just does
7092arithmetic on it. The two operand @code{ALIGN} allows an arbitrary
7093expression to be aligned upwards (@code{ALIGN(@var{align})} is
e0a3af22 7094equivalent to @code{ALIGN(ABSOLUTE(.), @var{align})}).
876f4090
NS
7095
7096Here is an example which aligns the output @code{.data} section to the
7097next @code{0x2000} byte boundary after the preceding section and sets a
7098variable within the section to the next @code{0x8000} boundary after the
7099input sections:
252b5132
RH
7100@smallexample
7101@group
7102SECTIONS @{ @dots{}
7103 .data ALIGN(0x2000): @{
7104 *(.data)
7105 variable = ALIGN(0x8000);
7106 @}
7107@dots{} @}
7108@end group
7109@end smallexample
7110@noindent
7111The first use of @code{ALIGN} in this example specifies the location of
7112a section because it is used as the optional @var{address} attribute of
7113a section definition (@pxref{Output Section Address}). The second use
7114of @code{ALIGN} is used to defines the value of a symbol.
7115
7116The builtin function @code{NEXT} is closely related to @code{ALIGN}.
7117
362c1d1a
NS
7118@item ALIGNOF(@var{section})
7119@kindex ALIGNOF(@var{section})
7120@cindex section alignment
7121Return the alignment in bytes of the named @var{section}, if that section has
b5c37946
SJ
7122been allocated, or zero if the section has not been allocated. If the
7123section does not exist in the linker script the linker will report an
7124error. If @var{section} is @code{NEXT_SECTION} then @code{ALIGNOF} will
7125return the alignment of the next allocated section specified in the
7126linker script, or zero if there is no such section. In the following
7127example, the alignment of the @code{.output} section is stored as the
7128first value in that section.
362c1d1a
NS
7129@smallexample
7130@group
7131SECTIONS@{ @dots{}
7132 .output @{
7133 LONG (ALIGNOF (.output))
7134 @dots{}
7135 @}
7136@dots{} @}
7137@end group
7138@end smallexample
7139
252b5132
RH
7140@item BLOCK(@var{exp})
7141@kindex BLOCK(@var{exp})
7142This is a synonym for @code{ALIGN}, for compatibility with older linker
7143scripts. It is most often seen when setting the address of an output
7144section.
7145
2d20f7bf
JJ
7146@item DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN(@var{maxpagesize}, @var{commonpagesize})
7147@kindex DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN(@var{maxpagesize}, @var{commonpagesize})
7148This is equivalent to either
7149@smallexample
7150(ALIGN(@var{maxpagesize}) + (. & (@var{maxpagesize} - 1)))
7151@end smallexample
7152or
7153@smallexample
fe6052e1
AM
7154(ALIGN(@var{maxpagesize})
7155 + ((. + @var{commonpagesize} - 1) & (@var{maxpagesize} - @var{commonpagesize})))
2d20f7bf
JJ
7156@end smallexample
7157@noindent
7158depending on whether the latter uses fewer @var{commonpagesize} sized pages
7159for the data segment (area between the result of this expression and
7160@code{DATA_SEGMENT_END}) than the former or not.
7161If the latter form is used, it means @var{commonpagesize} bytes of runtime
7162memory will be saved at the expense of up to @var{commonpagesize} wasted
7163bytes in the on-disk file.
7164
7165This expression can only be used directly in @code{SECTIONS} commands, not in
7166any output section descriptions and only once in the linker script.
7167@var{commonpagesize} should be less or equal to @var{maxpagesize} and should
def5c83c
AM
7168be the system page size the object wants to be optimized for while still
7169running on system page sizes up to @var{maxpagesize}. Note however
7170that @samp{-z relro} protection will not be effective if the system
7171page size is larger than @var{commonpagesize}.
2d20f7bf
JJ
7172
7173@noindent
7174Example:
7175@smallexample
7176 . = DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN(0x10000, 0x2000);
7177@end smallexample
7178
7179@item DATA_SEGMENT_END(@var{exp})
7180@kindex DATA_SEGMENT_END(@var{exp})
7181This defines the end of data segment for @code{DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN}
7182evaluation purposes.
7183
7184@smallexample
7185 . = DATA_SEGMENT_END(.);
7186@end smallexample
7187
a4f5ad88
JJ
7188@item DATA_SEGMENT_RELRO_END(@var{offset}, @var{exp})
7189@kindex DATA_SEGMENT_RELRO_END(@var{offset}, @var{exp})
7190This defines the end of the @code{PT_GNU_RELRO} segment when
eec2f3ed 7191@samp{-z relro} option is used.
a4f5ad88
JJ
7192When @samp{-z relro} option is not present, @code{DATA_SEGMENT_RELRO_END}
7193does nothing, otherwise @code{DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN} is padded so that
def5c83c
AM
7194@var{exp} + @var{offset} is aligned to the @var{commonpagesize}
7195argument given to @code{DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN}. If present in the linker
7196script, it must be placed between @code{DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN} and
eec2f3ed
AM
7197@code{DATA_SEGMENT_END}. Evaluates to the second argument plus any
7198padding needed at the end of the @code{PT_GNU_RELRO} segment due to
7199section alignment.
a4f5ad88
JJ
7200
7201@smallexample
7202 . = DATA_SEGMENT_RELRO_END(24, .);
7203@end smallexample
7204
252b5132
RH
7205@item DEFINED(@var{symbol})
7206@kindex DEFINED(@var{symbol})
7207@cindex symbol defaults
7208Return 1 if @var{symbol} is in the linker global symbol table and is
420e579c
HPN
7209defined before the statement using DEFINED in the script, otherwise
7210return 0. You can use this function to provide
252b5132
RH
7211default values for symbols. For example, the following script fragment
7212shows how to set a global symbol @samp{begin} to the first location in
7213the @samp{.text} section---but if a symbol called @samp{begin} already
7214existed, its value is preserved:
7215
7216@smallexample
7217@group
7218SECTIONS @{ @dots{}
7219 .text : @{
7220 begin = DEFINED(begin) ? begin : . ;
7221 @dots{}
7222 @}
7223 @dots{}
7224@}
7225@end group
7226@end smallexample
7227
3ec57632
NC
7228@item LENGTH(@var{memory})
7229@kindex LENGTH(@var{memory})
7230Return the length of the memory region named @var{memory}.
7231
252b5132
RH
7232@item LOADADDR(@var{section})
7233@kindex LOADADDR(@var{section})
7234@cindex section load address in expression
7542af2a 7235Return the absolute LMA of the named @var{section}. (@pxref{Output
252b5132
RH
7236Section LMA}).
7237
2e53f7d6
NC
7238@item LOG2CEIL(@var{exp})
7239@kindex LOG2CEIL(@var{exp})
7240Return the binary logarithm of @var{exp} rounded towards infinity.
7241@code{LOG2CEIL(0)} returns 0.
7242
252b5132
RH
7243@kindex MAX
7244@item MAX(@var{exp1}, @var{exp2})
7245Returns the maximum of @var{exp1} and @var{exp2}.
7246
7247@kindex MIN
7248@item MIN(@var{exp1}, @var{exp2})
7249Returns the minimum of @var{exp1} and @var{exp2}.
7250
7251@item NEXT(@var{exp})
7252@kindex NEXT(@var{exp})
7253@cindex unallocated address, next
7254Return the next unallocated address that is a multiple of @var{exp}.
7255This function is closely related to @code{ALIGN(@var{exp})}; unless you
7256use the @code{MEMORY} command to define discontinuous memory for the
7257output file, the two functions are equivalent.
7258
3ec57632
NC
7259@item ORIGIN(@var{memory})
7260@kindex ORIGIN(@var{memory})
7261Return the origin of the memory region named @var{memory}.
7262
ba916c8a
MM
7263@item SEGMENT_START(@var{segment}, @var{default})
7264@kindex SEGMENT_START(@var{segment}, @var{default})
7265Return the base address of the named @var{segment}. If an explicit
c5da8c7d
NC
7266value has already been given for this segment (with a command-line
7267@samp{-T} option) then that value will be returned otherwise the value
7268will be @var{default}. At present, the @samp{-T} command-line option
7269can only be used to set the base address for the ``text'', ``data'', and
7542af2a 7270``bss'' sections, but you can use @code{SEGMENT_START} with any segment
ba916c8a
MM
7271name.
7272
252b5132
RH
7273@item SIZEOF(@var{section})
7274@kindex SIZEOF(@var{section})
7275@cindex section size
7276Return the size in bytes of the named @var{section}, if that section has
b5c37946
SJ
7277been allocated, or zero if the section has not been allocated. If the
7278section does not exist in the linker script the linker will report an
7279error. If @var{section} is @code{NEXT_SECTION} then @code{SIZEOF} will
7280return the alignment of the next allocated section specified in the
7281linker script, or zero if there is no such section. In the following
7282example, @code{symbol_1} and @code{symbol_2} are assigned identical
7283values:
252b5132
RH
7284@smallexample
7285@group
7286SECTIONS@{ @dots{}
7287 .output @{
7288 .start = . ;
7289 @dots{}
7290 .end = . ;
7291 @}
7292 symbol_1 = .end - .start ;
7293 symbol_2 = SIZEOF(.output);
7294@dots{} @}
7295@end group
7296@end smallexample
7297
7298@item SIZEOF_HEADERS
252b5132
RH
7299@kindex SIZEOF_HEADERS
7300@cindex header size
7301Return the size in bytes of the output file's headers. This is
7302information which appears at the start of the output file. You can use
7303this number when setting the start address of the first section, if you
7304choose, to facilitate paging.
7305
7306@cindex not enough room for program headers
7307@cindex program headers, not enough room
7308When producing an ELF output file, if the linker script uses the
7309@code{SIZEOF_HEADERS} builtin function, the linker must compute the
7310number of program headers before it has determined all the section
7311addresses and sizes. If the linker later discovers that it needs
7312additional program headers, it will report an error @samp{not enough
7313room for program headers}. To avoid this error, you must avoid using
7314the @code{SIZEOF_HEADERS} function, or you must rework your linker
7315script to avoid forcing the linker to use additional program headers, or
7316you must define the program headers yourself using the @code{PHDRS}
7317command (@pxref{PHDRS}).
7318@end table
7319
7320@node Implicit Linker Scripts
7321@section Implicit Linker Scripts
7322@cindex implicit linker scripts
7323If you specify a linker input file which the linker can not recognize as
7324an object file or an archive file, it will try to read the file as a
7325linker script. If the file can not be parsed as a linker script, the
7326linker will report an error.
7327
7328An implicit linker script will not replace the default linker script.
7329
7330Typically an implicit linker script would contain only symbol
7331assignments, or the @code{INPUT}, @code{GROUP}, or @code{VERSION}
7332commands.
7333
7334Any input files read because of an implicit linker script will be read
7335at the position in the command line where the implicit linker script was
7336read. This can affect archive searching.
7337
bf6d8037
HC
7338@node Plugins
7339@chapter Linker Plugins
7340
7341@cindex plugins
7342@cindex linker plugins
7343The linker can use dynamically loaded plugins to modify its behavior.
7344For example, the link-time optimization feature that some compilers
7345support is implemented with a linker plugin.
7346
7347Currently there is only one plugin shipped by default, but more may
7348be added here later.
7349
9b38b85e 7350Plugins are enabled via the use of the @option{-plugin @var{name}}
3a117c58 7351command line option. @xref{Options}.
9b38b85e 7352
bf6d8037
HC
7353@menu
7354* libdep Plugin:: Static Library Dependencies Plugin
7355@end menu
7356
7357@node libdep Plugin
7358@section Static Library Dependencies Plugin
7359@cindex static library dependencies
7360Originally, static libraries were contained in an archive file consisting
7361just of a collection of relocatable object files. Later they evolved to
7362optionally include a symbol table, to assist in finding the needed objects
7363within a library. There their evolution ended, and dynamic libraries
7364rose to ascendance.
7365
7366One useful feature of dynamic libraries was that, more than just collecting
7367multiple objects into a single file, they also included a list of their
7368dependencies, such that one could specify just the name of a single dynamic
7369library at link time, and all of its dependencies would be implicitly
7370referenced as well. But static libraries lacked this feature, so if a
7371link invocation was switched from using dynamic libraries to static
7372libraries, the link command would usually fail unless it was rewritten to
7373explicitly list the dependencies of the static library.
7374
7375The GNU @command{ar} utility now supports a @option{--record-libdeps} option
7376to embed dependency lists into static libraries as well, and the @file{libdep}
7377plugin may be used to read this dependency information at link time. The
7378dependency information is stored as a single string, carrying @option{-l}
7379and @option{-L} arguments as they would normally appear in a linker
7380command line. As such, the information can be written with any text
7381utility and stored into any archive, even if GNU @command{ar} is not
7382being used to create the archive. The information is stored in an
7383archive member named @samp{__.LIBDEP}.
7384
7385For example, given a library @file{libssl.a} that depends on another
7386library @file{libcrypto.a} which may be found in @file{/usr/local/lib},
7387the @samp{__.LIBDEP} member of @file{libssl.a} would contain
7388
7389@smallexample
7390-L/usr/local/lib -lcrypto
7391@end smallexample
7392
252b5132
RH
7393@ifset GENERIC
7394@node Machine Dependent
7395@chapter Machine Dependent Features
7396
7397@cindex machine dependencies
ff5dcc92
SC
7398@command{ld} has additional features on some platforms; the following
7399sections describe them. Machines where @command{ld} has no additional
252b5132
RH
7400functionality are not listed.
7401
7402@menu
36f63dca
NC
7403@ifset H8300
7404* H8/300:: @command{ld} and the H8/300
7405@end ifset
7ca01ed9
NC
7406@ifset M68HC11
7407* M68HC11/68HC12:: @code{ld} and the Motorola 68HC11 and 68HC12 families
7408@end ifset
36f63dca
NC
7409@ifset ARM
7410* ARM:: @command{ld} and the ARM family
7411@end ifset
7412@ifset HPPA
7413* HPPA ELF32:: @command{ld} and HPPA 32-bit ELF
7414@end ifset
7fb9f789
NC
7415@ifset M68K
7416* M68K:: @command{ld} and the Motorola 68K family
7417@end ifset
833794fc
MR
7418@ifset MIPS
7419* MIPS:: @command{ld} and the MIPS family
7420@end ifset
3c3bdf30 7421@ifset MMIX
36f63dca 7422* MMIX:: @command{ld} and MMIX
3c3bdf30 7423@end ifset
2469cfa2 7424@ifset MSP430
36f63dca 7425* MSP430:: @command{ld} and MSP430
2469cfa2 7426@end ifset
35c08157
KLC
7427@ifset NDS32
7428* NDS32:: @command{ld} and NDS32
7429@end ifset
78058a5e
SL
7430@ifset NIOSII
7431* Nios II:: @command{ld} and the Altera Nios II
7432@end ifset
2a60a7a8
AM
7433@ifset POWERPC
7434* PowerPC ELF32:: @command{ld} and PowerPC 32-bit ELF Support
7435@end ifset
7436@ifset POWERPC64
7437* PowerPC64 ELF64:: @command{ld} and PowerPC64 64-bit ELF Support
7438@end ifset
b4cbbe8f
AK
7439@ifset S/390
7440* S/390 ELF:: @command{ld} and S/390 ELF Support
7441@end ifset
49fa1e15
AM
7442@ifset SPU
7443* SPU ELF:: @command{ld} and SPU ELF Support
7444@end ifset
74459f0e 7445@ifset TICOFF
ff5dcc92 7446* TI COFF:: @command{ld} and TI COFF
74459f0e 7447@end ifset
2ca22b03
NC
7448@ifset WIN32
7449* WIN32:: @command{ld} and WIN32 (cygwin/mingw)
7450@end ifset
e0001a05
NC
7451@ifset XTENSA
7452* Xtensa:: @command{ld} and Xtensa Processors
7453@end ifset
252b5132
RH
7454@end menu
7455@end ifset
7456
252b5132
RH
7457@ifset H8300
7458@ifclear GENERIC
7459@raisesections
7460@end ifclear
7461
7462@node H8/300
ff5dcc92 7463@section @command{ld} and the H8/300
252b5132
RH
7464
7465@cindex H8/300 support
ff5dcc92 7466For the H8/300, @command{ld} can perform these global optimizations when
252b5132
RH
7467you specify the @samp{--relax} command-line option.
7468
7469@table @emph
7470@cindex relaxing on H8/300
7471@item relaxing address modes
ff5dcc92 7472@command{ld} finds all @code{jsr} and @code{jmp} instructions whose
252b5132
RH
7473targets are within eight bits, and turns them into eight-bit
7474program-counter relative @code{bsr} and @code{bra} instructions,
7475respectively.
7476
7477@cindex synthesizing on H8/300
7478@item synthesizing instructions
81f5558e 7479@c FIXME: specifically mov.b, or any mov instructions really? -> mov.b only, at least on H8, H8H, H8S
ff5dcc92 7480@command{ld} finds all @code{mov.b} instructions which use the
252b5132
RH
7481sixteen-bit absolute address form, but refer to the top
7482page of memory, and changes them to use the eight-bit address form.
7483(That is: the linker turns @samp{mov.b @code{@@}@var{aa}:16} into
7484@samp{mov.b @code{@@}@var{aa}:8} whenever the address @var{aa} is in the
7485top page of memory).
1502569c 7486
81f5558e
NC
7487@command{ld} finds all @code{mov} instructions which use the register
7488indirect with 32-bit displacement addressing mode, but use a small
7489displacement inside 16-bit displacement range, and changes them to use
7490the 16-bit displacement form. (That is: the linker turns @samp{mov.b
7491@code{@@}@var{d}:32,ERx} into @samp{mov.b @code{@@}@var{d}:16,ERx}
7492whenever the displacement @var{d} is in the 16 bit signed integer
7493range. Only implemented in ELF-format ld).
7494
1502569c 7495@item bit manipulation instructions
c0065db7 7496@command{ld} finds all bit manipulation instructions like @code{band, bclr,
1502569c 7497biand, bild, bior, bist, bixor, bld, bnot, bor, bset, bst, btst, bxor}
c0065db7 7498which use 32 bit and 16 bit absolute address form, but refer to the top
1502569c
NC
7499page of memory, and changes them to use the 8 bit address form.
7500(That is: the linker turns @samp{bset #xx:3,@code{@@}@var{aa}:32} into
c0065db7 7501@samp{bset #xx:3,@code{@@}@var{aa}:8} whenever the address @var{aa} is in
1502569c
NC
7502the top page of memory).
7503
7504@item system control instructions
c0065db7
RM
7505@command{ld} finds all @code{ldc.w, stc.w} instructions which use the
750632 bit absolute address form, but refer to the top page of memory, and
1502569c
NC
7507changes them to use 16 bit address form.
7508(That is: the linker turns @samp{ldc.w @code{@@}@var{aa}:32,ccr} into
c0065db7 7509@samp{ldc.w @code{@@}@var{aa}:16,ccr} whenever the address @var{aa} is in
1502569c 7510the top page of memory).
252b5132
RH
7511@end table
7512
7513@ifclear GENERIC
7514@lowersections
7515@end ifclear
7516@end ifset
7517
36f63dca 7518@ifclear GENERIC
c2dcd04e 7519@ifset Renesas
36f63dca 7520@c This stuff is pointless to say unless you're especially concerned
c2dcd04e
NC
7521@c with Renesas chips; don't enable it for generic case, please.
7522@node Renesas
7523@chapter @command{ld} and Other Renesas Chips
36f63dca 7524
c2dcd04e
NC
7525@command{ld} also supports the Renesas (formerly Hitachi) H8/300H,
7526H8/500, and SH chips. No special features, commands, or command-line
7527options are required for these chips.
36f63dca
NC
7528@end ifset
7529@end ifclear
7530
36f63dca
NC
7531@ifset ARM
7532@ifclear GENERIC
7533@raisesections
7534@end ifclear
7535
93fd0973
SC
7536@ifset M68HC11
7537@ifclear GENERIC
7538@raisesections
7539@end ifclear
7540
7541@node M68HC11/68HC12
7542@section @command{ld} and the Motorola 68HC11 and 68HC12 families
7543
7544@cindex M68HC11 and 68HC12 support
7545
7546@subsection Linker Relaxation
7547
7548For the Motorola 68HC11, @command{ld} can perform these global
7549optimizations when you specify the @samp{--relax} command-line option.
7550
7551@table @emph
7552@cindex relaxing on M68HC11
7553@item relaxing address modes
7554@command{ld} finds all @code{jsr} and @code{jmp} instructions whose
7555targets are within eight bits, and turns them into eight-bit
7556program-counter relative @code{bsr} and @code{bra} instructions,
7557respectively.
7558
7559@command{ld} also looks at all 16-bit extended addressing modes and
7560transforms them in a direct addressing mode when the address is in
7561page 0 (between 0 and 0x0ff).
7562
7563@item relaxing gcc instruction group
7564When @command{gcc} is called with @option{-mrelax}, it can emit group
7565of instructions that the linker can optimize to use a 68HC11 direct
7566addressing mode. These instructions consists of @code{bclr} or
7567@code{bset} instructions.
7568
7569@end table
7570
7571@subsection Trampoline Generation
7572
7573@cindex trampoline generation on M68HC11
7574@cindex trampoline generation on M68HC12
7575For 68HC11 and 68HC12, @command{ld} can generate trampoline code to
7576call a far function using a normal @code{jsr} instruction. The linker
c0065db7 7577will also change the relocation to some far function to use the
93fd0973
SC
7578trampoline address instead of the function address. This is typically the
7579case when a pointer to a function is taken. The pointer will in fact
7580point to the function trampoline.
7581
7582@ifclear GENERIC
7583@lowersections
7584@end ifclear
7585@end ifset
7586
36f63dca 7587@node ARM
3674e28a 7588@section @command{ld} and the ARM family
36f63dca
NC
7589
7590@cindex ARM interworking support
7591@kindex --support-old-code
7592For the ARM, @command{ld} will generate code stubs to allow functions calls
b45619c0 7593between ARM and Thumb code. These stubs only work with code that has
36f63dca
NC
7594been compiled and assembled with the @samp{-mthumb-interwork} command
7595line option. If it is necessary to link with old ARM object files or
7596libraries, which have not been compiled with the -mthumb-interwork
a05a5b64 7597option then the @samp{--support-old-code} command-line switch should be
36f63dca
NC
7598given to the linker. This will make it generate larger stub functions
7599which will work with non-interworking aware ARM code. Note, however,
7600the linker does not support generating stubs for function calls to
7601non-interworking aware Thumb code.
7602
7603@cindex thumb entry point
7604@cindex entry point, thumb
7605@kindex --thumb-entry=@var{entry}
7606The @samp{--thumb-entry} switch is a duplicate of the generic
7607@samp{--entry} switch, in that it sets the program's starting address.
7608But it also sets the bottom bit of the address, so that it can be
7609branched to using a BX instruction, and the program will start
7610executing in Thumb mode straight away.
7611
ce11ba6c
KT
7612@cindex PE import table prefixing
7613@kindex --use-nul-prefixed-import-tables
7614The @samp{--use-nul-prefixed-import-tables} switch is specifying, that
7615the import tables idata4 and idata5 have to be generated with a zero
11e7fd74 7616element prefix for import libraries. This is the old style to generate
ce11ba6c
KT
7617import tables. By default this option is turned off.
7618
e489d0ae
PB
7619@cindex BE8
7620@kindex --be8
7621The @samp{--be8} switch instructs @command{ld} to generate BE8 format
080bb7bb
NC
7622executables. This option is only valid when linking big-endian
7623objects - ie ones which have been assembled with the @option{-EB}
7624option. The resulting image will contain big-endian data and
7625little-endian code.
e489d0ae 7626
3674e28a
PB
7627@cindex TARGET1
7628@kindex --target1-rel
7629@kindex --target1-abs
7630The @samp{R_ARM_TARGET1} relocation is typically used for entries in the
7631@samp{.init_array} section. It is interpreted as either @samp{R_ARM_REL32}
7632or @samp{R_ARM_ABS32}, depending on the target. The @samp{--target1-rel}
7633and @samp{--target1-abs} switches override the default.
7634
7635@cindex TARGET2
7636@kindex --target2=@var{type}
7637The @samp{--target2=type} switch overrides the default definition of the
7638@samp{R_ARM_TARGET2} relocation. Valid values for @samp{type}, their
7639meanings, and target defaults are as follows:
7640@table @samp
7641@item rel
eeac373a
PB
7642@samp{R_ARM_REL32} (arm*-*-elf, arm*-*-eabi)
7643@item abs
a57d1773 7644@samp{R_ARM_ABS32}
3674e28a
PB
7645@item got-rel
7646@samp{R_ARM_GOT_PREL} (arm*-*-linux, arm*-*-*bsd)
7647@end table
7648
319850b4
JB
7649@cindex FIX_V4BX
7650@kindex --fix-v4bx
7651The @samp{R_ARM_V4BX} relocation (defined by the ARM AAELF
7652specification) enables objects compiled for the ARMv4 architecture to be
7653interworking-safe when linked with other objects compiled for ARMv4t, but
7654also allows pure ARMv4 binaries to be built from the same ARMv4 objects.
7655
7656In the latter case, the switch @option{--fix-v4bx} must be passed to the
7657linker, which causes v4t @code{BX rM} instructions to be rewritten as
7658@code{MOV PC,rM}, since v4 processors do not have a @code{BX} instruction.
7659
7660In the former case, the switch should not be used, and @samp{R_ARM_V4BX}
7661relocations are ignored.
7662
845b51d6
PB
7663@cindex FIX_V4BX_INTERWORKING
7664@kindex --fix-v4bx-interworking
7665Replace @code{BX rM} instructions identified by @samp{R_ARM_V4BX}
7666relocations with a branch to the following veneer:
7667
7668@smallexample
7669TST rM, #1
7670MOVEQ PC, rM
7671BX Rn
7672@end smallexample
7673
7674This allows generation of libraries/applications that work on ARMv4 cores
7675and are still interworking safe. Note that the above veneer clobbers the
11e7fd74 7676condition flags, so may cause incorrect program behavior in rare cases.
845b51d6 7677
33bfe774
JB
7678@cindex USE_BLX
7679@kindex --use-blx
7680The @samp{--use-blx} switch enables the linker to use ARM/Thumb
7681BLX instructions (available on ARMv5t and above) in various
7682situations. Currently it is used to perform calls via the PLT from Thumb
7683code using BLX rather than using BX and a mode-switching stub before
7684each PLT entry. This should lead to such calls executing slightly faster.
7685
c6dd86c6
JB
7686@cindex VFP11_DENORM_FIX
7687@kindex --vfp11-denorm-fix
7688The @samp{--vfp11-denorm-fix} switch enables a link-time workaround for a
7689bug in certain VFP11 coprocessor hardware, which sometimes allows
7690instructions with denorm operands (which must be handled by support code)
7691to have those operands overwritten by subsequent instructions before
7692the support code can read the intended values.
7693
7694The bug may be avoided in scalar mode if you allow at least one
7695intervening instruction between a VFP11 instruction which uses a register
7696and another instruction which writes to the same register, or at least two
7697intervening instructions if vector mode is in use. The bug only affects
7698full-compliance floating-point mode: you do not need this workaround if
7699you are using "runfast" mode. Please contact ARM for further details.
7700
7701If you know you are using buggy VFP11 hardware, you can
7702enable this workaround by specifying the linker option
7703@samp{--vfp-denorm-fix=scalar} if you are using the VFP11 scalar
7704mode only, or @samp{--vfp-denorm-fix=vector} if you are using
7705vector mode (the latter also works for scalar code). The default is
7706@samp{--vfp-denorm-fix=none}.
7707
7708If the workaround is enabled, instructions are scanned for
7709potentially-troublesome sequences, and a veneer is created for each
7710such sequence which may trigger the erratum. The veneer consists of the
7711first instruction of the sequence and a branch back to the subsequent
7712instruction. The original instruction is then replaced with a branch to
7713the veneer. The extra cycles required to call and return from the veneer
7714are sufficient to avoid the erratum in both the scalar and vector cases.
7715
2de70689
MGD
7716@cindex ARM1176 erratum workaround
7717@kindex --fix-arm1176
7718@kindex --no-fix-arm1176
9d5777a3
RM
7719The @samp{--fix-arm1176} switch enables a link-time workaround for an erratum
7720in certain ARM1176 processors. The workaround is enabled by default if you
7721are targeting ARM v6 (excluding ARM v6T2) or earlier. It can be disabled
2de70689
MGD
7722unconditionally by specifying @samp{--no-fix-arm1176}.
7723
9d5777a3 7724Further information is available in the ``ARM1176JZ-S and ARM1176JZF-S
11e7fd74 7725Programmer Advice Notice'' available on the ARM documentation website at:
2de70689
MGD
7726http://infocenter.arm.com/.
7727
a504d23a
LA
7728@cindex STM32L4xx erratum workaround
7729@kindex --fix-stm32l4xx-629360
7730
7731The @samp{--fix-stm32l4xx-629360} switch enables a link-time
7732workaround for a bug in the bus matrix / memory controller for some of
7733the STM32 Cortex-M4 based products (STM32L4xx). When accessing
7734off-chip memory via the affected bus for bus reads of 9 words or more,
7735the bus can generate corrupt data and/or abort. These are only
7736core-initiated accesses (not DMA), and might affect any access:
7737integer loads such as LDM, POP and floating-point loads such as VLDM,
7738VPOP. Stores are not affected.
7739
7740The bug can be avoided by splitting memory accesses into the
7741necessary chunks to keep bus reads below 8 words.
7742
7743The workaround is not enabled by default, this is equivalent to use
7744@samp{--fix-stm32l4xx-629360=none}. If you know you are using buggy
7745STM32L4xx hardware, you can enable the workaround by specifying the
7746linker option @samp{--fix-stm32l4xx-629360}, or the equivalent
7747@samp{--fix-stm32l4xx-629360=default}.
7748
7749If the workaround is enabled, instructions are scanned for
7750potentially-troublesome sequences, and a veneer is created for each
7751such sequence which may trigger the erratum. The veneer consists in a
7752replacement sequence emulating the behaviour of the original one and a
7753branch back to the subsequent instruction. The original instruction is
7754then replaced with a branch to the veneer.
7755
7756The workaround does not always preserve the memory access order for
7757the LDMDB instruction, when the instruction loads the PC.
7758
7759The workaround is not able to handle problematic instructions when
7760they are in the middle of an IT block, since a branch is not allowed
7761there. In that case, the linker reports a warning and no replacement
7762occurs.
7763
7764The workaround is not able to replace problematic instructions with a
7765PC-relative branch instruction if the @samp{.text} section is too
7766large. In that case, when the branch that replaces the original code
7767cannot be encoded, the linker reports a warning and no replacement
7768occurs.
7769
bf21ed78
MS
7770@cindex NO_ENUM_SIZE_WARNING
7771@kindex --no-enum-size-warning
726150b7 7772The @option{--no-enum-size-warning} switch prevents the linker from
bf21ed78
MS
7773warning when linking object files that specify incompatible EABI
7774enumeration size attributes. For example, with this switch enabled,
7775linking of an object file using 32-bit enumeration values with another
7776using enumeration values fitted into the smallest possible space will
7777not be diagnosed.
a9dc9481
JM
7778
7779@cindex NO_WCHAR_SIZE_WARNING
7780@kindex --no-wchar-size-warning
7781The @option{--no-wchar-size-warning} switch prevents the linker from
7782warning when linking object files that specify incompatible EABI
7783@code{wchar_t} size attributes. For example, with this switch enabled,
7784linking of an object file using 32-bit @code{wchar_t} values with another
7785using 16-bit @code{wchar_t} values will not be diagnosed.
bf21ed78 7786
726150b7
NC
7787@cindex PIC_VENEER
7788@kindex --pic-veneer
7789The @samp{--pic-veneer} switch makes the linker use PIC sequences for
7790ARM/Thumb interworking veneers, even if the rest of the binary
7791is not PIC. This avoids problems on uClinux targets where
7792@samp{--emit-relocs} is used to generate relocatable binaries.
7793
7794@cindex STUB_GROUP_SIZE
7795@kindex --stub-group-size=@var{N}
7796The linker will automatically generate and insert small sequences of
7797code into a linked ARM ELF executable whenever an attempt is made to
7798perform a function call to a symbol that is too far away. The
7799placement of these sequences of instructions - called stubs - is
a05a5b64 7800controlled by the command-line option @option{--stub-group-size=N}.
726150b7 7801The placement is important because a poor choice can create a need for
11e7fd74 7802duplicate stubs, increasing the code size. The linker will try to
726150b7
NC
7803group stubs together in order to reduce interruptions to the flow of
7804code, but it needs guidance as to how big these groups should be and
7805where they should be placed.
7806
7807The value of @samp{N}, the parameter to the
7808@option{--stub-group-size=} option controls where the stub groups are
07d72278 7809placed. If it is negative then all stubs are placed after the first
726150b7
NC
7810branch that needs them. If it is positive then the stubs can be
7811placed either before or after the branches that need them. If the
7812value of @samp{N} is 1 (either +1 or -1) then the linker will choose
7813exactly where to place groups of stubs, using its built in heuristics.
7814A value of @samp{N} greater than 1 (or smaller than -1) tells the
7815linker that a single group of stubs can service at most @samp{N} bytes
7816from the input sections.
7817
7818The default, if @option{--stub-group-size=} is not specified, is
7819@samp{N = +1}.
7820
1a51c1a4
NC
7821Farcalls stubs insertion is fully supported for the ARM-EABI target
7822only, because it relies on object files properties not present
7823otherwise.
7824
1db37fe6
YG
7825@cindex Cortex-A8 erratum workaround
7826@kindex --fix-cortex-a8
7827@kindex --no-fix-cortex-a8
7828The @samp{--fix-cortex-a8} switch enables a link-time workaround for an erratum in certain Cortex-A8 processors. The workaround is enabled by default if you are targeting the ARM v7-A architecture profile. It can be enabled otherwise by specifying @samp{--fix-cortex-a8}, or disabled unconditionally by specifying @samp{--no-fix-cortex-a8}.
7829
7830The erratum only affects Thumb-2 code. Please contact ARM for further details.
7831
68fcca92
JW
7832@cindex Cortex-A53 erratum 835769 workaround
7833@kindex --fix-cortex-a53-835769
7834@kindex --no-fix-cortex-a53-835769
7835The @samp{--fix-cortex-a53-835769} switch enables a link-time workaround for erratum 835769 present on certain early revisions of Cortex-A53 processors. The workaround is disabled by default. It can be enabled by specifying @samp{--fix-cortex-a53-835769}, or disabled unconditionally by specifying @samp{--no-fix-cortex-a53-835769}.
7836
7837Please contact ARM for further details.
7838
1db37fe6
YG
7839@kindex --merge-exidx-entries
7840@kindex --no-merge-exidx-entries
7841@cindex Merging exidx entries
7842The @samp{--no-merge-exidx-entries} switch disables the merging of adjacent exidx entries in debuginfo.
7843
7844@kindex --long-plt
7845@cindex 32-bit PLT entries
7846The @samp{--long-plt} option enables the use of 16 byte PLT entries
7847which support up to 4Gb of code. The default is to use 12 byte PLT
7848entries which only support 512Mb of code.
7849
1f56df9d
JW
7850@kindex --no-apply-dynamic-relocs
7851@cindex AArch64 rela addend
7852The @samp{--no-apply-dynamic-relocs} option makes AArch64 linker do not apply
7853link-time values for dynamic relocations.
7854
4ba2ef8f
TP
7855@cindex Placement of SG veneers
7856All SG veneers are placed in the special output section @code{.gnu.sgstubs}.
a05a5b64 7857Its start address must be set, either with the command-line option
4ba2ef8f
TP
7858@samp{--section-start} or in a linker script, to indicate where to place these
7859veneers in memory.
7860
54ddd295
TP
7861@kindex --cmse-implib
7862@cindex Secure gateway import library
7863The @samp{--cmse-implib} option requests that the import libraries
7864specified by the @samp{--out-implib} and @samp{--in-implib} options are
7865secure gateway import libraries, suitable for linking a non-secure
7866executable against secure code as per ARMv8-M Security Extensions.
7867
0955507f
TP
7868@kindex --in-implib=@var{file}
7869@cindex Input import library
7870The @samp{--in-implib=file} specifies an input import library whose symbols
7871must keep the same address in the executable being produced. A warning is
7872given if no @samp{--out-implib} is given but new symbols have been introduced
7873in the executable that should be listed in its import library. Otherwise, if
7874@samp{--out-implib} is specified, the symbols are added to the output import
7875library. A warning is also given if some symbols present in the input import
7876library have disappeared from the executable. This option is only effective
7877for Secure Gateway import libraries, ie. when @samp{--cmse-implib} is
7878specified.
7879
36f63dca
NC
7880@ifclear GENERIC
7881@lowersections
7882@end ifclear
7883@end ifset
7884
7885@ifset HPPA
7886@ifclear GENERIC
7887@raisesections
7888@end ifclear
7889
7890@node HPPA ELF32
7891@section @command{ld} and HPPA 32-bit ELF Support
7892@cindex HPPA multiple sub-space stubs
7893@kindex --multi-subspace
7894When generating a shared library, @command{ld} will by default generate
7895import stubs suitable for use with a single sub-space application.
7896The @samp{--multi-subspace} switch causes @command{ld} to generate export
7897stubs, and different (larger) import stubs suitable for use with
7898multiple sub-spaces.
7899
7900@cindex HPPA stub grouping
7901@kindex --stub-group-size=@var{N}
7902Long branch stubs and import/export stubs are placed by @command{ld} in
7903stub sections located between groups of input sections.
7904@samp{--stub-group-size} specifies the maximum size of a group of input
7905sections handled by one stub section. Since branch offsets are signed,
7906a stub section may serve two groups of input sections, one group before
7907the stub section, and one group after it. However, when using
7908conditional branches that require stubs, it may be better (for branch
7909prediction) that stub sections only serve one group of input sections.
7910A negative value for @samp{N} chooses this scheme, ensuring that
7911branches to stubs always use a negative offset. Two special values of
7912@samp{N} are recognized, @samp{1} and @samp{-1}. These both instruct
7913@command{ld} to automatically size input section groups for the branch types
7914detected, with the same behaviour regarding stub placement as other
7915positive or negative values of @samp{N} respectively.
7916
7917Note that @samp{--stub-group-size} does not split input sections. A
7918single input section larger than the group size specified will of course
7919create a larger group (of one section). If input sections are too
7920large, it may not be possible for a branch to reach its stub.
7921
7922@ifclear GENERIC
7923@lowersections
7924@end ifclear
7925@end ifset
7926
7fb9f789
NC
7927@ifset M68K
7928@ifclear GENERIC
7929@raisesections
7930@end ifclear
7931
7932@node M68K
7933@section @command{ld} and the Motorola 68K family
7934
7935@cindex Motorola 68K GOT generation
7936@kindex --got=@var{type}
7937The @samp{--got=@var{type}} option lets you choose the GOT generation scheme.
7938The choices are @samp{single}, @samp{negative}, @samp{multigot} and
7939@samp{target}. When @samp{target} is selected the linker chooses
7940the default GOT generation scheme for the current target.
7941@samp{single} tells the linker to generate a single GOT with
7942entries only at non-negative offsets.
7943@samp{negative} instructs the linker to generate a single GOT with
7944entries at both negative and positive offsets. Not all environments
7945support such GOTs.
7946@samp{multigot} allows the linker to generate several GOTs in the
7947output file. All GOT references from a single input object
7948file access the same GOT, but references from different input object
7949files might access different GOTs. Not all environments support such GOTs.
7950
7951@ifclear GENERIC
7952@lowersections
7953@end ifclear
7954@end ifset
7955
833794fc
MR
7956@ifset MIPS
7957@ifclear GENERIC
7958@raisesections
7959@end ifclear
7960
7961@node MIPS
7962@section @command{ld} and the MIPS family
7963
7964@cindex MIPS microMIPS instruction choice selection
7965@kindex --insn32
7966@kindex --no-insn32
7967The @samp{--insn32} and @samp{--no-insn32} options control the choice of
7968microMIPS instructions used in code generated by the linker, such as that
7969in the PLT or lazy binding stubs, or in relaxation. If @samp{--insn32} is
7970used, then the linker only uses 32-bit instruction encodings. By default
7971or if @samp{--no-insn32} is used, all instruction encodings are used,
7972including 16-bit ones where possible.
7973
8b10b0b3
MR
7974@cindex MIPS branch relocation check control
7975@kindex --ignore-branch-isa
7976@kindex --no-ignore-branch-isa
7977The @samp{--ignore-branch-isa} and @samp{--no-ignore-branch-isa} options
7978control branch relocation checks for invalid ISA mode transitions. If
7979@samp{--ignore-branch-isa} is used, then the linker accepts any branch
7980relocations and any ISA mode transition required is lost in relocation
7981calculation, except for some cases of @code{BAL} instructions which meet
7982relaxation conditions and are converted to equivalent @code{JALX}
7983instructions as the associated relocation is calculated. By default
7984or if @samp{--no-ignore-branch-isa} is used a check is made causing
7985the loss of an ISA mode transition to produce an error.
7986
833794fc
MR
7987@ifclear GENERIC
7988@lowersections
7989@end ifclear
7990@end ifset
7991
36f63dca
NC
7992@ifset MMIX
7993@ifclear GENERIC
7994@raisesections
7995@end ifclear
7996
7997@node MMIX
7998@section @code{ld} and MMIX
7999For MMIX, there is a choice of generating @code{ELF} object files or
8000@code{mmo} object files when linking. The simulator @code{mmix}
8001understands the @code{mmo} format. The binutils @code{objcopy} utility
8002can translate between the two formats.
8003
8004There is one special section, the @samp{.MMIX.reg_contents} section.
8005Contents in this section is assumed to correspond to that of global
8006registers, and symbols referring to it are translated to special symbols,
8007equal to registers. In a final link, the start address of the
8008@samp{.MMIX.reg_contents} section corresponds to the first allocated
8009global register multiplied by 8. Register @code{$255} is not included in
8010this section; it is always set to the program entry, which is at the
8011symbol @code{Main} for @code{mmo} files.
8012
7a2de473
HPN
8013Global symbols with the prefix @code{__.MMIX.start.}, for example
8014@code{__.MMIX.start..text} and @code{__.MMIX.start..data} are special.
8015The default linker script uses these to set the default start address
8016of a section.
36f63dca
NC
8017
8018Initial and trailing multiples of zero-valued 32-bit words in a section,
8019are left out from an mmo file.
8020
8021@ifclear GENERIC
8022@lowersections
8023@end ifclear
8024@end ifset
8025
8026@ifset MSP430
8027@ifclear GENERIC
8028@raisesections
8029@end ifclear
8030
8031@node MSP430
8032@section @code{ld} and MSP430
8033For the MSP430 it is possible to select the MPU architecture. The flag @samp{-m [mpu type]}
8034will select an appropriate linker script for selected MPU type. (To get a list of known MPUs
8035just pass @samp{-m help} option to the linker).
8036
8037@cindex MSP430 extra sections
8038The linker will recognize some extra sections which are MSP430 specific:
8039
8040@table @code
8041@item @samp{.vectors}
8042Defines a portion of ROM where interrupt vectors located.
8043
8044@item @samp{.bootloader}
8045Defines the bootloader portion of the ROM (if applicable). Any code
8046in this section will be uploaded to the MPU.
8047
8048@item @samp{.infomem}
8049Defines an information memory section (if applicable). Any code in
8050this section will be uploaded to the MPU.
8051
c0065db7 8052@item @samp{.infomemnobits}
36f63dca
NC
8053This is the same as the @samp{.infomem} section except that any code
8054in this section will not be uploaded to the MPU.
8055
8056@item @samp{.noinit}
8057Denotes a portion of RAM located above @samp{.bss} section.
8058
c0065db7 8059The last two sections are used by gcc.
36f63dca
NC
8060@end table
8061
7ef3addb
JL
8062@table @option
8063@cindex MSP430 Options
8064@kindex --code-region
8065@item --code-region=[either,lower,upper,none]
8066This will transform .text* sections to [either,lower,upper].text* sections. The
8067argument passed to GCC for -mcode-region is propagated to the linker
8068using this option.
8069
8070@kindex --data-region
8071@item --data-region=[either,lower,upper,none]
8072This will transform .data*, .bss* and .rodata* sections to
8073[either,lower,upper].[data,bss,rodata]* sections. The argument passed to GCC
8074for -mdata-region is propagated to the linker using this option.
8075
8076@kindex --disable-sec-transformation
8077@item --disable-sec-transformation
8078Prevent the transformation of sections as specified by the @code{--code-region}
8079and @code{--data-region} options.
8080This is useful if you are compiling and linking using a single call to the GCC
8081wrapper, and want to compile the source files using -m[code,data]-region but
8082not transform the sections for prebuilt libraries and objects.
8083@end table
8084
36f63dca
NC
8085@ifclear GENERIC
8086@lowersections
8087@end ifclear
8088@end ifset
8089
35c08157
KLC
8090@ifset NDS32
8091@ifclear GENERIC
8092@raisesections
8093@end ifclear
8094
8095@node NDS32
8096@section @code{ld} and NDS32
8097@kindex relaxing on NDS32
8098For NDS32, there are some options to select relaxation behavior. The linker
8099relaxes objects according to these options.
8100
8101@table @code
8102@item @samp{--m[no-]fp-as-gp}
8103Disable/enable fp-as-gp relaxation.
8104
8105@item @samp{--mexport-symbols=FILE}
8106Exporting symbols and their address into FILE as linker script.
8107
8108@item @samp{--m[no-]ex9}
8109Disable/enable link-time EX9 relaxation.
8110
8111@item @samp{--mexport-ex9=FILE}
8112Export the EX9 table after linking.
8113
8114@item @samp{--mimport-ex9=FILE}
8115Import the Ex9 table for EX9 relaxation.
8116
8117@item @samp{--mupdate-ex9}
8118Update the existing EX9 table.
8119
8120@item @samp{--mex9-limit=NUM}
8121Maximum number of entries in the ex9 table.
8122
8123@item @samp{--mex9-loop-aware}
8124Avoid generating the EX9 instruction inside the loop.
8125
8126@item @samp{--m[no-]ifc}
8127Disable/enable the link-time IFC optimization.
8128
8129@item @samp{--mifc-loop-aware}
8130Avoid generating the IFC instruction inside the loop.
8131@end table
8132
8133@ifclear GENERIC
8134@lowersections
8135@end ifclear
8136@end ifset
8137
78058a5e
SL
8138@ifset NIOSII
8139@ifclear GENERIC
8140@raisesections
8141@end ifclear
8142
8143@node Nios II
8144@section @command{ld} and the Altera Nios II
8145@cindex Nios II call relaxation
8146@kindex --relax on Nios II
8147
8148Call and immediate jump instructions on Nios II processors are limited to
8149transferring control to addresses in the same 256MB memory segment,
8150which may result in @command{ld} giving
8151@samp{relocation truncated to fit} errors with very large programs.
8152The command-line option @option{--relax} enables the generation of
8153trampolines that can access the entire 32-bit address space for calls
8154outside the normal @code{call} and @code{jmpi} address range. These
8155trampolines are inserted at section boundaries, so may not themselves
8156be reachable if an input section and its associated call trampolines are
8157larger than 256MB.
8158
8159The @option{--relax} option is enabled by default unless @option{-r}
8160is also specified. You can disable trampoline generation by using the
8161@option{--no-relax} linker option. You can also disable this optimization
8162locally by using the @samp{set .noat} directive in assembly-language
8163source files, as the linker-inserted trampolines use the @code{at}
8164register as a temporary.
8165
8166Note that the linker @option{--relax} option is independent of assembler
8167relaxation options, and that using the GNU assembler's @option{-relax-all}
8168option interferes with the linker's more selective call instruction relaxation.
8169
8170@ifclear GENERIC
8171@lowersections
8172@end ifclear
8173@end ifset
8174
2a60a7a8
AM
8175@ifset POWERPC
8176@ifclear GENERIC
8177@raisesections
8178@end ifclear
8179
8180@node PowerPC ELF32
8181@section @command{ld} and PowerPC 32-bit ELF Support
8182@cindex PowerPC long branches
8183@kindex --relax on PowerPC
8184Branches on PowerPC processors are limited to a signed 26-bit
8185displacement, which may result in @command{ld} giving
8186@samp{relocation truncated to fit} errors with very large programs.
8187@samp{--relax} enables the generation of trampolines that can access
8188the entire 32-bit address space. These trampolines are inserted at
8189section boundaries, so may not themselves be reachable if an input
c8a1f254
NS
8190section exceeds 33M in size. You may combine @samp{-r} and
8191@samp{--relax} to add trampolines in a partial link. In that case
8192both branches to undefined symbols and inter-section branches are also
8193considered potentially out of range, and trampolines inserted.
2a60a7a8
AM
8194
8195@cindex PowerPC ELF32 options
8196@table @option
8197@cindex PowerPC PLT
8198@kindex --bss-plt
8199@item --bss-plt
8200Current PowerPC GCC accepts a @samp{-msecure-plt} option that
8201generates code capable of using a newer PLT and GOT layout that has
8202the security advantage of no executable section ever needing to be
8203writable and no writable section ever being executable. PowerPC
8204@command{ld} will generate this layout, including stubs to access the
8205PLT, if all input files (including startup and static libraries) were
8206compiled with @samp{-msecure-plt}. @samp{--bss-plt} forces the old
8207BSS PLT (and GOT layout) which can give slightly better performance.
8208
016687f8
AM
8209@kindex --secure-plt
8210@item --secure-plt
8211@command{ld} will use the new PLT and GOT layout if it is linking new
8212@samp{-fpic} or @samp{-fPIC} code, but does not do so automatically
8213when linking non-PIC code. This option requests the new PLT and GOT
8214layout. A warning will be given if some object file requires the old
8215style BSS PLT.
8216
2a60a7a8
AM
8217@cindex PowerPC GOT
8218@kindex --sdata-got
8219@item --sdata-got
8220The new secure PLT and GOT are placed differently relative to other
8221sections compared to older BSS PLT and GOT placement. The location of
8222@code{.plt} must change because the new secure PLT is an initialized
8223section while the old PLT is uninitialized. The reason for the
8224@code{.got} change is more subtle: The new placement allows
8225@code{.got} to be read-only in applications linked with
8226@samp{-z relro -z now}. However, this placement means that
8227@code{.sdata} cannot always be used in shared libraries, because the
8228PowerPC ABI accesses @code{.sdata} in shared libraries from the GOT
8229pointer. @samp{--sdata-got} forces the old GOT placement. PowerPC
8230GCC doesn't use @code{.sdata} in shared libraries, so this option is
8231really only useful for other compilers that may do so.
8232
8233@cindex PowerPC stub symbols
8234@kindex --emit-stub-syms
8235@item --emit-stub-syms
8236This option causes @command{ld} to label linker stubs with a local
8237symbol that encodes the stub type and destination.
8238
8239@cindex PowerPC TLS optimization
8240@kindex --no-tls-optimize
8241@item --no-tls-optimize
8242PowerPC @command{ld} normally performs some optimization of code
8243sequences used to access Thread-Local Storage. Use this option to
8244disable the optimization.
8245@end table
8246
8247@ifclear GENERIC
8248@lowersections
8249@end ifclear
8250@end ifset
8251
8252@ifset POWERPC64
8253@ifclear GENERIC
8254@raisesections
8255@end ifclear
8256
8257@node PowerPC64 ELF64
8258@section @command{ld} and PowerPC64 64-bit ELF Support
8259
8260@cindex PowerPC64 ELF64 options
8261@table @option
8262@cindex PowerPC64 stub grouping
8263@kindex --stub-group-size
8264@item --stub-group-size
8265Long branch stubs, PLT call stubs and TOC adjusting stubs are placed
8266by @command{ld} in stub sections located between groups of input sections.
8267@samp{--stub-group-size} specifies the maximum size of a group of input
8268sections handled by one stub section. Since branch offsets are signed,
8269a stub section may serve two groups of input sections, one group before
8270the stub section, and one group after it. However, when using
8271conditional branches that require stubs, it may be better (for branch
8272prediction) that stub sections only serve one group of input sections.
8273A negative value for @samp{N} chooses this scheme, ensuring that
8274branches to stubs always use a negative offset. Two special values of
8275@samp{N} are recognized, @samp{1} and @samp{-1}. These both instruct
8276@command{ld} to automatically size input section groups for the branch types
8277detected, with the same behaviour regarding stub placement as other
8278positive or negative values of @samp{N} respectively.
8279
8280Note that @samp{--stub-group-size} does not split input sections. A
8281single input section larger than the group size specified will of course
8282create a larger group (of one section). If input sections are too
8283large, it may not be possible for a branch to reach its stub.
8284
8285@cindex PowerPC64 stub symbols
8286@kindex --emit-stub-syms
8287@item --emit-stub-syms
8288This option causes @command{ld} to label linker stubs with a local
8289symbol that encodes the stub type and destination.
8290
8291@cindex PowerPC64 dot symbols
8292@kindex --dotsyms
8293@kindex --no-dotsyms
95421fb9
AM
8294@item --dotsyms
8295@itemx --no-dotsyms
2a60a7a8
AM
8296These two options control how @command{ld} interprets version patterns
8297in a version script. Older PowerPC64 compilers emitted both a
8298function descriptor symbol with the same name as the function, and a
8299code entry symbol with the name prefixed by a dot (@samp{.}). To
8300properly version a function @samp{foo}, the version script thus needs
8301to control both @samp{foo} and @samp{.foo}. The option
8302@samp{--dotsyms}, on by default, automatically adds the required
8303dot-prefixed patterns. Use @samp{--no-dotsyms} to disable this
8304feature.
8305
7ae4ea7d
AM
8306@cindex PowerPC64 register save/restore functions
8307@kindex --save-restore-funcs
8308@kindex --no-save-restore-funcs
95421fb9
AM
8309@item --save-restore-funcs
8310@itemx --no-save-restore-funcs
7ae4ea7d
AM
8311These two options control whether PowerPC64 @command{ld} automatically
8312provides out-of-line register save and restore functions used by
8313@samp{-Os} code. The default is to provide any such referenced
8314function for a normal final link, and to not do so for a relocatable
8315link.
8316
2a60a7a8
AM
8317@cindex PowerPC64 TLS optimization
8318@kindex --no-tls-optimize
8319@item --no-tls-optimize
8320PowerPC64 @command{ld} normally performs some optimization of code
8321sequences used to access Thread-Local Storage. Use this option to
8322disable the optimization.
8323
7c9cf415
AM
8324@cindex PowerPC64 __tls_get_addr optimization
8325@kindex --tls-get-addr-optimize
8326@kindex --no-tls-get-addr-optimize
9e7028aa
AM
8327@kindex --tls-get-addr-regsave
8328@kindex --no-tls-get-addr-regsave
95421fb9
AM
8329@item --tls-get-addr-optimize
8330@itemx --no-tls-get-addr-optimize
9e7028aa 8331These options control how PowerPC64 @command{ld} uses a special
7c9cf415
AM
8332stub to call __tls_get_addr. PowerPC64 glibc 2.22 and later support
8333an optimization that allows the second and subsequent calls to
8334@code{__tls_get_addr} for a given symbol to be resolved by the special
9e7028aa
AM
8335stub without calling in to glibc. By default the linker enables
8336generation of the stub when glibc advertises the availability of
8337__tls_get_addr_opt.
8338Using @option{--tls-get-addr-optimize} with an older glibc won't do
8339much besides slow down your applications, but may be useful if linking
8340an application against an older glibc with the expectation that it
8341will normally be used on systems having a newer glibc.
8342@option{--tls-get-addr-regsave} forces generation of a stub that saves
8343and restores volatile registers around the call into glibc. Normally,
8344this is done when the linker detects a call to __tls_get_addr_desc.
8345Such calls then go via the register saving stub to __tls_get_addr_opt.
5cebc931 8346@option{--no-tls-get-addr-regsave} disables generation of the
9e7028aa 8347register saves.
7c9cf415 8348
2a60a7a8
AM
8349@cindex PowerPC64 OPD optimization
8350@kindex --no-opd-optimize
8351@item --no-opd-optimize
8352PowerPC64 @command{ld} normally removes @code{.opd} section entries
8353corresponding to deleted link-once functions, or functions removed by
e7fc76dd 8354the action of @samp{--gc-sections} or linker script @code{/DISCARD/}.
2a60a7a8
AM
8355Use this option to disable @code{.opd} optimization.
8356
8357@cindex PowerPC64 OPD spacing
8358@kindex --non-overlapping-opd
8359@item --non-overlapping-opd
8360Some PowerPC64 compilers have an option to generate compressed
8361@code{.opd} entries spaced 16 bytes apart, overlapping the third word,
8362the static chain pointer (unused in C) with the first word of the next
8363entry. This option expands such entries to the full 24 bytes.
8364
8365@cindex PowerPC64 TOC optimization
8366@kindex --no-toc-optimize
8367@item --no-toc-optimize
8368PowerPC64 @command{ld} normally removes unused @code{.toc} section
8369entries. Such entries are detected by examining relocations that
8370reference the TOC in code sections. A reloc in a deleted code section
8371marks a TOC word as unneeded, while a reloc in a kept code section
8372marks a TOC word as needed. Since the TOC may reference itself, TOC
8373relocs are also examined. TOC words marked as both needed and
8374unneeded will of course be kept. TOC words without any referencing
8375reloc are assumed to be part of a multi-word entry, and are kept or
8376discarded as per the nearest marked preceding word. This works
8377reliably for compiler generated code, but may be incorrect if assembly
8378code is used to insert TOC entries. Use this option to disable the
8379optimization.
8380
d882c988
AM
8381@cindex PowerPC64 inline PLT call optimization
8382@kindex --no-inline-optimize
8383@item --no-inline-optimize
8384PowerPC64 @command{ld} normally replaces inline PLT call sequences
8385marked with @code{R_PPC64_PLTSEQ}, @code{R_PPC64_PLTCALL},
8386@code{R_PPC64_PLT16_HA} and @code{R_PPC64_PLT16_LO_DS} relocations by
8387a number of @code{nop}s and a direct call when the function is defined
8388locally and can't be overridden by some other definition. This option
8389disables that optimization.
8390
2a60a7a8
AM
8391@cindex PowerPC64 multi-TOC
8392@kindex --no-multi-toc
8393@item --no-multi-toc
794e51c0
AM
8394If given any toc option besides @code{-mcmodel=medium} or
8395@code{-mcmodel=large}, PowerPC64 GCC generates code for a TOC model
8396where TOC
2a60a7a8
AM
8397entries are accessed with a 16-bit offset from r2. This limits the
8398total TOC size to 64K. PowerPC64 @command{ld} extends this limit by
8399grouping code sections such that each group uses less than 64K for its
8400TOC entries, then inserts r2 adjusting stubs between inter-group
8401calls. @command{ld} does not split apart input sections, so cannot
8402help if a single input file has a @code{.toc} section that exceeds
840364K, most likely from linking multiple files with @command{ld -r}.
8404Use this option to turn off this feature.
794e51c0
AM
8405
8406@cindex PowerPC64 TOC sorting
8407@kindex --no-toc-sort
8408@item --no-toc-sort
8409By default, @command{ld} sorts TOC sections so that those whose file
8410happens to have a section called @code{.init} or @code{.fini} are
8411placed first, followed by TOC sections referenced by code generated
8412with PowerPC64 gcc's @code{-mcmodel=small}, and lastly TOC sections
8413referenced only by code generated with PowerPC64 gcc's
8414@code{-mcmodel=medium} or @code{-mcmodel=large} options. Doing this
8415results in better TOC grouping for multi-TOC. Use this option to turn
8416off this feature.
8417
8418@cindex PowerPC64 PLT stub alignment
8419@kindex --plt-align
8420@kindex --no-plt-align
8421@item --plt-align
8422@itemx --no-plt-align
8423Use these options to control whether individual PLT call stubs are
2420fff6
AM
8424aligned to a 32-byte boundary, or to the specified power of two
8425boundary when using @code{--plt-align=}. A negative value may be
8426specified to pad PLT call stubs so that they do not cross the
8427specified power of two boundary (or the minimum number of boundaries
8428if a PLT stub is so large that it must cross a boundary). By default
8429PLT call stubs are aligned to 32-byte boundaries.
794e51c0
AM
8430
8431@cindex PowerPC64 PLT call stub static chain
8432@kindex --plt-static-chain
8433@kindex --no-plt-static-chain
8434@item --plt-static-chain
8435@itemx --no-plt-static-chain
8436Use these options to control whether PLT call stubs load the static
8437chain pointer (r11). @code{ld} defaults to not loading the static
8438chain since there is never any need to do so on a PLT call.
8439
8440@cindex PowerPC64 PLT call stub thread safety
8441@kindex --plt-thread-safe
8442@kindex --no-plt-thread-safe
8443@item --plt-thread-safe
1be5d8d3 8444@itemx --no-plt-thread-safe
794e51c0
AM
8445With power7's weakly ordered memory model, it is possible when using
8446lazy binding for ld.so to update a plt entry in one thread and have
8447another thread see the individual plt entry words update in the wrong
8448order, despite ld.so carefully writing in the correct order and using
8449memory write barriers. To avoid this we need some sort of read
8450barrier in the call stub, or use LD_BIND_NOW=1. By default, @code{ld}
8451looks for calls to commonly used functions that create threads, and if
8452seen, adds the necessary barriers. Use these options to change the
8453default behaviour.
8b5f1ed8
AM
8454
8455@cindex PowerPC64 ELFv2 PLT localentry optimization
8456@kindex --plt-localentry
8457@kindex --no-plt-localentry
8458@item --plt-localentry
8459@itemx --no-localentry
8460ELFv2 functions with localentry:0 are those with a single entry point,
8461ie. global entry == local entry, and that have no requirement on r2
8462(the TOC/GOT pointer) or r12, and guarantee r2 is unchanged on return.
8463Such an external function can be called via the PLT without saving r2
8464or restoring it on return, avoiding a common load-hit-store for small
8465functions. The optimization is attractive, with up to 40% reduction
8466in execution time for a small function, but can result in symbol
d44c746a
AM
8467interposition failures. Also, minor changes in a shared library,
8468including system libraries, can cause a function that was localentry:0
8469to become localentry:8. This will result in a dynamic loader
8470complaint and failure to run. The option is experimental, use with
8471care. @option{--no-plt-localentry} is the default.
d882c988
AM
8472
8473@cindex PowerPC64 Power10 stubs
8474@kindex --power10-stubs
8475@kindex --no-power10-stubs
8476@item --power10-stubs
8477@itemx --no-power10-stubs
8478When PowerPC64 @command{ld} links input object files containing
8479relocations used on power10 prefixed instructions it normally creates
e10a07b3
AM
8480linkage stubs (PLT call and long branch) using power10 instructions
8481for @code{@@notoc} PLT calls where @code{r2} is not known. The
8482power10 notoc stubs are smaller and faster, so are preferred for
d882c988
AM
8483power10. @option{--power10-stubs} and @option{--no-power10-stubs}
8484allow you to override the linker's selection of stub instructions.
e10a07b3
AM
8485@option{--power10-stubs=auto} allows the user to select the default
8486auto mode.
2a60a7a8
AM
8487@end table
8488
8489@ifclear GENERIC
8490@lowersections
8491@end ifclear
8492@end ifset
8493
b4cbbe8f
AK
8494@ifset S/390
8495@ifclear GENERIC
8496@raisesections
8497@end ifclear
8498
8499@node S/390 ELF
8500@section @command{ld} and S/390 ELF Support
8501
8502@cindex S/390 ELF options
8503@table @option
8504
8505@cindex S/390
8506@kindex --s390-pgste
8507@item --s390-pgste
8508This option marks the result file with a @code{PT_S390_PGSTE}
8509segment. The Linux kernel is supposed to allocate 4k page tables for
8510binaries marked that way.
8511@end table
8512
8513@ifclear GENERIC
8514@lowersections
8515@end ifclear
8516@end ifset
8517
49fa1e15
AM
8518@ifset SPU
8519@ifclear GENERIC
8520@raisesections
8521@end ifclear
8522
8523@node SPU ELF
8524@section @command{ld} and SPU ELF Support
8525
8526@cindex SPU ELF options
8527@table @option
8528
8529@cindex SPU plugins
8530@kindex --plugin
8531@item --plugin
8532This option marks an executable as a PIC plugin module.
8533
8534@cindex SPU overlays
8535@kindex --no-overlays
8536@item --no-overlays
8537Normally, @command{ld} recognizes calls to functions within overlay
8538regions, and redirects such calls to an overlay manager via a stub.
8539@command{ld} also provides a built-in overlay manager. This option
8540turns off all this special overlay handling.
8541
8542@cindex SPU overlay stub symbols
8543@kindex --emit-stub-syms
8544@item --emit-stub-syms
8545This option causes @command{ld} to label overlay stubs with a local
8546symbol that encodes the stub type and destination.
8547
8548@cindex SPU extra overlay stubs
8549@kindex --extra-overlay-stubs
8550@item --extra-overlay-stubs
8551This option causes @command{ld} to add overlay call stubs on all
8552function calls out of overlay regions. Normally stubs are not added
8553on calls to non-overlay regions.
8554
8555@cindex SPU local store size
8556@kindex --local-store=lo:hi
8557@item --local-store=lo:hi
8558@command{ld} usually checks that a final executable for SPU fits in
8559the address range 0 to 256k. This option may be used to change the
8560range. Disable the check entirely with @option{--local-store=0:0}.
8561
c0065db7 8562@cindex SPU
49fa1e15
AM
8563@kindex --stack-analysis
8564@item --stack-analysis
8565SPU local store space is limited. Over-allocation of stack space
8566unnecessarily limits space available for code and data, while
8567under-allocation results in runtime failures. If given this option,
8568@command{ld} will provide an estimate of maximum stack usage.
8569@command{ld} does this by examining symbols in code sections to
8570determine the extents of functions, and looking at function prologues
8571for stack adjusting instructions. A call-graph is created by looking
8572for relocations on branch instructions. The graph is then searched
8573for the maximum stack usage path. Note that this analysis does not
8574find calls made via function pointers, and does not handle recursion
8575and other cycles in the call graph. Stack usage may be
8576under-estimated if your code makes such calls. Also, stack usage for
8577dynamic allocation, e.g. alloca, will not be detected. If a link map
8578is requested, detailed information about each function's stack usage
8579and calls will be given.
8580
c0065db7 8581@cindex SPU
49fa1e15
AM
8582@kindex --emit-stack-syms
8583@item --emit-stack-syms
8584This option, if given along with @option{--stack-analysis} will result
8585in @command{ld} emitting stack sizing symbols for each function.
8586These take the form @code{__stack_<function_name>} for global
8587functions, and @code{__stack_<number>_<function_name>} for static
8588functions. @code{<number>} is the section id in hex. The value of
8589such symbols is the stack requirement for the corresponding function.
8590The symbol size will be zero, type @code{STT_NOTYPE}, binding
c0065db7 8591@code{STB_LOCAL}, and section @code{SHN_ABS}.
49fa1e15
AM
8592@end table
8593
8594@ifclear GENERIC
8595@lowersections
8596@end ifclear
8597@end ifset
8598
36f63dca
NC
8599@ifset TICOFF
8600@ifclear GENERIC
8601@raisesections
8602@end ifclear
8603
8604@node TI COFF
8605@section @command{ld}'s Support for Various TI COFF Versions
8606@cindex TI COFF versions
8607@kindex --format=@var{version}
8608The @samp{--format} switch allows selection of one of the various
8609TI COFF versions. The latest of this writing is 2; versions 0 and 1 are
8610also supported. The TI COFF versions also vary in header byte-order
8611format; @command{ld} will read any version or byte order, but the output
8612header format depends on the default specified by the specific target.
8613
8614@ifclear GENERIC
8615@lowersections
8616@end ifclear
8617@end ifset
8618
2ca22b03
NC
8619@ifset WIN32
8620@ifclear GENERIC
8621@raisesections
8622@end ifclear
8623
8624@node WIN32
8625@section @command{ld} and WIN32 (cygwin/mingw)
8626
c0065db7 8627This section describes some of the win32 specific @command{ld} issues.
a05a5b64
TP
8628See @ref{Options,,Command-line Options} for detailed description of the
8629command-line options mentioned here.
2ca22b03
NC
8630
8631@table @emph
c0065db7
RM
8632@cindex import libraries
8633@item import libraries
69da35b5 8634The standard Windows linker creates and uses so-called import
2ca22b03 8635libraries, which contains information for linking to dll's. They are
69da35b5
NC
8636regular static archives and are handled as any other static
8637archive. The cygwin and mingw ports of @command{ld} have specific
2ca22b03 8638support for creating such libraries provided with the
a05a5b64 8639@samp{--out-implib} command-line option.
2ca22b03 8640
d1792f72
NC
8641@item Resource only DLLs
8642It is possible to create a DLL that only contains resources, ie just a
8643@samp{.rsrc} section, but in order to do so a custom linker script
8644must be used. This is because the built-in default linker scripts
05d31a0b 8645will always create @samp{.text} and @samp{.idata} sections, even if
d1792f72
NC
8646there is no input to go into them.
8647
8648The script should look like this, although the @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT}
8649should be changed to match the desired format.
8650
8651@example
8652OUTPUT_FORMAT(pei-i386)
8653SECTIONS
8654@{
8655 . = SIZEOF_HEADERS;
8656 . = ALIGN(__section_alignment__);
8657 .rsrc __image_base__ + __section_alignment__ : ALIGN(4)
8658 @{
8659 KEEP (*(.rsrc))
8660 KEEP (*(.rsrc$*))
8661 @}
8662 /DISCARD/ : @{ *(*) @}
8663@}
8664@end example
8665
8666With this script saved to a file called, eg @file{rsrc.ld}, a command
8667line like this can be used to create the resource only DLL
8668@file{rsrc.dll} from an input file called @file{rsrc.o}:
8669
8670@smallexample
8671ld -dll --subsystem windows -e 0 -s rsrc.o -o rsrc.dll -T rsrc.ld
8672@end smallexample
8673
c0065db7
RM
8674@item exporting DLL symbols
8675@cindex exporting DLL symbols
dc8465bf
NC
8676The cygwin/mingw @command{ld} has several ways to export symbols for dll's.
8677
8678@table @emph
8679@item using auto-export functionality
8680@cindex using auto-export functionality
8681By default @command{ld} exports symbols with the auto-export functionality,
a05a5b64 8682which is controlled by the following command-line options:
dc8465bf 8683
0a5d968e
NC
8684@itemize
8685@item --export-all-symbols [This is the default]
8686@item --exclude-symbols
8687@item --exclude-libs
e1c37eb5 8688@item --exclude-modules-for-implib
09e2aba4 8689@item --version-script
0a5d968e
NC
8690@end itemize
8691
09e2aba4
DK
8692When auto-export is in operation, @command{ld} will export all the non-local
8693(global and common) symbols it finds in a DLL, with the exception of a few
8694symbols known to belong to the system's runtime and libraries. As it will
8695often not be desirable to export all of a DLL's symbols, which may include
8696private functions that are not part of any public interface, the command-line
9d5777a3 8697options listed above may be used to filter symbols out from the list for
09e2aba4
DK
8698exporting. The @samp{--output-def} option can be used in order to see the
8699final list of exported symbols with all exclusions taken into effect.
8700
8701If @samp{--export-all-symbols} is not given explicitly on the
0a5d968e
NC
8702command line, then the default auto-export behavior will be @emph{disabled}
8703if either of the following are true:
8704
8705@itemize
8706@item A DEF file is used.
8707@item Any symbol in any object file was marked with the __declspec(dllexport) attribute.
8708@end itemize
dc8465bf 8709
c0065db7
RM
8710@item using a DEF file
8711@cindex using a DEF file
dc8465bf
NC
8712Another way of exporting symbols is using a DEF file. A DEF file is
8713an ASCII file containing definitions of symbols which should be
8714exported when a dll is created. Usually it is named @samp{<dll
8715name>.def} and is added as any other object file to the linker's
0a5d968e 8716command line. The file's name must end in @samp{.def} or @samp{.DEF}.
dc8465bf
NC
8717
8718@example
8719gcc -o <output> <objectfiles> <dll name>.def
8720@end example
8721
0a5d968e
NC
8722Using a DEF file turns off the normal auto-export behavior, unless the
8723@samp{--export-all-symbols} option is also used.
8724
dc8465bf
NC
8725Here is an example of a DEF file for a shared library called @samp{xyz.dll}:
8726
8727@example
4b5bd4e7 8728LIBRARY "xyz.dll" BASE=0x20000000
dc8465bf
NC
8729
8730EXPORTS
8731foo
8732bar
8733_bar = bar
4b5bd4e7
DS
8734another_foo = abc.dll.afoo
8735var1 DATA
7fcab871
KT
8736doo = foo == foo2
8737eoo DATA == var1
c0065db7 8738@end example
dc8465bf 8739
7fcab871 8740This example defines a DLL with a non-default base address and seven
4b5bd4e7
DS
8741symbols in the export table. The third exported symbol @code{_bar} is an
8742alias for the second. The fourth symbol, @code{another_foo} is resolved
8743by "forwarding" to another module and treating it as an alias for
8744@code{afoo} exported from the DLL @samp{abc.dll}. The final symbol
7fcab871
KT
8745@code{var1} is declared to be a data object. The @samp{doo} symbol in
8746export library is an alias of @samp{foo}, which gets the string name
8747in export table @samp{foo2}. The @samp{eoo} symbol is an data export
8748symbol, which gets in export table the name @samp{var1}.
4b5bd4e7 8749
6b31ad16
DS
8750The optional @code{LIBRARY <name>} command indicates the @emph{internal}
8751name of the output DLL. If @samp{<name>} does not include a suffix,
8752the default library suffix, @samp{.DLL} is appended.
8753
b45619c0
NC
8754When the .DEF file is used to build an application, rather than a
8755library, the @code{NAME <name>} command should be used instead of
6b31ad16 8756@code{LIBRARY}. If @samp{<name>} does not include a suffix, the default
c0065db7 8757executable suffix, @samp{.EXE} is appended.
6b31ad16
DS
8758
8759With either @code{LIBRARY <name>} or @code{NAME <name>} the optional
8760specification @code{BASE = <number>} may be used to specify a
c0065db7 8761non-default base address for the image.
6b31ad16
DS
8762
8763If neither @code{LIBRARY <name>} nor @code{NAME <name>} is specified,
a2877985
DS
8764or they specify an empty string, the internal name is the same as the
8765filename specified on the command line.
6b31ad16 8766
4b5bd4e7
DS
8767The complete specification of an export symbol is:
8768
8769@example
8770EXPORTS
8771 ( ( ( <name1> [ = <name2> ] )
8772 | ( <name1> = <module-name> . <external-name>))
7fcab871 8773 [ @@ <integer> ] [NONAME] [DATA] [CONSTANT] [PRIVATE] [== <name3>] ) *
c0065db7 8774@end example
4b5bd4e7
DS
8775
8776Declares @samp{<name1>} as an exported symbol from the DLL, or declares
8777@samp{<name1>} as an exported alias for @samp{<name2>}; or declares
8778@samp{<name1>} as a "forward" alias for the symbol
8779@samp{<external-name>} in the DLL @samp{<module-name>}.
8780Optionally, the symbol may be exported by the specified ordinal
7fcab871
KT
8781@samp{<integer>} alias. The optional @samp{<name3>} is the to be used
8782string in import/export table for the symbol.
4b5bd4e7
DS
8783
8784The optional keywords that follow the declaration indicate:
8785
8786@code{NONAME}: Do not put the symbol name in the DLL's export table. It
8787will still be exported by its ordinal alias (either the value specified
8788by the .def specification or, otherwise, the value assigned by the
8789linker). The symbol name, however, does remain visible in the import
8790library (if any), unless @code{PRIVATE} is also specified.
8791
8792@code{DATA}: The symbol is a variable or object, rather than a function.
8793The import lib will export only an indirect reference to @code{foo} as
8794the symbol @code{_imp__foo} (ie, @code{foo} must be resolved as
8795@code{*_imp__foo}).
8796
8797@code{CONSTANT}: Like @code{DATA}, but put the undecorated @code{foo} as
8798well as @code{_imp__foo} into the import library. Both refer to the
8799read-only import address table's pointer to the variable, not to the
8800variable itself. This can be dangerous. If the user code fails to add
8801the @code{dllimport} attribute and also fails to explicitly add the
8802extra indirection that the use of the attribute enforces, the
8803application will behave unexpectedly.
8804
8805@code{PRIVATE}: Put the symbol in the DLL's export table, but do not put
8806it into the static import library used to resolve imports at link time. The
8807symbol can still be imported using the @code{LoadLibrary/GetProcAddress}
de194d85 8808API at runtime or by using the GNU ld extension of linking directly to
4b5bd4e7 8809the DLL without an import library.
c0065db7 8810
4b5bd4e7
DS
8811See ld/deffilep.y in the binutils sources for the full specification of
8812other DEF file statements
dc8465bf
NC
8813
8814@cindex creating a DEF file
8815While linking a shared dll, @command{ld} is able to create a DEF file
a05a5b64 8816with the @samp{--output-def <file>} command-line option.
0a5d968e
NC
8817
8818@item Using decorations
8819@cindex Using decorations
8820Another way of marking symbols for export is to modify the source code
8821itself, so that when building the DLL each symbol to be exported is
8822declared as:
8823
8824@example
8825__declspec(dllexport) int a_variable
8826__declspec(dllexport) void a_function(int with_args)
8827@end example
8828
8829All such symbols will be exported from the DLL. If, however,
8830any of the object files in the DLL contain symbols decorated in
8831this way, then the normal auto-export behavior is disabled, unless
8832the @samp{--export-all-symbols} option is also used.
8833
8834Note that object files that wish to access these symbols must @emph{not}
c0065db7 8835decorate them with dllexport. Instead, they should use dllimport,
0a5d968e
NC
8836instead:
8837
8838@example
8839__declspec(dllimport) int a_variable
8840__declspec(dllimport) void a_function(int with_args)
8841@end example
8842
c0065db7
RM
8843This complicates the structure of library header files, because
8844when included by the library itself the header must declare the
0a5d968e
NC
8845variables and functions as dllexport, but when included by client
8846code the header must declare them as dllimport. There are a number
c0065db7 8847of idioms that are typically used to do this; often client code can
0a5d968e
NC
8848omit the __declspec() declaration completely. See
8849@samp{--enable-auto-import} and @samp{automatic data imports} for more
b45619c0 8850information.
c0065db7 8851@end table
dc8465bf 8852
2ca22b03
NC
8853@cindex automatic data imports
8854@item automatic data imports
8855The standard Windows dll format supports data imports from dlls only
69da35b5 8856by adding special decorations (dllimport/dllexport), which let the
2ca22b03 8857compiler produce specific assembler instructions to deal with this
c0065db7 8858issue. This increases the effort necessary to port existing Un*x
69da35b5 8859code to these platforms, especially for large
2ca22b03 8860c++ libraries and applications. The auto-import feature, which was
c0065db7 8861initially provided by Paul Sokolovsky, allows one to omit the
b45619c0 8862decorations to achieve a behavior that conforms to that on POSIX/Un*x
c0065db7 8863platforms. This feature is enabled with the @samp{--enable-auto-import}
69da35b5
NC
8864command-line option, although it is enabled by default on cygwin/mingw.
8865The @samp{--enable-auto-import} option itself now serves mainly to
8866suppress any warnings that are ordinarily emitted when linked objects
8867trigger the feature's use.
8868
c0065db7 8869auto-import of variables does not always work flawlessly without
69da35b5
NC
8870additional assistance. Sometimes, you will see this message
8871
c0065db7 8872"variable '<var>' can't be auto-imported. Please read the
69da35b5
NC
8873documentation for ld's @code{--enable-auto-import} for details."
8874
c0065db7
RM
8875The @samp{--enable-auto-import} documentation explains why this error
8876occurs, and several methods that can be used to overcome this difficulty.
8877One of these methods is the @emph{runtime pseudo-relocs} feature, described
69da35b5
NC
8878below.
8879
8880@cindex runtime pseudo-relocation
c0065db7
RM
8881For complex variables imported from DLLs (such as structs or classes),
8882object files typically contain a base address for the variable and an
8883offset (@emph{addend}) within the variable--to specify a particular
8884field or public member, for instance. Unfortunately, the runtime loader used
8885in win32 environments is incapable of fixing these references at runtime
69da35b5 8886without the additional information supplied by dllimport/dllexport decorations.
c0065db7 8887The standard auto-import feature described above is unable to resolve these
69da35b5
NC
8888references.
8889
c0065db7
RM
8890The @samp{--enable-runtime-pseudo-relocs} switch allows these references to
8891be resolved without error, while leaving the task of adjusting the references
8892themselves (with their non-zero addends) to specialized code provided by the
8893runtime environment. Recent versions of the cygwin and mingw environments and
8894compilers provide this runtime support; older versions do not. However, the
8895support is only necessary on the developer's platform; the compiled result will
69da35b5
NC
8896run without error on an older system.
8897
c0065db7
RM
8898@samp{--enable-runtime-pseudo-relocs} is not the default; it must be explicitly
8899enabled as needed.
2ca22b03
NC
8900
8901@cindex direct linking to a dll
8902@item direct linking to a dll
8903The cygwin/mingw ports of @command{ld} support the direct linking,
8904including data symbols, to a dll without the usage of any import
69da35b5 8905libraries. This is much faster and uses much less memory than does the
b45619c0 8906traditional import library method, especially when linking large
c0065db7
RM
8907libraries or applications. When @command{ld} creates an import lib, each
8908function or variable exported from the dll is stored in its own bfd, even
8909though a single bfd could contain many exports. The overhead involved in
69da35b5 8910storing, loading, and processing so many bfd's is quite large, and explains the
c0065db7 8911tremendous time, memory, and storage needed to link against particularly
69da35b5
NC
8912large or complex libraries when using import libs.
8913
c0065db7 8914Linking directly to a dll uses no extra command-line switches other than
69da35b5 8915@samp{-L} and @samp{-l}, because @command{ld} already searches for a number
c0065db7 8916of names to match each library. All that is needed from the developer's
69da35b5
NC
8917perspective is an understanding of this search, in order to force ld to
8918select the dll instead of an import library.
8919
2ca22b03 8920
69da35b5
NC
8921For instance, when ld is called with the argument @samp{-lxxx} it will attempt
8922to find, in the first directory of its search path,
2ca22b03
NC
8923
8924@example
45e948fe
NC
8925libxxx.dll.a
8926xxx.dll.a
8927libxxx.a
8928xxx.lib
f6c4d4b1 8929libxxx.lib
69da35b5 8930cygxxx.dll (*)
45e948fe
NC
8931libxxx.dll
8932xxx.dll
2ca22b03
NC
8933@end example
8934
69da35b5
NC
8935before moving on to the next directory in the search path.
8936
c0065db7
RM
8937(*) Actually, this is not @samp{cygxxx.dll} but in fact is @samp{<prefix>xxx.dll},
8938where @samp{<prefix>} is set by the @command{ld} option
8939@samp{--dll-search-prefix=<prefix>}. In the case of cygwin, the standard gcc spec
8940file includes @samp{--dll-search-prefix=cyg}, so in effect we actually search for
69da35b5
NC
8941@samp{cygxxx.dll}.
8942
c0065db7
RM
8943Other win32-based unix environments, such as mingw or pw32, may use other
8944@samp{<prefix>}es, although at present only cygwin makes use of this feature. It
69da35b5
NC
8945was originally intended to help avoid name conflicts among dll's built for the
8946various win32/un*x environments, so that (for example) two versions of a zlib dll
8947could coexist on the same machine.
8948
2ca22b03
NC
8949The generic cygwin/mingw path layout uses a @samp{bin} directory for
8950applications and dll's and a @samp{lib} directory for the import
69da35b5 8951libraries (using cygwin nomenclature):
2ca22b03
NC
8952
8953@example
8954bin/
8955 cygxxx.dll
8956lib/
8957 libxxx.dll.a (in case of dll's)
c0065db7 8958 libxxx.a (in case of static archive)
2ca22b03
NC
8959@end example
8960
c0065db7
RM
8961Linking directly to a dll without using the import library can be
8962done two ways:
2ca22b03
NC
8963
89641. Use the dll directly by adding the @samp{bin} path to the link line
8965@example
8966gcc -Wl,-verbose -o a.exe -L../bin/ -lxxx
c0065db7 8967@end example
2ca22b03 8968
69da35b5
NC
8969However, as the dll's often have version numbers appended to their names
8970(@samp{cygncurses-5.dll}) this will often fail, unless one specifies
8971@samp{-L../bin -lncurses-5} to include the version. Import libs are generally
8972not versioned, and do not have this difficulty.
8973
2ca22b03
NC
89742. Create a symbolic link from the dll to a file in the @samp{lib}
8975directory according to the above mentioned search pattern. This
8976should be used to avoid unwanted changes in the tools needed for
8977making the app/dll.
8978
8979@example
8980ln -s bin/cygxxx.dll lib/[cyg|lib|]xxx.dll[.a]
c0065db7 8981@end example
2ca22b03
NC
8982
8983Then you can link without any make environment changes.
8984
8985@example
8986gcc -Wl,-verbose -o a.exe -L../lib/ -lxxx
c0065db7 8987@end example
69da35b5
NC
8988
8989This technique also avoids the version number problems, because the following is
8990perfectly legal
8991
8992@example
8993bin/
8994 cygxxx-5.dll
8995lib/
c0065db7 8996 libxxx.dll.a -> ../bin/cygxxx-5.dll
69da35b5
NC
8997@end example
8998
dc8465bf 8999Linking directly to a dll without using an import lib will work
69da35b5
NC
9000even when auto-import features are exercised, and even when
9001@samp{--enable-runtime-pseudo-relocs} is used.
9002
9003Given the improvements in speed and memory usage, one might justifiably
45e948fe 9004wonder why import libraries are used at all. There are three reasons:
69da35b5
NC
9005
90061. Until recently, the link-directly-to-dll functionality did @emph{not}
9007work with auto-imported data.
9008
dc8465bf
NC
90092. Sometimes it is necessary to include pure static objects within the
9010import library (which otherwise contains only bfd's for indirection
9011symbols that point to the exports of a dll). Again, the import lib
9012for the cygwin kernel makes use of this ability, and it is not
9013possible to do this without an import lib.
69da35b5 9014
45e948fe
NC
90153. Symbol aliases can only be resolved using an import lib. This is
9016critical when linking against OS-supplied dll's (eg, the win32 API)
9017in which symbols are usually exported as undecorated aliases of their
9018stdcall-decorated assembly names.
9019
69da35b5 9020So, import libs are not going away. But the ability to replace
c0065db7
RM
9021true import libs with a simple symbolic link to (or a copy of)
9022a dll, in many cases, is a useful addition to the suite of tools
9023binutils makes available to the win32 developer. Given the
69da35b5
NC
9024massive improvements in memory requirements during linking, storage
9025requirements, and linking speed, we expect that many developers
9026will soon begin to use this feature whenever possible.
dc8465bf 9027
c0065db7 9028@item symbol aliasing
dc8465bf 9029@table @emph
c0065db7
RM
9030@item adding additional names
9031Sometimes, it is useful to export symbols with additional names.
dc8465bf
NC
9032A symbol @samp{foo} will be exported as @samp{foo}, but it can also be
9033exported as @samp{_foo} by using special directives in the DEF file
9034when creating the dll. This will affect also the optional created
c0065db7 9035import library. Consider the following DEF file:
dc8465bf 9036
c0065db7 9037@example
dc8465bf
NC
9038LIBRARY "xyz.dll" BASE=0x61000000
9039
9040EXPORTS
c0065db7 9041foo
dc8465bf 9042_foo = foo
c0065db7 9043@end example
dc8465bf
NC
9044
9045The line @samp{_foo = foo} maps the symbol @samp{foo} to @samp{_foo}.
9046
9047Another method for creating a symbol alias is to create it in the
9048source code using the "weak" attribute:
9049
c0065db7
RM
9050@example
9051void foo () @{ /* Do something. */; @}
dc8465bf 9052void _foo () __attribute__ ((weak, alias ("foo")));
c0065db7 9053@end example
dc8465bf
NC
9054
9055See the gcc manual for more information about attributes and weak
9056symbols.
9057
9058@item renaming symbols
9059Sometimes it is useful to rename exports. For instance, the cygwin
c0065db7 9060kernel does this regularly. A symbol @samp{_foo} can be exported as
dc8465bf
NC
9061@samp{foo} but not as @samp{_foo} by using special directives in the
9062DEF file. (This will also affect the import library, if it is
c0065db7 9063created). In the following example:
dc8465bf 9064
c0065db7 9065@example
dc8465bf
NC
9066LIBRARY "xyz.dll" BASE=0x61000000
9067
9068EXPORTS
9069_foo = foo
c0065db7 9070@end example
dc8465bf
NC
9071
9072The line @samp{_foo = foo} maps the exported symbol @samp{foo} to
9073@samp{_foo}.
c0065db7 9074@end table
dc8465bf 9075
0a5d968e 9076Note: using a DEF file disables the default auto-export behavior,
a05a5b64 9077unless the @samp{--export-all-symbols} command-line option is used.
0a5d968e 9078If, however, you are trying to rename symbols, then you should list
c0065db7
RM
9079@emph{all} desired exports in the DEF file, including the symbols
9080that are not being renamed, and do @emph{not} use the
9081@samp{--export-all-symbols} option. If you list only the
9082renamed symbols in the DEF file, and use @samp{--export-all-symbols}
9083to handle the other symbols, then the both the new names @emph{and}
9084the original names for the renamed symbols will be exported.
9085In effect, you'd be aliasing those symbols, not renaming them,
0a5d968e 9086which is probably not what you wanted.
c87db184
CF
9087
9088@cindex weak externals
9089@item weak externals
9090The Windows object format, PE, specifies a form of weak symbols called
9091weak externals. When a weak symbol is linked and the symbol is not
9092defined, the weak symbol becomes an alias for some other symbol. There
9093are three variants of weak externals:
9094@itemize
9095@item Definition is searched for in objects and libraries, historically
9096called lazy externals.
9097@item Definition is searched for only in other objects, not in libraries.
9098This form is not presently implemented.
9099@item No search; the symbol is an alias. This form is not presently
9100implemented.
9101@end itemize
9102As a GNU extension, weak symbols that do not specify an alternate symbol
9103are supported. If the symbol is undefined when linking, the symbol
9104uses a default value.
c1711530
DK
9105
9106@cindex aligned common symbols
9107@item aligned common symbols
9108As a GNU extension to the PE file format, it is possible to specify the
9109desired alignment for a common symbol. This information is conveyed from
9110the assembler or compiler to the linker by means of GNU-specific commands
9111carried in the object file's @samp{.drectve} section, which are recognized
9112by @command{ld} and respected when laying out the common symbols. Native
9113tools will be able to process object files employing this GNU extension,
9114but will fail to respect the alignment instructions, and may issue noisy
9115warnings about unknown linker directives.
5063daf7 9116
2ca22b03
NC
9117@end table
9118
9119@ifclear GENERIC
9120@lowersections
9121@end ifclear
9122@end ifset
9123
e0001a05
NC
9124@ifset XTENSA
9125@ifclear GENERIC
9126@raisesections
9127@end ifclear
9128
9129@node Xtensa
9130@section @code{ld} and Xtensa Processors
9131
9132@cindex Xtensa processors
9133The default @command{ld} behavior for Xtensa processors is to interpret
9134@code{SECTIONS} commands so that lists of explicitly named sections in a
9135specification with a wildcard file will be interleaved when necessary to
9136keep literal pools within the range of PC-relative load offsets. For
9137example, with the command:
9138
9139@smallexample
9140SECTIONS
9141@{
9142 .text : @{
9143 *(.literal .text)
9144 @}
9145@}
9146@end smallexample
9147
9148@noindent
9149@command{ld} may interleave some of the @code{.literal}
9150and @code{.text} sections from different object files to ensure that the
9151literal pools are within the range of PC-relative load offsets. A valid
9152interleaving might place the @code{.literal} sections from an initial
9153group of files followed by the @code{.text} sections of that group of
9154files. Then, the @code{.literal} sections from the rest of the files
9155and the @code{.text} sections from the rest of the files would follow.
e0001a05 9156
43cd72b9 9157@cindex @option{--relax} on Xtensa
e0001a05 9158@cindex relaxing on Xtensa
43cd72b9
BW
9159Relaxation is enabled by default for the Xtensa version of @command{ld} and
9160provides two important link-time optimizations. The first optimization
9161is to combine identical literal values to reduce code size. A redundant
9162literal will be removed and all the @code{L32R} instructions that use it
9163will be changed to reference an identical literal, as long as the
9164location of the replacement literal is within the offset range of all
9165the @code{L32R} instructions. The second optimization is to remove
9166unnecessary overhead from assembler-generated ``longcall'' sequences of
9167@code{L32R}/@code{CALLX@var{n}} when the target functions are within
9168range of direct @code{CALL@var{n}} instructions.
9169
9170For each of these cases where an indirect call sequence can be optimized
9171to a direct call, the linker will change the @code{CALLX@var{n}}
9172instruction to a @code{CALL@var{n}} instruction, remove the @code{L32R}
9173instruction, and remove the literal referenced by the @code{L32R}
9174instruction if it is not used for anything else. Removing the
9175@code{L32R} instruction always reduces code size but can potentially
9176hurt performance by changing the alignment of subsequent branch targets.
9177By default, the linker will always preserve alignments, either by
9178switching some instructions between 24-bit encodings and the equivalent
9179density instructions or by inserting a no-op in place of the @code{L32R}
9180instruction that was removed. If code size is more important than
9181performance, the @option{--size-opt} option can be used to prevent the
9182linker from widening density instructions or inserting no-ops, except in
9183a few cases where no-ops are required for correctness.
9184
9185The following Xtensa-specific command-line options can be used to
9186control the linker:
9187
9188@cindex Xtensa options
9189@table @option
43cd72b9
BW
9190@item --size-opt
9191When optimizing indirect calls to direct calls, optimize for code size
9192more than performance. With this option, the linker will not insert
9193no-ops or widen density instructions to preserve branch target
9194alignment. There may still be some cases where no-ops are required to
9195preserve the correctness of the code.
7a77f1ac
MF
9196
9197@item --abi-windowed
9198@itemx --abi-call0
9199Choose ABI for the output object and for the generated PLT code.
9200PLT code inserted by the linker must match ABI of the output object
9201because windowed and call0 ABI use incompatible function call
9202conventions.
9203Default ABI is chosen by the ABI tag in the @code{.xtensa.info} section
9204of the first input object.
9205A warning is issued if ABI tags of input objects do not match each other
9206or the chosen output object ABI.
43cd72b9 9207@end table
e0001a05
NC
9208
9209@ifclear GENERIC
9210@lowersections
9211@end ifclear
9212@end ifset
9213
252b5132
RH
9214@ifclear SingleFormat
9215@node BFD
9216@chapter BFD
9217
9218@cindex back end
9219@cindex object file management
9220@cindex object formats available
9221@kindex objdump -i
9222The linker accesses object and archive files using the BFD libraries.
9223These libraries allow the linker to use the same routines to operate on
9224object files whatever the object file format. A different object file
9225format can be supported simply by creating a new BFD back end and adding
9226it to the library. To conserve runtime memory, however, the linker and
9227associated tools are usually configured to support only a subset of the
9228object file formats available. You can use @code{objdump -i}
9229(@pxref{objdump,,objdump,binutils.info,The GNU Binary Utilities}) to
9230list all the formats available for your configuration.
9231
9232@cindex BFD requirements
9233@cindex requirements for BFD
9234As with most implementations, BFD is a compromise between
9235several conflicting requirements. The major factor influencing
9236BFD design was efficiency: any time used converting between
9237formats is time which would not have been spent had BFD not
9238been involved. This is partly offset by abstraction payback; since
9239BFD simplifies applications and back ends, more time and care
9240may be spent optimizing algorithms for a greater speed.
9241
9242One minor artifact of the BFD solution which you should bear in
9243mind is the potential for information loss. There are two places where
9244useful information can be lost using the BFD mechanism: during
9245conversion and during output. @xref{BFD information loss}.
9246
9247@menu
9248* BFD outline:: How it works: an outline of BFD
9249@end menu
9250
9251@node BFD outline
36f63dca 9252@section How It Works: An Outline of BFD
252b5132
RH
9253@cindex opening object files
9254@include bfdsumm.texi
9255@end ifclear
9256
9257@node Reporting Bugs
9258@chapter Reporting Bugs
ff5dcc92
SC
9259@cindex bugs in @command{ld}
9260@cindex reporting bugs in @command{ld}
252b5132 9261
ff5dcc92 9262Your bug reports play an essential role in making @command{ld} reliable.
252b5132
RH
9263
9264Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or
9265it may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is
ff5dcc92 9266to help the entire community by making the next version of @command{ld}
252b5132 9267work better. Bug reports are your contribution to the maintenance of
ff5dcc92 9268@command{ld}.
252b5132
RH
9269
9270In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
9271information that enables us to fix the bug.
9272
9273@menu
9274* Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
9275* Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
9276@end menu
9277
9278@node Bug Criteria
36f63dca 9279@section Have You Found a Bug?
252b5132
RH
9280@cindex bug criteria
9281
9282If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
9283
9284@itemize @bullet
9285@cindex fatal signal
9286@cindex linker crash
9287@cindex crash of linker
9288@item
9289If the linker gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
ff5dcc92 9290@command{ld} bug. Reliable linkers never crash.
252b5132
RH
9291
9292@cindex error on valid input
9293@item
ff5dcc92 9294If @command{ld} produces an error message for valid input, that is a bug.
252b5132
RH
9295
9296@cindex invalid input
9297@item
ff5dcc92 9298If @command{ld} does not produce an error message for invalid input, that
252b5132
RH
9299may be a bug. In the general case, the linker can not verify that
9300object files are correct.
9301
9302@item
9303If you are an experienced user of linkers, your suggestions for
ff5dcc92 9304improvement of @command{ld} are welcome in any case.
252b5132
RH
9305@end itemize
9306
9307@node Bug Reporting
36f63dca 9308@section How to Report Bugs
252b5132 9309@cindex bug reports
ff5dcc92 9310@cindex @command{ld} bugs, reporting
252b5132
RH
9311
9312A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu}
ff5dcc92 9313products. If you obtained @command{ld} from a support organization, we
252b5132
RH
9314recommend you contact that organization first.
9315
9316You can find contact information for many support companies and
9317individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
9318distribution.
9319
ad22bfe8 9320@ifset BUGURL
ff5dcc92 9321Otherwise, send bug reports for @command{ld} to
ad22bfe8
JM
9322@value{BUGURL}.
9323@end ifset
252b5132
RH
9324
9325The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
9326@strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
9327fact or leave it out, state it!
9328
9329Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
9330problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
b553b183
NC
9331assume that the name of a symbol you use in an example does not
9332matter. Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps
9333the bug is a stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the
9334location where that name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name
9335were different, the contents of that location would fool the linker
9336into doing the right thing despite the bug. Play it safe and give a
9337specific, complete example. That is the easiest thing for you to do,
c0065db7 9338and the most helpful.
b553b183
NC
9339
9340Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix
9341the bug if it is new to us. Therefore, always write your bug reports
9342on the assumption that the bug has not been reported previously.
252b5132
RH
9343
9344Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
36f63dca
NC
9345bell?'' This cannot help us fix a bug, so it is basically useless. We
9346respond by asking for enough details to enable us to investigate.
9347You might as well expedite matters by sending them to begin with.
252b5132
RH
9348
9349To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
9350
9351@itemize @bullet
9352@item
ff5dcc92 9353The version of @command{ld}. @command{ld} announces it if you start it with
252b5132
RH
9354the @samp{--version} argument.
9355
9356Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
ff5dcc92 9357the bug in the current version of @command{ld}.
252b5132
RH
9358
9359@item
ff5dcc92 9360Any patches you may have applied to the @command{ld} source, including any
252b5132
RH
9361patches made to the @code{BFD} library.
9362
9363@item
9364The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
9365version number.
9366
9367@item
ff5dcc92 9368What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @command{ld}---e.g.
252b5132
RH
9369``@code{gcc-2.7}''.
9370
9371@item
9372The command arguments you gave the linker to link your example and
9373observe the bug. To guarantee you will not omit something important,
9374list them all. A copy of the Makefile (or the output from make) is
9375sufficient.
9376
9377If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
9378and then we might not encounter the bug.
9379
9380@item
9381A complete input file, or set of input files, that will reproduce the
b553b183
NC
9382bug. It is generally most helpful to send the actual object files
9383provided that they are reasonably small. Say no more than 10K. For
9384bigger files you can either make them available by FTP or HTTP or else
9385state that you are willing to send the object file(s) to whomever
9386requests them. (Note - your email will be going to a mailing list, so
9387we do not want to clog it up with large attachments). But small
9388attachments are best.
252b5132
RH
9389
9390If the source files were assembled using @code{gas} or compiled using
9391@code{gcc}, then it may be OK to send the source files rather than the
9392object files. In this case, be sure to say exactly what version of
9393@code{gas} or @code{gcc} was used to produce the object files. Also say
9394how @code{gas} or @code{gcc} were configured.
9395
9396@item
9397A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
9398incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
9399
ff5dcc92 9400Of course, if the bug is that @command{ld} gets a fatal signal, then we
252b5132
RH
9401will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
9402not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
9403a chance to make a mistake.
9404
9405Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
9406say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
b45619c0 9407copy of @command{ld} is out of sync, or you have encountered a bug in the
252b5132
RH
9408C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might crash
9409and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when ours
9410fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for us. If
9411you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able to draw
9412any conclusion from our observations.
9413
9414@item
ff5dcc92 9415If you wish to suggest changes to the @command{ld} source, send us context
252b5132
RH
9416diffs, as generated by @code{diff} with the @samp{-u}, @samp{-c}, or
9417@samp{-p} option. Always send diffs from the old file to the new file.
ff5dcc92 9418If you even discuss something in the @command{ld} source, refer to it by
252b5132
RH
9419context, not by line number.
9420
9421The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
9422sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
9423@end itemize
9424
9425Here are some things that are not necessary:
9426
9427@itemize @bullet
9428@item
9429A description of the envelope of the bug.
9430
9431Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
9432which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
9433changes will not affect it.
9434
9435This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
9436will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
9437with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
9438We recommend that you save your time for something else.
9439
9440Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
9441of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
9442output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
9443less time, and so on.
9444
9445However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
9446report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
9447
9448@item
9449A patch for the bug.
9450
9451A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
9452the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
9453a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
9454to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
9455
ff5dcc92 9456Sometimes with a program as complicated as @command{ld} it is very hard to
252b5132
RH
9457construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
9458through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be
9459able to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is
9460fixed.
9461
9462And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
9463patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
9464help us to understand.
9465
9466@item
9467A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
9468
9469Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
9470things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
9471@end itemize
9472
9473@node MRI
9474@appendix MRI Compatible Script Files
9475@cindex MRI compatibility
ff5dcc92
SC
9476To aid users making the transition to @sc{gnu} @command{ld} from the MRI
9477linker, @command{ld} can use MRI compatible linker scripts as an
252b5132
RH
9478alternative to the more general-purpose linker scripting language
9479described in @ref{Scripts}. MRI compatible linker scripts have a much
9480simpler command set than the scripting language otherwise used with
ff5dcc92 9481@command{ld}. @sc{gnu} @command{ld} supports the most commonly used MRI
252b5132
RH
9482linker commands; these commands are described here.
9483
9484In general, MRI scripts aren't of much use with the @code{a.out} object
9485file format, since it only has three sections and MRI scripts lack some
9486features to make use of them.
9487
9488You can specify a file containing an MRI-compatible script using the
9489@samp{-c} command-line option.
9490
9491Each command in an MRI-compatible script occupies its own line; each
9492command line starts with the keyword that identifies the command (though
9493blank lines are also allowed for punctuation). If a line of an
ff5dcc92 9494MRI-compatible script begins with an unrecognized keyword, @command{ld}
252b5132
RH
9495issues a warning message, but continues processing the script.
9496
9497Lines beginning with @samp{*} are comments.
9498
9499You can write these commands using all upper-case letters, or all
9500lower case; for example, @samp{chip} is the same as @samp{CHIP}.
9501The following list shows only the upper-case form of each command.
9502
9503@table @code
9504@cindex @code{ABSOLUTE} (MRI)
9505@item ABSOLUTE @var{secname}
9506@itemx ABSOLUTE @var{secname}, @var{secname}, @dots{} @var{secname}
ff5dcc92 9507Normally, @command{ld} includes in the output file all sections from all
252b5132
RH
9508the input files. However, in an MRI-compatible script, you can use the
9509@code{ABSOLUTE} command to restrict the sections that will be present in
9510your output program. If the @code{ABSOLUTE} command is used at all in a
9511script, then only the sections named explicitly in @code{ABSOLUTE}
9512commands will appear in the linker output. You can still use other
9513input sections (whatever you select on the command line, or using
9514@code{LOAD}) to resolve addresses in the output file.
9515
9516@cindex @code{ALIAS} (MRI)
9517@item ALIAS @var{out-secname}, @var{in-secname}
9518Use this command to place the data from input section @var{in-secname}
9519in a section called @var{out-secname} in the linker output file.
9520
9521@var{in-secname} may be an integer.
9522
9523@cindex @code{ALIGN} (MRI)
9524@item ALIGN @var{secname} = @var{expression}
9525Align the section called @var{secname} to @var{expression}. The
9526@var{expression} should be a power of two.
9527
9528@cindex @code{BASE} (MRI)
9529@item BASE @var{expression}
9530Use the value of @var{expression} as the lowest address (other than
9531absolute addresses) in the output file.
9532
9533@cindex @code{CHIP} (MRI)
9534@item CHIP @var{expression}
9535@itemx CHIP @var{expression}, @var{expression}
9536This command does nothing; it is accepted only for compatibility.
9537
9538@cindex @code{END} (MRI)
9539@item END
9540This command does nothing whatever; it's only accepted for compatibility.
9541
9542@cindex @code{FORMAT} (MRI)
9543@item FORMAT @var{output-format}
9544Similar to the @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} command in the more general linker
dc12032b 9545language, but restricted to S-records, if @var{output-format} is @samp{S}
252b5132
RH
9546
9547@cindex @code{LIST} (MRI)
9548@item LIST @var{anything}@dots{}
9549Print (to the standard output file) a link map, as produced by the
ff5dcc92 9550@command{ld} command-line option @samp{-M}.
252b5132
RH
9551
9552The keyword @code{LIST} may be followed by anything on the
9553same line, with no change in its effect.
9554
9555@cindex @code{LOAD} (MRI)
9556@item LOAD @var{filename}
9557@itemx LOAD @var{filename}, @var{filename}, @dots{} @var{filename}
9558Include one or more object file @var{filename} in the link; this has the
ff5dcc92 9559same effect as specifying @var{filename} directly on the @command{ld}
252b5132
RH
9560command line.
9561
9562@cindex @code{NAME} (MRI)
9563@item NAME @var{output-name}
ff5dcc92 9564@var{output-name} is the name for the program produced by @command{ld}; the
252b5132
RH
9565MRI-compatible command @code{NAME} is equivalent to the command-line
9566option @samp{-o} or the general script language command @code{OUTPUT}.
9567
9568@cindex @code{ORDER} (MRI)
9569@item ORDER @var{secname}, @var{secname}, @dots{} @var{secname}
9570@itemx ORDER @var{secname} @var{secname} @var{secname}
ff5dcc92 9571Normally, @command{ld} orders the sections in its output file in the
252b5132
RH
9572order in which they first appear in the input files. In an MRI-compatible
9573script, you can override this ordering with the @code{ORDER} command. The
9574sections you list with @code{ORDER} will appear first in your output
9575file, in the order specified.
9576
9577@cindex @code{PUBLIC} (MRI)
9578@item PUBLIC @var{name}=@var{expression}
9579@itemx PUBLIC @var{name},@var{expression}
9580@itemx PUBLIC @var{name} @var{expression}
9581Supply a value (@var{expression}) for external symbol
9582@var{name} used in the linker input files.
9583
9584@cindex @code{SECT} (MRI)
9585@item SECT @var{secname}, @var{expression}
9586@itemx SECT @var{secname}=@var{expression}
9587@itemx SECT @var{secname} @var{expression}
9588You can use any of these three forms of the @code{SECT} command to
9589specify the start address (@var{expression}) for section @var{secname}.
9590If you have more than one @code{SECT} statement for the same
9591@var{secname}, only the @emph{first} sets the start address.
9592@end table
9593
793c5807
NC
9594@node GNU Free Documentation License
9595@appendix GNU Free Documentation License
36f63dca 9596@include fdl.texi
704c465c 9597
370b66a1
CD
9598@node LD Index
9599@unnumbered LD Index
252b5132
RH
9600
9601@printindex cp
9602
9603@tex
7ca01ed9 9604% I think something like @@colophon should be in texinfo. In the
252b5132
RH
9605% meantime:
9606\long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
9607\centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
9608\centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
9609\centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
9610\centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
9611\centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/} and}
9612\centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
9613\centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
9614\page\colophon
7ca01ed9 9615% Blame: doc@@cygnus.com, 28mar91.
252b5132
RH
9616@end tex
9617
252b5132 9618@bye